]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blob - gdb/ada-lang.c
* ada-lang.c (resolve_subexp): Update.
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / ada-lang.c
1 /* Ada language support routines for GDB, the GNU debugger.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1992-1994, 1997-2000, 2003-2005, 2007-2012 Free
4 Software Foundation, Inc.
5
6 This file is part of GDB.
7
8 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
9 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
10 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
11 (at your option) any later version.
12
13 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
14 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
15 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
16 GNU General Public License for more details.
17
18 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20
21
22 #include "defs.h"
23 #include <stdio.h>
24 #include "gdb_string.h"
25 #include <ctype.h>
26 #include <stdarg.h>
27 #include "demangle.h"
28 #include "gdb_regex.h"
29 #include "frame.h"
30 #include "symtab.h"
31 #include "gdbtypes.h"
32 #include "gdbcmd.h"
33 #include "expression.h"
34 #include "parser-defs.h"
35 #include "language.h"
36 #include "c-lang.h"
37 #include "inferior.h"
38 #include "symfile.h"
39 #include "objfiles.h"
40 #include "breakpoint.h"
41 #include "gdbcore.h"
42 #include "hashtab.h"
43 #include "gdb_obstack.h"
44 #include "ada-lang.h"
45 #include "completer.h"
46 #include "gdb_stat.h"
47 #ifdef UI_OUT
48 #include "ui-out.h"
49 #endif
50 #include "block.h"
51 #include "infcall.h"
52 #include "dictionary.h"
53 #include "exceptions.h"
54 #include "annotate.h"
55 #include "valprint.h"
56 #include "source.h"
57 #include "observer.h"
58 #include "vec.h"
59 #include "stack.h"
60 #include "gdb_vecs.h"
61
62 #include "psymtab.h"
63 #include "value.h"
64 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
65 #include "arch-utils.h"
66 #include "exceptions.h"
67 #include "cli/cli-utils.h"
68
69 /* Define whether or not the C operator '/' truncates towards zero for
70 differently signed operands (truncation direction is undefined in C).
71 Copied from valarith.c. */
72
73 #ifndef TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO
74 #define TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO ((-5 / 2) == -2)
75 #endif
76
77 static struct type *desc_base_type (struct type *);
78
79 static struct type *desc_bounds_type (struct type *);
80
81 static struct value *desc_bounds (struct value *);
82
83 static int fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (struct type *);
84
85 static int fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (struct type *);
86
87 static struct type *desc_data_target_type (struct type *);
88
89 static struct value *desc_data (struct value *);
90
91 static int fat_pntr_data_bitpos (struct type *);
92
93 static int fat_pntr_data_bitsize (struct type *);
94
95 static struct value *desc_one_bound (struct value *, int, int);
96
97 static int desc_bound_bitpos (struct type *, int, int);
98
99 static int desc_bound_bitsize (struct type *, int, int);
100
101 static struct type *desc_index_type (struct type *, int);
102
103 static int desc_arity (struct type *);
104
105 static int ada_type_match (struct type *, struct type *, int);
106
107 static int ada_args_match (struct symbol *, struct value **, int);
108
109 static int full_match (const char *, const char *);
110
111 static struct value *make_array_descriptor (struct type *, struct value *);
112
113 static void ada_add_block_symbols (struct obstack *,
114 struct block *, const char *,
115 domain_enum, struct objfile *, int);
116
117 static int is_nonfunction (struct ada_symbol_info *, int);
118
119 static void add_defn_to_vec (struct obstack *, struct symbol *,
120 struct block *);
121
122 static int num_defns_collected (struct obstack *);
123
124 static struct ada_symbol_info *defns_collected (struct obstack *, int);
125
126 static struct value *resolve_subexp (struct expression **, int *, int,
127 struct type *);
128
129 static void replace_operator_with_call (struct expression **, int, int, int,
130 struct symbol *, struct block *);
131
132 static int possible_user_operator_p (enum exp_opcode, struct value **);
133
134 static char *ada_op_name (enum exp_opcode);
135
136 static const char *ada_decoded_op_name (enum exp_opcode);
137
138 static int numeric_type_p (struct type *);
139
140 static int integer_type_p (struct type *);
141
142 static int scalar_type_p (struct type *);
143
144 static int discrete_type_p (struct type *);
145
146 static enum ada_renaming_category parse_old_style_renaming (struct type *,
147 const char **,
148 int *,
149 const char **);
150
151 static struct symbol *find_old_style_renaming_symbol (const char *,
152 struct block *);
153
154 static struct type *ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (struct type *, char *,
155 int, int, int *);
156
157 static struct value *evaluate_subexp_type (struct expression *, int *);
158
159 static struct type *ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (struct type *,
160 const char *);
161
162 static int is_dynamic_field (struct type *, int);
163
164 static struct type *to_fixed_variant_branch_type (struct type *,
165 const gdb_byte *,
166 CORE_ADDR, struct value *);
167
168 static struct type *to_fixed_array_type (struct type *, struct value *, int);
169
170 static struct type *to_fixed_range_type (struct type *, struct value *);
171
172 static struct type *to_static_fixed_type (struct type *);
173 static struct type *static_unwrap_type (struct type *type);
174
175 static struct value *unwrap_value (struct value *);
176
177 static struct type *constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *, long *);
178
179 static struct type *decode_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *);
180
181 static long decode_packed_array_bitsize (struct type *);
182
183 static struct value *decode_constrained_packed_array (struct value *);
184
185 static int ada_is_packed_array_type (struct type *);
186
187 static int ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (struct type *);
188
189 static struct value *value_subscript_packed (struct value *, int,
190 struct value **);
191
192 static void move_bits (gdb_byte *, int, const gdb_byte *, int, int, int);
193
194 static struct value *coerce_unspec_val_to_type (struct value *,
195 struct type *);
196
197 static struct value *get_var_value (char *, char *);
198
199 static int lesseq_defined_than (struct symbol *, struct symbol *);
200
201 static int equiv_types (struct type *, struct type *);
202
203 static int is_name_suffix (const char *);
204
205 static int advance_wild_match (const char **, const char *, int);
206
207 static int wild_match (const char *, const char *);
208
209 static struct value *ada_coerce_ref (struct value *);
210
211 static LONGEST pos_atr (struct value *);
212
213 static struct value *value_pos_atr (struct type *, struct value *);
214
215 static struct value *value_val_atr (struct type *, struct value *);
216
217 static struct symbol *standard_lookup (const char *, const struct block *,
218 domain_enum);
219
220 static struct value *ada_search_struct_field (char *, struct value *, int,
221 struct type *);
222
223 static struct value *ada_value_primitive_field (struct value *, int, int,
224 struct type *);
225
226 static int find_struct_field (char *, struct type *, int,
227 struct type **, int *, int *, int *, int *);
228
229 static struct value *ada_to_fixed_value_create (struct type *, CORE_ADDR,
230 struct value *);
231
232 static int ada_resolve_function (struct ada_symbol_info *, int,
233 struct value **, int, const char *,
234 struct type *);
235
236 static int ada_is_direct_array_type (struct type *);
237
238 static void ada_language_arch_info (struct gdbarch *,
239 struct language_arch_info *);
240
241 static void check_size (const struct type *);
242
243 static struct value *ada_index_struct_field (int, struct value *, int,
244 struct type *);
245
246 static struct value *assign_aggregate (struct value *, struct value *,
247 struct expression *,
248 int *, enum noside);
249
250 static void aggregate_assign_from_choices (struct value *, struct value *,
251 struct expression *,
252 int *, LONGEST *, int *,
253 int, LONGEST, LONGEST);
254
255 static void aggregate_assign_positional (struct value *, struct value *,
256 struct expression *,
257 int *, LONGEST *, int *, int,
258 LONGEST, LONGEST);
259
260
261 static void aggregate_assign_others (struct value *, struct value *,
262 struct expression *,
263 int *, LONGEST *, int, LONGEST, LONGEST);
264
265
266 static void add_component_interval (LONGEST, LONGEST, LONGEST *, int *, int);
267
268
269 static struct value *ada_evaluate_subexp (struct type *, struct expression *,
270 int *, enum noside);
271
272 static void ada_forward_operator_length (struct expression *, int, int *,
273 int *);
274 \f
275
276
277 /* Maximum-sized dynamic type. */
278 static unsigned int varsize_limit;
279
280 /* FIXME: brobecker/2003-09-17: No longer a const because it is
281 returned by a function that does not return a const char *. */
282 static char *ada_completer_word_break_characters =
283 #ifdef VMS
284 " \t\n!@#%^&*()+=|~`}{[]\";:?/,-";
285 #else
286 " \t\n!@#$%^&*()+=|~`}{[]\";:?/,-";
287 #endif
288
289 /* The name of the symbol to use to get the name of the main subprogram. */
290 static const char ADA_MAIN_PROGRAM_SYMBOL_NAME[]
291 = "__gnat_ada_main_program_name";
292
293 /* Limit on the number of warnings to raise per expression evaluation. */
294 static int warning_limit = 2;
295
296 /* Number of warning messages issued; reset to 0 by cleanups after
297 expression evaluation. */
298 static int warnings_issued = 0;
299
300 static const char *known_runtime_file_name_patterns[] = {
301 ADA_KNOWN_RUNTIME_FILE_NAME_PATTERNS NULL
302 };
303
304 static const char *known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[] = {
305 ADA_KNOWN_AUXILIARY_FUNCTION_NAME_PATTERNS NULL
306 };
307
308 /* Space for allocating results of ada_lookup_symbol_list. */
309 static struct obstack symbol_list_obstack;
310
311 /* Inferior-specific data. */
312
313 /* Per-inferior data for this module. */
314
315 struct ada_inferior_data
316 {
317 /* The ada__tags__type_specific_data type, which is used when decoding
318 tagged types. With older versions of GNAT, this type was directly
319 accessible through a component ("tsd") in the object tag. But this
320 is no longer the case, so we cache it for each inferior. */
321 struct type *tsd_type;
322
323 /* The exception_support_info data. This data is used to determine
324 how to implement support for Ada exception catchpoints in a given
325 inferior. */
326 const struct exception_support_info *exception_info;
327 };
328
329 /* Our key to this module's inferior data. */
330 static const struct inferior_data *ada_inferior_data;
331
332 /* A cleanup routine for our inferior data. */
333 static void
334 ada_inferior_data_cleanup (struct inferior *inf, void *arg)
335 {
336 struct ada_inferior_data *data;
337
338 data = inferior_data (inf, ada_inferior_data);
339 if (data != NULL)
340 xfree (data);
341 }
342
343 /* Return our inferior data for the given inferior (INF).
344
345 This function always returns a valid pointer to an allocated
346 ada_inferior_data structure. If INF's inferior data has not
347 been previously set, this functions creates a new one with all
348 fields set to zero, sets INF's inferior to it, and then returns
349 a pointer to that newly allocated ada_inferior_data. */
350
351 static struct ada_inferior_data *
352 get_ada_inferior_data (struct inferior *inf)
353 {
354 struct ada_inferior_data *data;
355
356 data = inferior_data (inf, ada_inferior_data);
357 if (data == NULL)
358 {
359 data = XZALLOC (struct ada_inferior_data);
360 set_inferior_data (inf, ada_inferior_data, data);
361 }
362
363 return data;
364 }
365
366 /* Perform all necessary cleanups regarding our module's inferior data
367 that is required after the inferior INF just exited. */
368
369 static void
370 ada_inferior_exit (struct inferior *inf)
371 {
372 ada_inferior_data_cleanup (inf, NULL);
373 set_inferior_data (inf, ada_inferior_data, NULL);
374 }
375
376 /* Utilities */
377
378 /* If TYPE is a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF type, return the target type after
379 all typedef layers have been peeled. Otherwise, return TYPE.
380
381 Normally, we really expect a typedef type to only have 1 typedef layer.
382 In other words, we really expect the target type of a typedef type to be
383 a non-typedef type. This is particularly true for Ada units, because
384 the language does not have a typedef vs not-typedef distinction.
385 In that respect, the Ada compiler has been trying to eliminate as many
386 typedef definitions in the debugging information, since they generally
387 do not bring any extra information (we still use typedef under certain
388 circumstances related mostly to the GNAT encoding).
389
390 Unfortunately, we have seen situations where the debugging information
391 generated by the compiler leads to such multiple typedef layers. For
392 instance, consider the following example with stabs:
393
394 .stabs "pck__float_array___XUP:Tt(0,46)=s16P_ARRAY:(0,47)=[...]"[...]
395 .stabs "pck__float_array___XUP:t(0,36)=(0,46)",128,0,6,0
396
397 This is an error in the debugging information which causes type
398 pck__float_array___XUP to be defined twice, and the second time,
399 it is defined as a typedef of a typedef.
400
401 This is on the fringe of legality as far as debugging information is
402 concerned, and certainly unexpected. But it is easy to handle these
403 situations correctly, so we can afford to be lenient in this case. */
404
405 static struct type *
406 ada_typedef_target_type (struct type *type)
407 {
408 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
409 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
410 return type;
411 }
412
413 /* Given DECODED_NAME a string holding a symbol name in its
414 decoded form (ie using the Ada dotted notation), returns
415 its unqualified name. */
416
417 static const char *
418 ada_unqualified_name (const char *decoded_name)
419 {
420 const char *result = strrchr (decoded_name, '.');
421
422 if (result != NULL)
423 result++; /* Skip the dot... */
424 else
425 result = decoded_name;
426
427 return result;
428 }
429
430 /* Return a string starting with '<', followed by STR, and '>'.
431 The result is good until the next call. */
432
433 static char *
434 add_angle_brackets (const char *str)
435 {
436 static char *result = NULL;
437
438 xfree (result);
439 result = xstrprintf ("<%s>", str);
440 return result;
441 }
442
443 static char *
444 ada_get_gdb_completer_word_break_characters (void)
445 {
446 return ada_completer_word_break_characters;
447 }
448
449 /* Print an array element index using the Ada syntax. */
450
451 static void
452 ada_print_array_index (struct value *index_value, struct ui_file *stream,
453 const struct value_print_options *options)
454 {
455 LA_VALUE_PRINT (index_value, stream, options);
456 fprintf_filtered (stream, " => ");
457 }
458
459 /* Assuming VECT points to an array of *SIZE objects of size
460 ELEMENT_SIZE, grow it to contain at least MIN_SIZE objects,
461 updating *SIZE as necessary and returning the (new) array. */
462
463 void *
464 grow_vect (void *vect, size_t *size, size_t min_size, int element_size)
465 {
466 if (*size < min_size)
467 {
468 *size *= 2;
469 if (*size < min_size)
470 *size = min_size;
471 vect = xrealloc (vect, *size * element_size);
472 }
473 return vect;
474 }
475
476 /* True (non-zero) iff TARGET matches FIELD_NAME up to any trailing
477 suffix of FIELD_NAME beginning "___". */
478
479 static int
480 field_name_match (const char *field_name, const char *target)
481 {
482 int len = strlen (target);
483
484 return
485 (strncmp (field_name, target, len) == 0
486 && (field_name[len] == '\0'
487 || (strncmp (field_name + len, "___", 3) == 0
488 && strcmp (field_name + strlen (field_name) - 6,
489 "___XVN") != 0)));
490 }
491
492
493 /* Assuming TYPE is a TYPE_CODE_STRUCT or a TYPE_CODE_TYPDEF to
494 a TYPE_CODE_STRUCT, find the field whose name matches FIELD_NAME,
495 and return its index. This function also handles fields whose name
496 have ___ suffixes because the compiler sometimes alters their name
497 by adding such a suffix to represent fields with certain constraints.
498 If the field could not be found, return a negative number if
499 MAYBE_MISSING is set. Otherwise raise an error. */
500
501 int
502 ada_get_field_index (const struct type *type, const char *field_name,
503 int maybe_missing)
504 {
505 int fieldno;
506 struct type *struct_type = check_typedef ((struct type *) type);
507
508 for (fieldno = 0; fieldno < TYPE_NFIELDS (struct_type); fieldno++)
509 if (field_name_match (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (struct_type, fieldno), field_name))
510 return fieldno;
511
512 if (!maybe_missing)
513 error (_("Unable to find field %s in struct %s. Aborting"),
514 field_name, TYPE_NAME (struct_type));
515
516 return -1;
517 }
518
519 /* The length of the prefix of NAME prior to any "___" suffix. */
520
521 int
522 ada_name_prefix_len (const char *name)
523 {
524 if (name == NULL)
525 return 0;
526 else
527 {
528 const char *p = strstr (name, "___");
529
530 if (p == NULL)
531 return strlen (name);
532 else
533 return p - name;
534 }
535 }
536
537 /* Return non-zero if SUFFIX is a suffix of STR.
538 Return zero if STR is null. */
539
540 static int
541 is_suffix (const char *str, const char *suffix)
542 {
543 int len1, len2;
544
545 if (str == NULL)
546 return 0;
547 len1 = strlen (str);
548 len2 = strlen (suffix);
549 return (len1 >= len2 && strcmp (str + len1 - len2, suffix) == 0);
550 }
551
552 /* The contents of value VAL, treated as a value of type TYPE. The
553 result is an lval in memory if VAL is. */
554
555 static struct value *
556 coerce_unspec_val_to_type (struct value *val, struct type *type)
557 {
558 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
559 if (value_type (val) == type)
560 return val;
561 else
562 {
563 struct value *result;
564
565 /* Make sure that the object size is not unreasonable before
566 trying to allocate some memory for it. */
567 check_size (type);
568
569 if (value_lazy (val)
570 || TYPE_LENGTH (type) > TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (val)))
571 result = allocate_value_lazy (type);
572 else
573 {
574 result = allocate_value (type);
575 memcpy (value_contents_raw (result), value_contents (val),
576 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
577 }
578 set_value_component_location (result, val);
579 set_value_bitsize (result, value_bitsize (val));
580 set_value_bitpos (result, value_bitpos (val));
581 set_value_address (result, value_address (val));
582 return result;
583 }
584 }
585
586 static const gdb_byte *
587 cond_offset_host (const gdb_byte *valaddr, long offset)
588 {
589 if (valaddr == NULL)
590 return NULL;
591 else
592 return valaddr + offset;
593 }
594
595 static CORE_ADDR
596 cond_offset_target (CORE_ADDR address, long offset)
597 {
598 if (address == 0)
599 return 0;
600 else
601 return address + offset;
602 }
603
604 /* Issue a warning (as for the definition of warning in utils.c, but
605 with exactly one argument rather than ...), unless the limit on the
606 number of warnings has passed during the evaluation of the current
607 expression. */
608
609 /* FIXME: cagney/2004-10-10: This function is mimicking the behavior
610 provided by "complaint". */
611 static void lim_warning (const char *format, ...) ATTRIBUTE_PRINTF (1, 2);
612
613 static void
614 lim_warning (const char *format, ...)
615 {
616 va_list args;
617
618 va_start (args, format);
619 warnings_issued += 1;
620 if (warnings_issued <= warning_limit)
621 vwarning (format, args);
622
623 va_end (args);
624 }
625
626 /* Issue an error if the size of an object of type T is unreasonable,
627 i.e. if it would be a bad idea to allocate a value of this type in
628 GDB. */
629
630 static void
631 check_size (const struct type *type)
632 {
633 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) > varsize_limit)
634 error (_("object size is larger than varsize-limit"));
635 }
636
637 /* Maximum value of a SIZE-byte signed integer type. */
638 static LONGEST
639 max_of_size (int size)
640 {
641 LONGEST top_bit = (LONGEST) 1 << (size * 8 - 2);
642
643 return top_bit | (top_bit - 1);
644 }
645
646 /* Minimum value of a SIZE-byte signed integer type. */
647 static LONGEST
648 min_of_size (int size)
649 {
650 return -max_of_size (size) - 1;
651 }
652
653 /* Maximum value of a SIZE-byte unsigned integer type. */
654 static ULONGEST
655 umax_of_size (int size)
656 {
657 ULONGEST top_bit = (ULONGEST) 1 << (size * 8 - 1);
658
659 return top_bit | (top_bit - 1);
660 }
661
662 /* Maximum value of integral type T, as a signed quantity. */
663 static LONGEST
664 max_of_type (struct type *t)
665 {
666 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t))
667 return (LONGEST) umax_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
668 else
669 return max_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
670 }
671
672 /* Minimum value of integral type T, as a signed quantity. */
673 static LONGEST
674 min_of_type (struct type *t)
675 {
676 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t))
677 return 0;
678 else
679 return min_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
680 }
681
682 /* The largest value in the domain of TYPE, a discrete type, as an integer. */
683 LONGEST
684 ada_discrete_type_high_bound (struct type *type)
685 {
686 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
687 {
688 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
689 return TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type);
690 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
691 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, TYPE_NFIELDS (type) - 1);
692 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
693 return 1;
694 case TYPE_CODE_CHAR:
695 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
696 return max_of_type (type);
697 default:
698 error (_("Unexpected type in ada_discrete_type_high_bound."));
699 }
700 }
701
702 /* The largest value in the domain of TYPE, a discrete type, as an integer. */
703 LONGEST
704 ada_discrete_type_low_bound (struct type *type)
705 {
706 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
707 {
708 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
709 return TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type);
710 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
711 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, 0);
712 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
713 return 0;
714 case TYPE_CODE_CHAR:
715 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
716 return min_of_type (type);
717 default:
718 error (_("Unexpected type in ada_discrete_type_low_bound."));
719 }
720 }
721
722 /* The identity on non-range types. For range types, the underlying
723 non-range scalar type. */
724
725 static struct type *
726 get_base_type (struct type *type)
727 {
728 while (type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
729 {
730 if (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) || TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) == NULL)
731 return type;
732 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
733 }
734 return type;
735 }
736 \f
737
738 /* Language Selection */
739
740 /* If the main program is in Ada, return language_ada, otherwise return LANG
741 (the main program is in Ada iif the adainit symbol is found). */
742
743 enum language
744 ada_update_initial_language (enum language lang)
745 {
746 if (lookup_minimal_symbol ("adainit", (const char *) NULL,
747 (struct objfile *) NULL) != NULL)
748 return language_ada;
749
750 return lang;
751 }
752
753 /* If the main procedure is written in Ada, then return its name.
754 The result is good until the next call. Return NULL if the main
755 procedure doesn't appear to be in Ada. */
756
757 char *
758 ada_main_name (void)
759 {
760 struct minimal_symbol *msym;
761 static char *main_program_name = NULL;
762
763 /* For Ada, the name of the main procedure is stored in a specific
764 string constant, generated by the binder. Look for that symbol,
765 extract its address, and then read that string. If we didn't find
766 that string, then most probably the main procedure is not written
767 in Ada. */
768 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol (ADA_MAIN_PROGRAM_SYMBOL_NAME, NULL, NULL);
769
770 if (msym != NULL)
771 {
772 CORE_ADDR main_program_name_addr;
773 int err_code;
774
775 main_program_name_addr = SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (msym);
776 if (main_program_name_addr == 0)
777 error (_("Invalid address for Ada main program name."));
778
779 xfree (main_program_name);
780 target_read_string (main_program_name_addr, &main_program_name,
781 1024, &err_code);
782
783 if (err_code != 0)
784 return NULL;
785 return main_program_name;
786 }
787
788 /* The main procedure doesn't seem to be in Ada. */
789 return NULL;
790 }
791 \f
792 /* Symbols */
793
794 /* Table of Ada operators and their GNAT-encoded names. Last entry is pair
795 of NULLs. */
796
797 const struct ada_opname_map ada_opname_table[] = {
798 {"Oadd", "\"+\"", BINOP_ADD},
799 {"Osubtract", "\"-\"", BINOP_SUB},
800 {"Omultiply", "\"*\"", BINOP_MUL},
801 {"Odivide", "\"/\"", BINOP_DIV},
802 {"Omod", "\"mod\"", BINOP_MOD},
803 {"Orem", "\"rem\"", BINOP_REM},
804 {"Oexpon", "\"**\"", BINOP_EXP},
805 {"Olt", "\"<\"", BINOP_LESS},
806 {"Ole", "\"<=\"", BINOP_LEQ},
807 {"Ogt", "\">\"", BINOP_GTR},
808 {"Oge", "\">=\"", BINOP_GEQ},
809 {"Oeq", "\"=\"", BINOP_EQUAL},
810 {"One", "\"/=\"", BINOP_NOTEQUAL},
811 {"Oand", "\"and\"", BINOP_BITWISE_AND},
812 {"Oor", "\"or\"", BINOP_BITWISE_IOR},
813 {"Oxor", "\"xor\"", BINOP_BITWISE_XOR},
814 {"Oconcat", "\"&\"", BINOP_CONCAT},
815 {"Oabs", "\"abs\"", UNOP_ABS},
816 {"Onot", "\"not\"", UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT},
817 {"Oadd", "\"+\"", UNOP_PLUS},
818 {"Osubtract", "\"-\"", UNOP_NEG},
819 {NULL, NULL}
820 };
821
822 /* The "encoded" form of DECODED, according to GNAT conventions.
823 The result is valid until the next call to ada_encode. */
824
825 char *
826 ada_encode (const char *decoded)
827 {
828 static char *encoding_buffer = NULL;
829 static size_t encoding_buffer_size = 0;
830 const char *p;
831 int k;
832
833 if (decoded == NULL)
834 return NULL;
835
836 GROW_VECT (encoding_buffer, encoding_buffer_size,
837 2 * strlen (decoded) + 10);
838
839 k = 0;
840 for (p = decoded; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
841 {
842 if (*p == '.')
843 {
844 encoding_buffer[k] = encoding_buffer[k + 1] = '_';
845 k += 2;
846 }
847 else if (*p == '"')
848 {
849 const struct ada_opname_map *mapping;
850
851 for (mapping = ada_opname_table;
852 mapping->encoded != NULL
853 && strncmp (mapping->decoded, p,
854 strlen (mapping->decoded)) != 0; mapping += 1)
855 ;
856 if (mapping->encoded == NULL)
857 error (_("invalid Ada operator name: %s"), p);
858 strcpy (encoding_buffer + k, mapping->encoded);
859 k += strlen (mapping->encoded);
860 break;
861 }
862 else
863 {
864 encoding_buffer[k] = *p;
865 k += 1;
866 }
867 }
868
869 encoding_buffer[k] = '\0';
870 return encoding_buffer;
871 }
872
873 /* Return NAME folded to lower case, or, if surrounded by single
874 quotes, unfolded, but with the quotes stripped away. Result good
875 to next call. */
876
877 char *
878 ada_fold_name (const char *name)
879 {
880 static char *fold_buffer = NULL;
881 static size_t fold_buffer_size = 0;
882
883 int len = strlen (name);
884 GROW_VECT (fold_buffer, fold_buffer_size, len + 1);
885
886 if (name[0] == '\'')
887 {
888 strncpy (fold_buffer, name + 1, len - 2);
889 fold_buffer[len - 2] = '\000';
890 }
891 else
892 {
893 int i;
894
895 for (i = 0; i <= len; i += 1)
896 fold_buffer[i] = tolower (name[i]);
897 }
898
899 return fold_buffer;
900 }
901
902 /* Return nonzero if C is either a digit or a lowercase alphabet character. */
903
904 static int
905 is_lower_alphanum (const char c)
906 {
907 return (isdigit (c) || (isalpha (c) && islower (c)));
908 }
909
910 /* ENCODED is the linkage name of a symbol and LEN contains its length.
911 This function saves in LEN the length of that same symbol name but
912 without either of these suffixes:
913 . .{DIGIT}+
914 . ${DIGIT}+
915 . ___{DIGIT}+
916 . __{DIGIT}+.
917
918 These are suffixes introduced by the compiler for entities such as
919 nested subprogram for instance, in order to avoid name clashes.
920 They do not serve any purpose for the debugger. */
921
922 static void
923 ada_remove_trailing_digits (const char *encoded, int *len)
924 {
925 if (*len > 1 && isdigit (encoded[*len - 1]))
926 {
927 int i = *len - 2;
928
929 while (i > 0 && isdigit (encoded[i]))
930 i--;
931 if (i >= 0 && encoded[i] == '.')
932 *len = i;
933 else if (i >= 0 && encoded[i] == '$')
934 *len = i;
935 else if (i >= 2 && strncmp (encoded + i - 2, "___", 3) == 0)
936 *len = i - 2;
937 else if (i >= 1 && strncmp (encoded + i - 1, "__", 2) == 0)
938 *len = i - 1;
939 }
940 }
941
942 /* Remove the suffix introduced by the compiler for protected object
943 subprograms. */
944
945 static void
946 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (const char *encoded, int *len)
947 {
948 /* Remove trailing N. */
949
950 /* Protected entry subprograms are broken into two
951 separate subprograms: The first one is unprotected, and has
952 a 'N' suffix; the second is the protected version, and has
953 the 'P' suffix. The second calls the first one after handling
954 the protection. Since the P subprograms are internally generated,
955 we leave these names undecoded, giving the user a clue that this
956 entity is internal. */
957
958 if (*len > 1
959 && encoded[*len - 1] == 'N'
960 && (isdigit (encoded[*len - 2]) || islower (encoded[*len - 2])))
961 *len = *len - 1;
962 }
963
964 /* Remove trailing X[bn]* suffixes (indicating names in package bodies). */
965
966 static void
967 ada_remove_Xbn_suffix (const char *encoded, int *len)
968 {
969 int i = *len - 1;
970
971 while (i > 0 && (encoded[i] == 'b' || encoded[i] == 'n'))
972 i--;
973
974 if (encoded[i] != 'X')
975 return;
976
977 if (i == 0)
978 return;
979
980 if (isalnum (encoded[i-1]))
981 *len = i;
982 }
983
984 /* If ENCODED follows the GNAT entity encoding conventions, then return
985 the decoded form of ENCODED. Otherwise, return "<%s>" where "%s" is
986 replaced by ENCODED.
987
988 The resulting string is valid until the next call of ada_decode.
989 If the string is unchanged by decoding, the original string pointer
990 is returned. */
991
992 const char *
993 ada_decode (const char *encoded)
994 {
995 int i, j;
996 int len0;
997 const char *p;
998 char *decoded;
999 int at_start_name;
1000 static char *decoding_buffer = NULL;
1001 static size_t decoding_buffer_size = 0;
1002
1003 /* The name of the Ada main procedure starts with "_ada_".
1004 This prefix is not part of the decoded name, so skip this part
1005 if we see this prefix. */
1006 if (strncmp (encoded, "_ada_", 5) == 0)
1007 encoded += 5;
1008
1009 /* If the name starts with '_', then it is not a properly encoded
1010 name, so do not attempt to decode it. Similarly, if the name
1011 starts with '<', the name should not be decoded. */
1012 if (encoded[0] == '_' || encoded[0] == '<')
1013 goto Suppress;
1014
1015 len0 = strlen (encoded);
1016
1017 ada_remove_trailing_digits (encoded, &len0);
1018 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (encoded, &len0);
1019
1020 /* Remove the ___X.* suffix if present. Do not forget to verify that
1021 the suffix is located before the current "end" of ENCODED. We want
1022 to avoid re-matching parts of ENCODED that have previously been
1023 marked as discarded (by decrementing LEN0). */
1024 p = strstr (encoded, "___");
1025 if (p != NULL && p - encoded < len0 - 3)
1026 {
1027 if (p[3] == 'X')
1028 len0 = p - encoded;
1029 else
1030 goto Suppress;
1031 }
1032
1033 /* Remove any trailing TKB suffix. It tells us that this symbol
1034 is for the body of a task, but that information does not actually
1035 appear in the decoded name. */
1036
1037 if (len0 > 3 && strncmp (encoded + len0 - 3, "TKB", 3) == 0)
1038 len0 -= 3;
1039
1040 /* Remove any trailing TB suffix. The TB suffix is slightly different
1041 from the TKB suffix because it is used for non-anonymous task
1042 bodies. */
1043
1044 if (len0 > 2 && strncmp (encoded + len0 - 2, "TB", 2) == 0)
1045 len0 -= 2;
1046
1047 /* Remove trailing "B" suffixes. */
1048 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-04-19: Not sure what this are used for... */
1049
1050 if (len0 > 1 && strncmp (encoded + len0 - 1, "B", 1) == 0)
1051 len0 -= 1;
1052
1053 /* Make decoded big enough for possible expansion by operator name. */
1054
1055 GROW_VECT (decoding_buffer, decoding_buffer_size, 2 * len0 + 1);
1056 decoded = decoding_buffer;
1057
1058 /* Remove trailing __{digit}+ or trailing ${digit}+. */
1059
1060 if (len0 > 1 && isdigit (encoded[len0 - 1]))
1061 {
1062 i = len0 - 2;
1063 while ((i >= 0 && isdigit (encoded[i]))
1064 || (i >= 1 && encoded[i] == '_' && isdigit (encoded[i - 1])))
1065 i -= 1;
1066 if (i > 1 && encoded[i] == '_' && encoded[i - 1] == '_')
1067 len0 = i - 1;
1068 else if (encoded[i] == '$')
1069 len0 = i;
1070 }
1071
1072 /* The first few characters that are not alphabetic are not part
1073 of any encoding we use, so we can copy them over verbatim. */
1074
1075 for (i = 0, j = 0; i < len0 && !isalpha (encoded[i]); i += 1, j += 1)
1076 decoded[j] = encoded[i];
1077
1078 at_start_name = 1;
1079 while (i < len0)
1080 {
1081 /* Is this a symbol function? */
1082 if (at_start_name && encoded[i] == 'O')
1083 {
1084 int k;
1085
1086 for (k = 0; ada_opname_table[k].encoded != NULL; k += 1)
1087 {
1088 int op_len = strlen (ada_opname_table[k].encoded);
1089 if ((strncmp (ada_opname_table[k].encoded + 1, encoded + i + 1,
1090 op_len - 1) == 0)
1091 && !isalnum (encoded[i + op_len]))
1092 {
1093 strcpy (decoded + j, ada_opname_table[k].decoded);
1094 at_start_name = 0;
1095 i += op_len;
1096 j += strlen (ada_opname_table[k].decoded);
1097 break;
1098 }
1099 }
1100 if (ada_opname_table[k].encoded != NULL)
1101 continue;
1102 }
1103 at_start_name = 0;
1104
1105 /* Replace "TK__" with "__", which will eventually be translated
1106 into "." (just below). */
1107
1108 if (i < len0 - 4 && strncmp (encoded + i, "TK__", 4) == 0)
1109 i += 2;
1110
1111 /* Replace "__B_{DIGITS}+__" sequences by "__", which will eventually
1112 be translated into "." (just below). These are internal names
1113 generated for anonymous blocks inside which our symbol is nested. */
1114
1115 if (len0 - i > 5 && encoded [i] == '_' && encoded [i+1] == '_'
1116 && encoded [i+2] == 'B' && encoded [i+3] == '_'
1117 && isdigit (encoded [i+4]))
1118 {
1119 int k = i + 5;
1120
1121 while (k < len0 && isdigit (encoded[k]))
1122 k++; /* Skip any extra digit. */
1123
1124 /* Double-check that the "__B_{DIGITS}+" sequence we found
1125 is indeed followed by "__". */
1126 if (len0 - k > 2 && encoded [k] == '_' && encoded [k+1] == '_')
1127 i = k;
1128 }
1129
1130 /* Remove _E{DIGITS}+[sb] */
1131
1132 /* Just as for protected object subprograms, there are 2 categories
1133 of subprograms created by the compiler for each entry. The first
1134 one implements the actual entry code, and has a suffix following
1135 the convention above; the second one implements the barrier and
1136 uses the same convention as above, except that the 'E' is replaced
1137 by a 'B'.
1138
1139 Just as above, we do not decode the name of barrier functions
1140 to give the user a clue that the code he is debugging has been
1141 internally generated. */
1142
1143 if (len0 - i > 3 && encoded [i] == '_' && encoded[i+1] == 'E'
1144 && isdigit (encoded[i+2]))
1145 {
1146 int k = i + 3;
1147
1148 while (k < len0 && isdigit (encoded[k]))
1149 k++;
1150
1151 if (k < len0
1152 && (encoded[k] == 'b' || encoded[k] == 's'))
1153 {
1154 k++;
1155 /* Just as an extra precaution, make sure that if this
1156 suffix is followed by anything else, it is a '_'.
1157 Otherwise, we matched this sequence by accident. */
1158 if (k == len0
1159 || (k < len0 && encoded[k] == '_'))
1160 i = k;
1161 }
1162 }
1163
1164 /* Remove trailing "N" in [a-z0-9]+N__. The N is added by
1165 the GNAT front-end in protected object subprograms. */
1166
1167 if (i < len0 + 3
1168 && encoded[i] == 'N' && encoded[i+1] == '_' && encoded[i+2] == '_')
1169 {
1170 /* Backtrack a bit up until we reach either the begining of
1171 the encoded name, or "__". Make sure that we only find
1172 digits or lowercase characters. */
1173 const char *ptr = encoded + i - 1;
1174
1175 while (ptr >= encoded && is_lower_alphanum (ptr[0]))
1176 ptr--;
1177 if (ptr < encoded
1178 || (ptr > encoded && ptr[0] == '_' && ptr[-1] == '_'))
1179 i++;
1180 }
1181
1182 if (encoded[i] == 'X' && i != 0 && isalnum (encoded[i - 1]))
1183 {
1184 /* This is a X[bn]* sequence not separated from the previous
1185 part of the name with a non-alpha-numeric character (in other
1186 words, immediately following an alpha-numeric character), then
1187 verify that it is placed at the end of the encoded name. If
1188 not, then the encoding is not valid and we should abort the
1189 decoding. Otherwise, just skip it, it is used in body-nested
1190 package names. */
1191 do
1192 i += 1;
1193 while (i < len0 && (encoded[i] == 'b' || encoded[i] == 'n'));
1194 if (i < len0)
1195 goto Suppress;
1196 }
1197 else if (i < len0 - 2 && encoded[i] == '_' && encoded[i + 1] == '_')
1198 {
1199 /* Replace '__' by '.'. */
1200 decoded[j] = '.';
1201 at_start_name = 1;
1202 i += 2;
1203 j += 1;
1204 }
1205 else
1206 {
1207 /* It's a character part of the decoded name, so just copy it
1208 over. */
1209 decoded[j] = encoded[i];
1210 i += 1;
1211 j += 1;
1212 }
1213 }
1214 decoded[j] = '\000';
1215
1216 /* Decoded names should never contain any uppercase character.
1217 Double-check this, and abort the decoding if we find one. */
1218
1219 for (i = 0; decoded[i] != '\0'; i += 1)
1220 if (isupper (decoded[i]) || decoded[i] == ' ')
1221 goto Suppress;
1222
1223 if (strcmp (decoded, encoded) == 0)
1224 return encoded;
1225 else
1226 return decoded;
1227
1228 Suppress:
1229 GROW_VECT (decoding_buffer, decoding_buffer_size, strlen (encoded) + 3);
1230 decoded = decoding_buffer;
1231 if (encoded[0] == '<')
1232 strcpy (decoded, encoded);
1233 else
1234 xsnprintf (decoded, decoding_buffer_size, "<%s>", encoded);
1235 return decoded;
1236
1237 }
1238
1239 /* Table for keeping permanent unique copies of decoded names. Once
1240 allocated, names in this table are never released. While this is a
1241 storage leak, it should not be significant unless there are massive
1242 changes in the set of decoded names in successive versions of a
1243 symbol table loaded during a single session. */
1244 static struct htab *decoded_names_store;
1245
1246 /* Returns the decoded name of GSYMBOL, as for ada_decode, caching it
1247 in the language-specific part of GSYMBOL, if it has not been
1248 previously computed. Tries to save the decoded name in the same
1249 obstack as GSYMBOL, if possible, and otherwise on the heap (so that,
1250 in any case, the decoded symbol has a lifetime at least that of
1251 GSYMBOL).
1252 The GSYMBOL parameter is "mutable" in the C++ sense: logically
1253 const, but nevertheless modified to a semantically equivalent form
1254 when a decoded name is cached in it. */
1255
1256 char *
1257 ada_decode_symbol (const struct general_symbol_info *gsymbol)
1258 {
1259 char **resultp =
1260 (char **) &gsymbol->language_specific.mangled_lang.demangled_name;
1261
1262 if (*resultp == NULL)
1263 {
1264 const char *decoded = ada_decode (gsymbol->name);
1265
1266 if (gsymbol->obj_section != NULL)
1267 {
1268 struct objfile *objf = gsymbol->obj_section->objfile;
1269
1270 *resultp = obsavestring (decoded, strlen (decoded),
1271 &objf->objfile_obstack);
1272 }
1273 /* Sometimes, we can't find a corresponding objfile, in which
1274 case, we put the result on the heap. Since we only decode
1275 when needed, we hope this usually does not cause a
1276 significant memory leak (FIXME). */
1277 if (*resultp == NULL)
1278 {
1279 char **slot = (char **) htab_find_slot (decoded_names_store,
1280 decoded, INSERT);
1281
1282 if (*slot == NULL)
1283 *slot = xstrdup (decoded);
1284 *resultp = *slot;
1285 }
1286 }
1287
1288 return *resultp;
1289 }
1290
1291 static char *
1292 ada_la_decode (const char *encoded, int options)
1293 {
1294 return xstrdup (ada_decode (encoded));
1295 }
1296
1297 /* Returns non-zero iff SYM_NAME matches NAME, ignoring any trailing
1298 suffixes that encode debugging information or leading _ada_ on
1299 SYM_NAME (see is_name_suffix commentary for the debugging
1300 information that is ignored). If WILD, then NAME need only match a
1301 suffix of SYM_NAME minus the same suffixes. Also returns 0 if
1302 either argument is NULL. */
1303
1304 static int
1305 match_name (const char *sym_name, const char *name, int wild)
1306 {
1307 if (sym_name == NULL || name == NULL)
1308 return 0;
1309 else if (wild)
1310 return wild_match (sym_name, name) == 0;
1311 else
1312 {
1313 int len_name = strlen (name);
1314
1315 return (strncmp (sym_name, name, len_name) == 0
1316 && is_name_suffix (sym_name + len_name))
1317 || (strncmp (sym_name, "_ada_", 5) == 0
1318 && strncmp (sym_name + 5, name, len_name) == 0
1319 && is_name_suffix (sym_name + len_name + 5));
1320 }
1321 }
1322 \f
1323
1324 /* Arrays */
1325
1326 /* Assuming that INDEX_DESC_TYPE is an ___XA structure, a structure
1327 generated by the GNAT compiler to describe the index type used
1328 for each dimension of an array, check whether it follows the latest
1329 known encoding. If not, fix it up to conform to the latest encoding.
1330 Otherwise, do nothing. This function also does nothing if
1331 INDEX_DESC_TYPE is NULL.
1332
1333 The GNAT encoding used to describle the array index type evolved a bit.
1334 Initially, the information would be provided through the name of each
1335 field of the structure type only, while the type of these fields was
1336 described as unspecified and irrelevant. The debugger was then expected
1337 to perform a global type lookup using the name of that field in order
1338 to get access to the full index type description. Because these global
1339 lookups can be very expensive, the encoding was later enhanced to make
1340 the global lookup unnecessary by defining the field type as being
1341 the full index type description.
1342
1343 The purpose of this routine is to allow us to support older versions
1344 of the compiler by detecting the use of the older encoding, and by
1345 fixing up the INDEX_DESC_TYPE to follow the new one (at this point,
1346 we essentially replace each field's meaningless type by the associated
1347 index subtype). */
1348
1349 void
1350 ada_fixup_array_indexes_type (struct type *index_desc_type)
1351 {
1352 int i;
1353
1354 if (index_desc_type == NULL)
1355 return;
1356 gdb_assert (TYPE_NFIELDS (index_desc_type) > 0);
1357
1358 /* Check if INDEX_DESC_TYPE follows the older encoding (it is sufficient
1359 to check one field only, no need to check them all). If not, return
1360 now.
1361
1362 If our INDEX_DESC_TYPE was generated using the older encoding,
1363 the field type should be a meaningless integer type whose name
1364 is not equal to the field name. */
1365 if (TYPE_NAME (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_desc_type, 0)) != NULL
1366 && strcmp (TYPE_NAME (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_desc_type, 0)),
1367 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (index_desc_type, 0)) == 0)
1368 return;
1369
1370 /* Fixup each field of INDEX_DESC_TYPE. */
1371 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (index_desc_type); i++)
1372 {
1373 char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (index_desc_type, i);
1374 struct type *raw_type = ada_check_typedef (ada_find_any_type (name));
1375
1376 if (raw_type)
1377 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_desc_type, i) = raw_type;
1378 }
1379 }
1380
1381 /* Names of MAX_ADA_DIMENS bounds in P_BOUNDS fields of array descriptors. */
1382
1383 static char *bound_name[] = {
1384 "LB0", "UB0", "LB1", "UB1", "LB2", "UB2", "LB3", "UB3",
1385 "LB4", "UB4", "LB5", "UB5", "LB6", "UB6", "LB7", "UB7"
1386 };
1387
1388 /* Maximum number of array dimensions we are prepared to handle. */
1389
1390 #define MAX_ADA_DIMENS (sizeof(bound_name) / (2*sizeof(char *)))
1391
1392
1393 /* The desc_* routines return primitive portions of array descriptors
1394 (fat pointers). */
1395
1396 /* The descriptor or array type, if any, indicated by TYPE; removes
1397 level of indirection, if needed. */
1398
1399 static struct type *
1400 desc_base_type (struct type *type)
1401 {
1402 if (type == NULL)
1403 return NULL;
1404 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1405 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
1406 type = ada_typedef_target_type (type);
1407
1408 if (type != NULL
1409 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1410 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF))
1411 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
1412 else
1413 return type;
1414 }
1415
1416 /* True iff TYPE indicates a "thin" array pointer type. */
1417
1418 static int
1419 is_thin_pntr (struct type *type)
1420 {
1421 return
1422 is_suffix (ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type)), "___XUT")
1423 || is_suffix (ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type)), "___XUT___XVE");
1424 }
1425
1426 /* The descriptor type for thin pointer type TYPE. */
1427
1428 static struct type *
1429 thin_descriptor_type (struct type *type)
1430 {
1431 struct type *base_type = desc_base_type (type);
1432
1433 if (base_type == NULL)
1434 return NULL;
1435 if (is_suffix (ada_type_name (base_type), "___XVE"))
1436 return base_type;
1437 else
1438 {
1439 struct type *alt_type = ada_find_parallel_type (base_type, "___XVE");
1440
1441 if (alt_type == NULL)
1442 return base_type;
1443 else
1444 return alt_type;
1445 }
1446 }
1447
1448 /* A pointer to the array data for thin-pointer value VAL. */
1449
1450 static struct value *
1451 thin_data_pntr (struct value *val)
1452 {
1453 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (val));
1454 struct type *data_type = desc_data_target_type (thin_descriptor_type (type));
1455
1456 data_type = lookup_pointer_type (data_type);
1457
1458 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1459 return value_cast (data_type, value_copy (val));
1460 else
1461 return value_from_longest (data_type, value_address (val));
1462 }
1463
1464 /* True iff TYPE indicates a "thick" array pointer type. */
1465
1466 static int
1467 is_thick_pntr (struct type *type)
1468 {
1469 type = desc_base_type (type);
1470 return (type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1471 && lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1) != NULL);
1472 }
1473
1474 /* If TYPE is the type of an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer) or a
1475 pointer to one, the type of its bounds data; otherwise, NULL. */
1476
1477 static struct type *
1478 desc_bounds_type (struct type *type)
1479 {
1480 struct type *r;
1481
1482 type = desc_base_type (type);
1483
1484 if (type == NULL)
1485 return NULL;
1486 else if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1487 {
1488 type = thin_descriptor_type (type);
1489 if (type == NULL)
1490 return NULL;
1491 r = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "BOUNDS", 1);
1492 if (r != NULL)
1493 return ada_check_typedef (r);
1494 }
1495 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
1496 {
1497 r = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1);
1498 if (r != NULL)
1499 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ada_check_typedef (r)));
1500 }
1501 return NULL;
1502 }
1503
1504 /* If ARR is an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer), or pointer to
1505 one, a pointer to its bounds data. Otherwise NULL. */
1506
1507 static struct value *
1508 desc_bounds (struct value *arr)
1509 {
1510 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
1511
1512 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1513 {
1514 struct type *bounds_type =
1515 desc_bounds_type (thin_descriptor_type (type));
1516 LONGEST addr;
1517
1518 if (bounds_type == NULL)
1519 error (_("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1520
1521 /* NOTE: The following calculation is not really kosher, but
1522 since desc_type is an XVE-encoded type (and shouldn't be),
1523 the correct calculation is a real pain. FIXME (and fix GCC). */
1524 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1525 addr = value_as_long (arr);
1526 else
1527 addr = value_address (arr);
1528
1529 return
1530 value_from_longest (lookup_pointer_type (bounds_type),
1531 addr - TYPE_LENGTH (bounds_type));
1532 }
1533
1534 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1535 {
1536 struct value *p_bounds = value_struct_elt (&arr, NULL, "P_BOUNDS", NULL,
1537 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1538 struct type *p_bounds_type = value_type (p_bounds);
1539
1540 if (p_bounds_type
1541 && TYPE_CODE (p_bounds_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1542 {
1543 struct type *target_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (p_bounds_type);
1544
1545 if (TYPE_STUB (target_type))
1546 p_bounds = value_cast (lookup_pointer_type
1547 (ada_check_typedef (target_type)),
1548 p_bounds);
1549 }
1550 else
1551 error (_("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1552
1553 return p_bounds;
1554 }
1555 else
1556 return NULL;
1557 }
1558
1559 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1560 position of the field containing the address of the bounds data. */
1561
1562 static int
1563 fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (struct type *type)
1564 {
1565 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 1);
1566 }
1567
1568 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1569 size of the field containing the address of the bounds data. */
1570
1571 static int
1572 fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (struct type *type)
1573 {
1574 type = desc_base_type (type);
1575
1576 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 1) > 0)
1577 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 1);
1578 else
1579 return 8 * TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 1)));
1580 }
1581
1582 /* If TYPE is the type of an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer) or a
1583 pointer to one, the type of its array data (a array-with-no-bounds type);
1584 otherwise, NULL. Use ada_type_of_array to get an array type with bounds
1585 data. */
1586
1587 static struct type *
1588 desc_data_target_type (struct type *type)
1589 {
1590 type = desc_base_type (type);
1591
1592 /* NOTE: The following is bogus; see comment in desc_bounds. */
1593 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1594 return desc_base_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (thin_descriptor_type (type), 1));
1595 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1596 {
1597 struct type *data_type = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_ARRAY", 1);
1598
1599 if (data_type
1600 && TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (data_type)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1601 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (data_type));
1602 }
1603
1604 return NULL;
1605 }
1606
1607 /* If ARR is an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer), a pointer to
1608 its array data. */
1609
1610 static struct value *
1611 desc_data (struct value *arr)
1612 {
1613 struct type *type = value_type (arr);
1614
1615 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1616 return thin_data_pntr (arr);
1617 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1618 return value_struct_elt (&arr, NULL, "P_ARRAY", NULL,
1619 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1620 else
1621 return NULL;
1622 }
1623
1624
1625 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1626 position of the field containing the address of the data. */
1627
1628 static int
1629 fat_pntr_data_bitpos (struct type *type)
1630 {
1631 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 0);
1632 }
1633
1634 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1635 size of the field containing the address of the data. */
1636
1637 static int
1638 fat_pntr_data_bitsize (struct type *type)
1639 {
1640 type = desc_base_type (type);
1641
1642 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0) > 0)
1643 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0);
1644 else
1645 return TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0));
1646 }
1647
1648 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure (or pointer to one), return
1649 the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1650 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1651
1652 static struct value *
1653 desc_one_bound (struct value *bounds, int i, int which)
1654 {
1655 return value_struct_elt (&bounds, NULL, bound_name[2 * i + which - 2], NULL,
1656 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor bounds"));
1657 }
1658
1659 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure type, return the bit position
1660 of the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1661 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1662
1663 static int
1664 desc_bound_bitpos (struct type *type, int i, int which)
1665 {
1666 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 2 * i + which - 2);
1667 }
1668
1669 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure type, return the bit field size
1670 of the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1671 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1672
1673 static int
1674 desc_bound_bitsize (struct type *type, int i, int which)
1675 {
1676 type = desc_base_type (type);
1677
1678 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 2 * i + which - 2) > 0)
1679 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 2 * i + which - 2);
1680 else
1681 return 8 * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 2 * i + which - 2));
1682 }
1683
1684 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-bounds structure, the type of its
1685 Ith bound (numbering from 1). Otherwise, NULL. */
1686
1687 static struct type *
1688 desc_index_type (struct type *type, int i)
1689 {
1690 type = desc_base_type (type);
1691
1692 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
1693 return lookup_struct_elt_type (type, bound_name[2 * i - 2], 1);
1694 else
1695 return NULL;
1696 }
1697
1698 /* The number of index positions in the array-bounds type TYPE.
1699 Return 0 if TYPE is NULL. */
1700
1701 static int
1702 desc_arity (struct type *type)
1703 {
1704 type = desc_base_type (type);
1705
1706 if (type != NULL)
1707 return TYPE_NFIELDS (type) / 2;
1708 return 0;
1709 }
1710
1711 /* Non-zero iff TYPE is a simple array type (not a pointer to one) or
1712 an array descriptor type (representing an unconstrained array
1713 type). */
1714
1715 static int
1716 ada_is_direct_array_type (struct type *type)
1717 {
1718 if (type == NULL)
1719 return 0;
1720 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1721 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1722 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type));
1723 }
1724
1725 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents any kind of array in Ada, or a pointer
1726 * to one. */
1727
1728 static int
1729 ada_is_array_type (struct type *type)
1730 {
1731 while (type != NULL
1732 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1733 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF))
1734 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
1735 return ada_is_direct_array_type (type);
1736 }
1737
1738 /* Non-zero iff TYPE is a simple array type or pointer to one. */
1739
1740 int
1741 ada_is_simple_array_type (struct type *type)
1742 {
1743 if (type == NULL)
1744 return 0;
1745 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1746 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1747 || (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1748 && TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)))
1749 == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY));
1750 }
1751
1752 /* Non-zero iff TYPE belongs to a GNAT array descriptor. */
1753
1754 int
1755 ada_is_array_descriptor_type (struct type *type)
1756 {
1757 struct type *data_type = desc_data_target_type (type);
1758
1759 if (type == NULL)
1760 return 0;
1761 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1762 return (data_type != NULL
1763 && TYPE_CODE (data_type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1764 && desc_arity (desc_bounds_type (type)) > 0);
1765 }
1766
1767 /* Non-zero iff type is a partially mal-formed GNAT array
1768 descriptor. FIXME: This is to compensate for some problems with
1769 debugging output from GNAT. Re-examine periodically to see if it
1770 is still needed. */
1771
1772 int
1773 ada_is_bogus_array_descriptor (struct type *type)
1774 {
1775 return
1776 type != NULL
1777 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1778 && (lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1) != NULL
1779 || lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_ARRAY", 1) != NULL)
1780 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
1781 }
1782
1783
1784 /* If ARR has a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array descriptor,
1785 (fat pointer) returns the type of the array data described---specifically,
1786 a pointer-to-array type. If BOUNDS is non-zero, the bounds data are filled
1787 in from the descriptor; otherwise, they are left unspecified. If
1788 the ARR denotes a null array descriptor and BOUNDS is non-zero,
1789 returns NULL. The result is simply the type of ARR if ARR is not
1790 a descriptor. */
1791 struct type *
1792 ada_type_of_array (struct value *arr, int bounds)
1793 {
1794 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1795 return decode_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr));
1796
1797 if (!ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1798 return value_type (arr);
1799
1800 if (!bounds)
1801 {
1802 struct type *array_type =
1803 ada_check_typedef (desc_data_target_type (value_type (arr)));
1804
1805 if (ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1806 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (array_type, 0) =
1807 decode_packed_array_bitsize (value_type (arr));
1808
1809 return array_type;
1810 }
1811 else
1812 {
1813 struct type *elt_type;
1814 int arity;
1815 struct value *descriptor;
1816
1817 elt_type = ada_array_element_type (value_type (arr), -1);
1818 arity = ada_array_arity (value_type (arr));
1819
1820 if (elt_type == NULL || arity == 0)
1821 return ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
1822
1823 descriptor = desc_bounds (arr);
1824 if (value_as_long (descriptor) == 0)
1825 return NULL;
1826 while (arity > 0)
1827 {
1828 struct type *range_type = alloc_type_copy (value_type (arr));
1829 struct type *array_type = alloc_type_copy (value_type (arr));
1830 struct value *low = desc_one_bound (descriptor, arity, 0);
1831 struct value *high = desc_one_bound (descriptor, arity, 1);
1832
1833 arity -= 1;
1834 create_range_type (range_type, value_type (low),
1835 longest_to_int (value_as_long (low)),
1836 longest_to_int (value_as_long (high)));
1837 elt_type = create_array_type (array_type, elt_type, range_type);
1838
1839 if (ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1840 {
1841 /* We need to store the element packed bitsize, as well as
1842 recompute the array size, because it was previously
1843 computed based on the unpacked element size. */
1844 LONGEST lo = value_as_long (low);
1845 LONGEST hi = value_as_long (high);
1846
1847 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) =
1848 decode_packed_array_bitsize (value_type (arr));
1849 /* If the array has no element, then the size is already
1850 zero, and does not need to be recomputed. */
1851 if (lo < hi)
1852 {
1853 int array_bitsize =
1854 (hi - lo + 1) * TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0);
1855
1856 TYPE_LENGTH (array_type) = (array_bitsize + 7) / 8;
1857 }
1858 }
1859 }
1860
1861 return lookup_pointer_type (elt_type);
1862 }
1863 }
1864
1865 /* If ARR does not represent an array, returns ARR unchanged.
1866 Otherwise, returns either a standard GDB array with bounds set
1867 appropriately or, if ARR is a non-null fat pointer, a pointer to a standard
1868 GDB array. Returns NULL if ARR is a null fat pointer. */
1869
1870 struct value *
1871 ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (struct value *arr)
1872 {
1873 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1874 {
1875 struct type *arrType = ada_type_of_array (arr, 1);
1876
1877 if (arrType == NULL)
1878 return NULL;
1879 return value_cast (arrType, value_copy (desc_data (arr)));
1880 }
1881 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1882 return decode_constrained_packed_array (arr);
1883 else
1884 return arr;
1885 }
1886
1887 /* If ARR does not represent an array, returns ARR unchanged.
1888 Otherwise, returns a standard GDB array describing ARR (which may
1889 be ARR itself if it already is in the proper form). */
1890
1891 struct value *
1892 ada_coerce_to_simple_array (struct value *arr)
1893 {
1894 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1895 {
1896 struct value *arrVal = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (arr);
1897
1898 if (arrVal == NULL)
1899 error (_("Bounds unavailable for null array pointer."));
1900 check_size (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (arrVal)));
1901 return value_ind (arrVal);
1902 }
1903 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1904 return decode_constrained_packed_array (arr);
1905 else
1906 return arr;
1907 }
1908
1909 /* If TYPE represents a GNAT array type, return it translated to an
1910 ordinary GDB array type (possibly with BITSIZE fields indicating
1911 packing). For other types, is the identity. */
1912
1913 struct type *
1914 ada_coerce_to_simple_array_type (struct type *type)
1915 {
1916 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type))
1917 return decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type);
1918
1919 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
1920 return ada_check_typedef (desc_data_target_type (type));
1921
1922 return type;
1923 }
1924
1925 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents a standard GNAT packed-array type. */
1926
1927 static int
1928 ada_is_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
1929 {
1930 if (type == NULL)
1931 return 0;
1932 type = desc_base_type (type);
1933 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1934 return
1935 ada_type_name (type) != NULL
1936 && strstr (ada_type_name (type), "___XP") != NULL;
1937 }
1938
1939 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents a standard GNAT constrained
1940 packed-array type. */
1941
1942 int
1943 ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
1944 {
1945 return ada_is_packed_array_type (type)
1946 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
1947 }
1948
1949 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents an array descriptor for a
1950 unconstrained packed-array type. */
1951
1952 static int
1953 ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
1954 {
1955 return ada_is_packed_array_type (type)
1956 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
1957 }
1958
1959 /* Given that TYPE encodes a packed array type (constrained or unconstrained),
1960 return the size of its elements in bits. */
1961
1962 static long
1963 decode_packed_array_bitsize (struct type *type)
1964 {
1965 char *raw_name;
1966 char *tail;
1967 long bits;
1968
1969 /* Access to arrays implemented as fat pointers are encoded as a typedef
1970 of the fat pointer type. We need the name of the fat pointer type
1971 to do the decoding, so strip the typedef layer. */
1972 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
1973 type = ada_typedef_target_type (type);
1974
1975 raw_name = ada_type_name (ada_check_typedef (type));
1976 if (!raw_name)
1977 raw_name = ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type));
1978
1979 if (!raw_name)
1980 return 0;
1981
1982 tail = strstr (raw_name, "___XP");
1983 gdb_assert (tail != NULL);
1984
1985 if (sscanf (tail + sizeof ("___XP") - 1, "%ld", &bits) != 1)
1986 {
1987 lim_warning
1988 (_("could not understand bit size information on packed array"));
1989 return 0;
1990 }
1991
1992 return bits;
1993 }
1994
1995 /* Given that TYPE is a standard GDB array type with all bounds filled
1996 in, and that the element size of its ultimate scalar constituents
1997 (that is, either its elements, or, if it is an array of arrays, its
1998 elements' elements, etc.) is *ELT_BITS, return an identical type,
1999 but with the bit sizes of its elements (and those of any
2000 constituent arrays) recorded in the BITSIZE components of its
2001 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE values, and with *ELT_BITS set to its total size
2002 in bits. */
2003
2004 static struct type *
2005 constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type, long *elt_bits)
2006 {
2007 struct type *new_elt_type;
2008 struct type *new_type;
2009 LONGEST low_bound, high_bound;
2010
2011 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
2012 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2013 return type;
2014
2015 new_type = alloc_type_copy (type);
2016 new_elt_type =
2017 constrained_packed_array_type (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)),
2018 elt_bits);
2019 create_array_type (new_type, new_elt_type, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type));
2020 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (new_type, 0) = *elt_bits;
2021 TYPE_NAME (new_type) = ada_type_name (type);
2022
2023 if (get_discrete_bounds (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type),
2024 &low_bound, &high_bound) < 0)
2025 low_bound = high_bound = 0;
2026 if (high_bound < low_bound)
2027 *elt_bits = TYPE_LENGTH (new_type) = 0;
2028 else
2029 {
2030 *elt_bits *= (high_bound - low_bound + 1);
2031 TYPE_LENGTH (new_type) =
2032 (*elt_bits + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2033 }
2034
2035 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (new_type) = 1;
2036 return new_type;
2037 }
2038
2039 /* The array type encoded by TYPE, where
2040 ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (TYPE). */
2041
2042 static struct type *
2043 decode_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
2044 {
2045 char *raw_name = ada_type_name (ada_check_typedef (type));
2046 char *name;
2047 char *tail;
2048 struct type *shadow_type;
2049 long bits;
2050
2051 if (!raw_name)
2052 raw_name = ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type));
2053
2054 if (!raw_name)
2055 return NULL;
2056
2057 name = (char *) alloca (strlen (raw_name) + 1);
2058 tail = strstr (raw_name, "___XP");
2059 type = desc_base_type (type);
2060
2061 memcpy (name, raw_name, tail - raw_name);
2062 name[tail - raw_name] = '\000';
2063
2064 shadow_type = ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (type, name);
2065
2066 if (shadow_type == NULL)
2067 {
2068 lim_warning (_("could not find bounds information on packed array"));
2069 return NULL;
2070 }
2071 CHECK_TYPEDEF (shadow_type);
2072
2073 if (TYPE_CODE (shadow_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2074 {
2075 lim_warning (_("could not understand bounds "
2076 "information on packed array"));
2077 return NULL;
2078 }
2079
2080 bits = decode_packed_array_bitsize (type);
2081 return constrained_packed_array_type (shadow_type, &bits);
2082 }
2083
2084 /* Given that ARR is a struct value *indicating a GNAT constrained packed
2085 array, returns a simple array that denotes that array. Its type is a
2086 standard GDB array type except that the BITSIZEs of the array
2087 target types are set to the number of bits in each element, and the
2088 type length is set appropriately. */
2089
2090 static struct value *
2091 decode_constrained_packed_array (struct value *arr)
2092 {
2093 struct type *type;
2094
2095 arr = ada_coerce_ref (arr);
2096
2097 /* If our value is a pointer, then dererence it. Make sure that
2098 this operation does not cause the target type to be fixed, as
2099 this would indirectly cause this array to be decoded. The rest
2100 of the routine assumes that the array hasn't been decoded yet,
2101 so we use the basic "value_ind" routine to perform the dereferencing,
2102 as opposed to using "ada_value_ind". */
2103 if (TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr))) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
2104 arr = value_ind (arr);
2105
2106 type = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr));
2107 if (type == NULL)
2108 {
2109 error (_("can't unpack array"));
2110 return NULL;
2111 }
2112
2113 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (value_type (arr)))
2114 && ada_is_modular_type (value_type (arr)))
2115 {
2116 /* This is a (right-justified) modular type representing a packed
2117 array with no wrapper. In order to interpret the value through
2118 the (left-justified) packed array type we just built, we must
2119 first left-justify it. */
2120 int bit_size, bit_pos;
2121 ULONGEST mod;
2122
2123 mod = ada_modulus (value_type (arr)) - 1;
2124 bit_size = 0;
2125 while (mod > 0)
2126 {
2127 bit_size += 1;
2128 mod >>= 1;
2129 }
2130 bit_pos = HOST_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arr)) - bit_size;
2131 arr = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arr, NULL,
2132 bit_pos / HOST_CHAR_BIT,
2133 bit_pos % HOST_CHAR_BIT,
2134 bit_size,
2135 type);
2136 }
2137
2138 return coerce_unspec_val_to_type (arr, type);
2139 }
2140
2141
2142 /* The value of the element of packed array ARR at the ARITY indices
2143 given in IND. ARR must be a simple array. */
2144
2145 static struct value *
2146 value_subscript_packed (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind)
2147 {
2148 int i;
2149 int bits, elt_off, bit_off;
2150 long elt_total_bit_offset;
2151 struct type *elt_type;
2152 struct value *v;
2153
2154 bits = 0;
2155 elt_total_bit_offset = 0;
2156 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
2157 for (i = 0; i < arity; i += 1)
2158 {
2159 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
2160 || TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) == 0)
2161 error
2162 (_("attempt to do packed indexing of "
2163 "something other than a packed array"));
2164 else
2165 {
2166 struct type *range_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (elt_type);
2167 LONGEST lowerbound, upperbound;
2168 LONGEST idx;
2169
2170 if (get_discrete_bounds (range_type, &lowerbound, &upperbound) < 0)
2171 {
2172 lim_warning (_("don't know bounds of array"));
2173 lowerbound = upperbound = 0;
2174 }
2175
2176 idx = pos_atr (ind[i]);
2177 if (idx < lowerbound || idx > upperbound)
2178 lim_warning (_("packed array index %ld out of bounds"),
2179 (long) idx);
2180 bits = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0);
2181 elt_total_bit_offset += (idx - lowerbound) * bits;
2182 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type));
2183 }
2184 }
2185 elt_off = elt_total_bit_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2186 bit_off = elt_total_bit_offset % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2187
2188 v = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arr, NULL, elt_off, bit_off,
2189 bits, elt_type);
2190 return v;
2191 }
2192
2193 /* Non-zero iff TYPE includes negative integer values. */
2194
2195 static int
2196 has_negatives (struct type *type)
2197 {
2198 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
2199 {
2200 default:
2201 return 0;
2202 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
2203 return !TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
2204 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
2205 return TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type) < 0;
2206 }
2207 }
2208
2209
2210 /* Create a new value of type TYPE from the contents of OBJ starting
2211 at byte OFFSET, and bit offset BIT_OFFSET within that byte,
2212 proceeding for BIT_SIZE bits. If OBJ is an lval in memory, then
2213 assigning through the result will set the field fetched from.
2214 VALADDR is ignored unless OBJ is NULL, in which case,
2215 VALADDR+OFFSET must address the start of storage containing the
2216 packed value. The value returned in this case is never an lval.
2217 Assumes 0 <= BIT_OFFSET < HOST_CHAR_BIT. */
2218
2219 struct value *
2220 ada_value_primitive_packed_val (struct value *obj, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
2221 long offset, int bit_offset, int bit_size,
2222 struct type *type)
2223 {
2224 struct value *v;
2225 int src, /* Index into the source area */
2226 targ, /* Index into the target area */
2227 srcBitsLeft, /* Number of source bits left to move */
2228 nsrc, ntarg, /* Number of source and target bytes */
2229 unusedLS, /* Number of bits in next significant
2230 byte of source that are unused */
2231 accumSize; /* Number of meaningful bits in accum */
2232 unsigned char *bytes; /* First byte containing data to unpack */
2233 unsigned char *unpacked;
2234 unsigned long accum; /* Staging area for bits being transferred */
2235 unsigned char sign;
2236 int len = (bit_size + bit_offset + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / 8;
2237 /* Transmit bytes from least to most significant; delta is the direction
2238 the indices move. */
2239 int delta = gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (type)) ? -1 : 1;
2240
2241 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
2242
2243 if (obj == NULL)
2244 {
2245 v = allocate_value (type);
2246 bytes = (unsigned char *) (valaddr + offset);
2247 }
2248 else if (VALUE_LVAL (obj) == lval_memory && value_lazy (obj))
2249 {
2250 v = value_at (type,
2251 value_address (obj) + offset);
2252 bytes = (unsigned char *) alloca (len);
2253 read_memory (value_address (v), bytes, len);
2254 }
2255 else
2256 {
2257 v = allocate_value (type);
2258 bytes = (unsigned char *) value_contents (obj) + offset;
2259 }
2260
2261 if (obj != NULL)
2262 {
2263 CORE_ADDR new_addr;
2264
2265 set_value_component_location (v, obj);
2266 new_addr = value_address (obj) + offset;
2267 set_value_bitpos (v, bit_offset + value_bitpos (obj));
2268 set_value_bitsize (v, bit_size);
2269 if (value_bitpos (v) >= HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2270 {
2271 ++new_addr;
2272 set_value_bitpos (v, value_bitpos (v) - HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2273 }
2274 set_value_address (v, new_addr);
2275 }
2276 else
2277 set_value_bitsize (v, bit_size);
2278 unpacked = (unsigned char *) value_contents (v);
2279
2280 srcBitsLeft = bit_size;
2281 nsrc = len;
2282 ntarg = TYPE_LENGTH (type);
2283 sign = 0;
2284 if (bit_size == 0)
2285 {
2286 memset (unpacked, 0, TYPE_LENGTH (type));
2287 return v;
2288 }
2289 else if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (type)))
2290 {
2291 src = len - 1;
2292 if (has_negatives (type)
2293 && ((bytes[0] << bit_offset) & (1 << (HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1))))
2294 sign = ~0;
2295
2296 unusedLS =
2297 (HOST_CHAR_BIT - (bit_size + bit_offset) % HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2298 % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2299
2300 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
2301 {
2302 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
2303 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
2304 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
2305 /* Non-scalar values must be aligned at a byte boundary... */
2306 accumSize =
2307 (HOST_CHAR_BIT - bit_size % HOST_CHAR_BIT) % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2308 /* ... And are placed at the beginning (most-significant) bytes
2309 of the target. */
2310 targ = (bit_size + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1;
2311 ntarg = targ + 1;
2312 break;
2313 default:
2314 accumSize = 0;
2315 targ = TYPE_LENGTH (type) - 1;
2316 break;
2317 }
2318 }
2319 else
2320 {
2321 int sign_bit_offset = (bit_size + bit_offset - 1) % 8;
2322
2323 src = targ = 0;
2324 unusedLS = bit_offset;
2325 accumSize = 0;
2326
2327 if (has_negatives (type) && (bytes[len - 1] & (1 << sign_bit_offset)))
2328 sign = ~0;
2329 }
2330
2331 accum = 0;
2332 while (nsrc > 0)
2333 {
2334 /* Mask for removing bits of the next source byte that are not
2335 part of the value. */
2336 unsigned int unusedMSMask =
2337 (1 << (srcBitsLeft >= HOST_CHAR_BIT ? HOST_CHAR_BIT : srcBitsLeft)) -
2338 1;
2339 /* Sign-extend bits for this byte. */
2340 unsigned int signMask = sign & ~unusedMSMask;
2341
2342 accum |=
2343 (((bytes[src] >> unusedLS) & unusedMSMask) | signMask) << accumSize;
2344 accumSize += HOST_CHAR_BIT - unusedLS;
2345 if (accumSize >= HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2346 {
2347 unpacked[targ] = accum & ~(~0L << HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2348 accumSize -= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2349 accum >>= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2350 ntarg -= 1;
2351 targ += delta;
2352 }
2353 srcBitsLeft -= HOST_CHAR_BIT - unusedLS;
2354 unusedLS = 0;
2355 nsrc -= 1;
2356 src += delta;
2357 }
2358 while (ntarg > 0)
2359 {
2360 accum |= sign << accumSize;
2361 unpacked[targ] = accum & ~(~0L << HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2362 accumSize -= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2363 accum >>= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2364 ntarg -= 1;
2365 targ += delta;
2366 }
2367
2368 return v;
2369 }
2370
2371 /* Move N bits from SOURCE, starting at bit offset SRC_OFFSET to
2372 TARGET, starting at bit offset TARG_OFFSET. SOURCE and TARGET must
2373 not overlap. */
2374 static void
2375 move_bits (gdb_byte *target, int targ_offset, const gdb_byte *source,
2376 int src_offset, int n, int bits_big_endian_p)
2377 {
2378 unsigned int accum, mask;
2379 int accum_bits, chunk_size;
2380
2381 target += targ_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2382 targ_offset %= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2383 source += src_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2384 src_offset %= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2385 if (bits_big_endian_p)
2386 {
2387 accum = (unsigned char) *source;
2388 source += 1;
2389 accum_bits = HOST_CHAR_BIT - src_offset;
2390
2391 while (n > 0)
2392 {
2393 int unused_right;
2394
2395 accum = (accum << HOST_CHAR_BIT) + (unsigned char) *source;
2396 accum_bits += HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2397 source += 1;
2398 chunk_size = HOST_CHAR_BIT - targ_offset;
2399 if (chunk_size > n)
2400 chunk_size = n;
2401 unused_right = HOST_CHAR_BIT - (chunk_size + targ_offset);
2402 mask = ((1 << chunk_size) - 1) << unused_right;
2403 *target =
2404 (*target & ~mask)
2405 | ((accum >> (accum_bits - chunk_size - unused_right)) & mask);
2406 n -= chunk_size;
2407 accum_bits -= chunk_size;
2408 target += 1;
2409 targ_offset = 0;
2410 }
2411 }
2412 else
2413 {
2414 accum = (unsigned char) *source >> src_offset;
2415 source += 1;
2416 accum_bits = HOST_CHAR_BIT - src_offset;
2417
2418 while (n > 0)
2419 {
2420 accum = accum + ((unsigned char) *source << accum_bits);
2421 accum_bits += HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2422 source += 1;
2423 chunk_size = HOST_CHAR_BIT - targ_offset;
2424 if (chunk_size > n)
2425 chunk_size = n;
2426 mask = ((1 << chunk_size) - 1) << targ_offset;
2427 *target = (*target & ~mask) | ((accum << targ_offset) & mask);
2428 n -= chunk_size;
2429 accum_bits -= chunk_size;
2430 accum >>= chunk_size;
2431 target += 1;
2432 targ_offset = 0;
2433 }
2434 }
2435 }
2436
2437 /* Store the contents of FROMVAL into the location of TOVAL.
2438 Return a new value with the location of TOVAL and contents of
2439 FROMVAL. Handles assignment into packed fields that have
2440 floating-point or non-scalar types. */
2441
2442 static struct value *
2443 ada_value_assign (struct value *toval, struct value *fromval)
2444 {
2445 struct type *type = value_type (toval);
2446 int bits = value_bitsize (toval);
2447
2448 toval = ada_coerce_ref (toval);
2449 fromval = ada_coerce_ref (fromval);
2450
2451 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (toval)))
2452 toval = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (toval);
2453 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (fromval)))
2454 fromval = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (fromval);
2455
2456 if (!deprecated_value_modifiable (toval))
2457 error (_("Left operand of assignment is not a modifiable lvalue."));
2458
2459 if (VALUE_LVAL (toval) == lval_memory
2460 && bits > 0
2461 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_FLT
2462 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT))
2463 {
2464 int len = (value_bitpos (toval)
2465 + bits + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2466 int from_size;
2467 char *buffer = (char *) alloca (len);
2468 struct value *val;
2469 CORE_ADDR to_addr = value_address (toval);
2470
2471 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_FLT)
2472 fromval = value_cast (type, fromval);
2473
2474 read_memory (to_addr, buffer, len);
2475 from_size = value_bitsize (fromval);
2476 if (from_size == 0)
2477 from_size = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (fromval)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
2478 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (type)))
2479 move_bits (buffer, value_bitpos (toval),
2480 value_contents (fromval), from_size - bits, bits, 1);
2481 else
2482 move_bits (buffer, value_bitpos (toval),
2483 value_contents (fromval), 0, bits, 0);
2484 write_memory (to_addr, buffer, len);
2485 observer_notify_memory_changed (to_addr, len, buffer);
2486
2487 val = value_copy (toval);
2488 memcpy (value_contents_raw (val), value_contents (fromval),
2489 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
2490 deprecated_set_value_type (val, type);
2491
2492 return val;
2493 }
2494
2495 return value_assign (toval, fromval);
2496 }
2497
2498
2499 /* Given that COMPONENT is a memory lvalue that is part of the lvalue
2500 * CONTAINER, assign the contents of VAL to COMPONENTS's place in
2501 * CONTAINER. Modifies the VALUE_CONTENTS of CONTAINER only, not
2502 * COMPONENT, and not the inferior's memory. The current contents
2503 * of COMPONENT are ignored. */
2504 static void
2505 value_assign_to_component (struct value *container, struct value *component,
2506 struct value *val)
2507 {
2508 LONGEST offset_in_container =
2509 (LONGEST) (value_address (component) - value_address (container));
2510 int bit_offset_in_container =
2511 value_bitpos (component) - value_bitpos (container);
2512 int bits;
2513
2514 val = value_cast (value_type (component), val);
2515
2516 if (value_bitsize (component) == 0)
2517 bits = TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (component));
2518 else
2519 bits = value_bitsize (component);
2520
2521 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (value_type (container))))
2522 move_bits (value_contents_writeable (container) + offset_in_container,
2523 value_bitpos (container) + bit_offset_in_container,
2524 value_contents (val),
2525 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (component)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT - bits,
2526 bits, 1);
2527 else
2528 move_bits (value_contents_writeable (container) + offset_in_container,
2529 value_bitpos (container) + bit_offset_in_container,
2530 value_contents (val), 0, bits, 0);
2531 }
2532
2533 /* The value of the element of array ARR at the ARITY indices given in IND.
2534 ARR may be either a simple array, GNAT array descriptor, or pointer
2535 thereto. */
2536
2537 struct value *
2538 ada_value_subscript (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind)
2539 {
2540 int k;
2541 struct value *elt;
2542 struct type *elt_type;
2543
2544 elt = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arr);
2545
2546 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (elt));
2547 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
2548 && TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) > 0)
2549 return value_subscript_packed (elt, arity, ind);
2550
2551 for (k = 0; k < arity; k += 1)
2552 {
2553 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2554 error (_("too many subscripts (%d expected)"), k);
2555 elt = value_subscript (elt, pos_atr (ind[k]));
2556 }
2557 return elt;
2558 }
2559
2560 /* Assuming ARR is a pointer to a standard GDB array of type TYPE, the
2561 value of the element of *ARR at the ARITY indices given in
2562 IND. Does not read the entire array into memory. */
2563
2564 static struct value *
2565 ada_value_ptr_subscript (struct value *arr, struct type *type, int arity,
2566 struct value **ind)
2567 {
2568 int k;
2569
2570 for (k = 0; k < arity; k += 1)
2571 {
2572 LONGEST lwb, upb;
2573
2574 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2575 error (_("too many subscripts (%d expected)"), k);
2576 arr = value_cast (lookup_pointer_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)),
2577 value_copy (arr));
2578 get_discrete_bounds (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type), &lwb, &upb);
2579 arr = value_ptradd (arr, pos_atr (ind[k]) - lwb);
2580 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2581 }
2582
2583 return value_ind (arr);
2584 }
2585
2586 /* Given that ARRAY_PTR is a pointer or reference to an array of type TYPE (the
2587 actual type of ARRAY_PTR is ignored), returns the Ada slice of HIGH-LOW+1
2588 elements starting at index LOW. The lower bound of this array is LOW, as
2589 per Ada rules. */
2590 static struct value *
2591 ada_value_slice_from_ptr (struct value *array_ptr, struct type *type,
2592 int low, int high)
2593 {
2594 struct type *type0 = ada_check_typedef (type);
2595 CORE_ADDR base = value_as_address (array_ptr)
2596 + ((low - ada_discrete_type_low_bound (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0)))
2597 * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0)));
2598 struct type *index_type =
2599 create_range_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0)),
2600 low, high);
2601 struct type *slice_type =
2602 create_array_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0), index_type);
2603
2604 return value_at_lazy (slice_type, base);
2605 }
2606
2607
2608 static struct value *
2609 ada_value_slice (struct value *array, int low, int high)
2610 {
2611 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (array));
2612 struct type *index_type =
2613 create_range_type (NULL, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type), low, high);
2614 struct type *slice_type =
2615 create_array_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), index_type);
2616
2617 return value_cast (slice_type, value_slice (array, low, high - low + 1));
2618 }
2619
2620 /* If type is a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array
2621 descriptor, returns the number of dimensions for type. If arr is a
2622 simple array, returns the number of "array of"s that prefix its
2623 type designation. Otherwise, returns 0. */
2624
2625 int
2626 ada_array_arity (struct type *type)
2627 {
2628 int arity;
2629
2630 if (type == NULL)
2631 return 0;
2632
2633 type = desc_base_type (type);
2634
2635 arity = 0;
2636 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
2637 return desc_arity (desc_bounds_type (type));
2638 else
2639 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2640 {
2641 arity += 1;
2642 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
2643 }
2644
2645 return arity;
2646 }
2647
2648 /* If TYPE is a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array
2649 descriptor or a simple array type, returns the element type for
2650 TYPE after indexing by NINDICES indices, or by all indices if
2651 NINDICES is -1. Otherwise, returns NULL. */
2652
2653 struct type *
2654 ada_array_element_type (struct type *type, int nindices)
2655 {
2656 type = desc_base_type (type);
2657
2658 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
2659 {
2660 int k;
2661 struct type *p_array_type;
2662
2663 p_array_type = desc_data_target_type (type);
2664
2665 k = ada_array_arity (type);
2666 if (k == 0)
2667 return NULL;
2668
2669 /* Initially p_array_type = elt_type(*)[]...(k times)...[]. */
2670 if (nindices >= 0 && k > nindices)
2671 k = nindices;
2672 while (k > 0 && p_array_type != NULL)
2673 {
2674 p_array_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (p_array_type));
2675 k -= 1;
2676 }
2677 return p_array_type;
2678 }
2679 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2680 {
2681 while (nindices != 0 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2682 {
2683 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2684 nindices -= 1;
2685 }
2686 return type;
2687 }
2688
2689 return NULL;
2690 }
2691
2692 /* The type of nth index in arrays of given type (n numbering from 1).
2693 Does not examine memory. Throws an error if N is invalid or TYPE
2694 is not an array type. NAME is the name of the Ada attribute being
2695 evaluated ('range, 'first, 'last, or 'length); it is used in building
2696 the error message. */
2697
2698 static struct type *
2699 ada_index_type (struct type *type, int n, const char *name)
2700 {
2701 struct type *result_type;
2702
2703 type = desc_base_type (type);
2704
2705 if (n < 0 || n > ada_array_arity (type))
2706 error (_("invalid dimension number to '%s"), name);
2707
2708 if (ada_is_simple_array_type (type))
2709 {
2710 int i;
2711
2712 for (i = 1; i < n; i += 1)
2713 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2714 result_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type));
2715 /* FIXME: The stabs type r(0,0);bound;bound in an array type
2716 has a target type of TYPE_CODE_UNDEF. We compensate here, but
2717 perhaps stabsread.c would make more sense. */
2718 if (result_type && TYPE_CODE (result_type) == TYPE_CODE_UNDEF)
2719 result_type = NULL;
2720 }
2721 else
2722 {
2723 result_type = desc_index_type (desc_bounds_type (type), n);
2724 if (result_type == NULL)
2725 error (_("attempt to take bound of something that is not an array"));
2726 }
2727
2728 return result_type;
2729 }
2730
2731 /* Given that arr is an array type, returns the lower bound of the
2732 Nth index (numbering from 1) if WHICH is 0, and the upper bound if
2733 WHICH is 1. This returns bounds 0 .. -1 if ARR_TYPE is an
2734 array-descriptor type. It works for other arrays with bounds supplied
2735 by run-time quantities other than discriminants. */
2736
2737 static LONGEST
2738 ada_array_bound_from_type (struct type * arr_type, int n, int which)
2739 {
2740 struct type *type, *elt_type, *index_type_desc, *index_type;
2741 int i;
2742
2743 gdb_assert (which == 0 || which == 1);
2744
2745 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
2746 arr_type = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type);
2747
2748 if (arr_type == NULL || !ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
2749 return (LONGEST) - which;
2750
2751 if (TYPE_CODE (arr_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
2752 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (arr_type);
2753 else
2754 type = arr_type;
2755
2756 elt_type = type;
2757 for (i = n; i > 1; i--)
2758 elt_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2759
2760 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XA");
2761 ada_fixup_array_indexes_type (index_type_desc);
2762 if (index_type_desc != NULL)
2763 index_type = to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_type_desc, n - 1),
2764 NULL);
2765 else
2766 index_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (elt_type);
2767
2768 return
2769 (LONGEST) (which == 0
2770 ? ada_discrete_type_low_bound (index_type)
2771 : ada_discrete_type_high_bound (index_type));
2772 }
2773
2774 /* Given that arr is an array value, returns the lower bound of the
2775 nth index (numbering from 1) if WHICH is 0, and the upper bound if
2776 WHICH is 1. This routine will also work for arrays with bounds
2777 supplied by run-time quantities other than discriminants. */
2778
2779 static LONGEST
2780 ada_array_bound (struct value *arr, int n, int which)
2781 {
2782 struct type *arr_type = value_type (arr);
2783
2784 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
2785 return ada_array_bound (decode_constrained_packed_array (arr), n, which);
2786 else if (ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
2787 return ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, which);
2788 else
2789 return value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, which));
2790 }
2791
2792 /* Given that arr is an array value, returns the length of the
2793 nth index. This routine will also work for arrays with bounds
2794 supplied by run-time quantities other than discriminants.
2795 Does not work for arrays indexed by enumeration types with representation
2796 clauses at the moment. */
2797
2798 static LONGEST
2799 ada_array_length (struct value *arr, int n)
2800 {
2801 struct type *arr_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
2802
2803 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
2804 return ada_array_length (decode_constrained_packed_array (arr), n);
2805
2806 if (ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
2807 return (ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, 1)
2808 - ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, 0) + 1);
2809 else
2810 return (value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, 1))
2811 - value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, 0)) + 1);
2812 }
2813
2814 /* An empty array whose type is that of ARR_TYPE (an array type),
2815 with bounds LOW to LOW-1. */
2816
2817 static struct value *
2818 empty_array (struct type *arr_type, int low)
2819 {
2820 struct type *arr_type0 = ada_check_typedef (arr_type);
2821 struct type *index_type =
2822 create_range_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (arr_type0)),
2823 low, low - 1);
2824 struct type *elt_type = ada_array_element_type (arr_type0, 1);
2825
2826 return allocate_value (create_array_type (NULL, elt_type, index_type));
2827 }
2828 \f
2829
2830 /* Name resolution */
2831
2832 /* The "decoded" name for the user-definable Ada operator corresponding
2833 to OP. */
2834
2835 static const char *
2836 ada_decoded_op_name (enum exp_opcode op)
2837 {
2838 int i;
2839
2840 for (i = 0; ada_opname_table[i].encoded != NULL; i += 1)
2841 {
2842 if (ada_opname_table[i].op == op)
2843 return ada_opname_table[i].decoded;
2844 }
2845 error (_("Could not find operator name for opcode"));
2846 }
2847
2848
2849 /* Same as evaluate_type (*EXP), but resolves ambiguous symbol
2850 references (marked by OP_VAR_VALUE nodes in which the symbol has an
2851 undefined namespace) and converts operators that are
2852 user-defined into appropriate function calls. If CONTEXT_TYPE is
2853 non-null, it provides a preferred result type [at the moment, only
2854 type void has any effect---causing procedures to be preferred over
2855 functions in calls]. A null CONTEXT_TYPE indicates that a non-void
2856 return type is preferred. May change (expand) *EXP. */
2857
2858 static void
2859 resolve (struct expression **expp, int void_context_p)
2860 {
2861 struct type *context_type = NULL;
2862 int pc = 0;
2863
2864 if (void_context_p)
2865 context_type = builtin_type ((*expp)->gdbarch)->builtin_void;
2866
2867 resolve_subexp (expp, &pc, 1, context_type);
2868 }
2869
2870 /* Resolve the operator of the subexpression beginning at
2871 position *POS of *EXPP. "Resolving" consists of replacing
2872 the symbols that have undefined namespaces in OP_VAR_VALUE nodes
2873 with their resolutions, replacing built-in operators with
2874 function calls to user-defined operators, where appropriate, and,
2875 when DEPROCEDURE_P is non-zero, converting function-valued variables
2876 into parameterless calls. May expand *EXPP. The CONTEXT_TYPE functions
2877 are as in ada_resolve, above. */
2878
2879 static struct value *
2880 resolve_subexp (struct expression **expp, int *pos, int deprocedure_p,
2881 struct type *context_type)
2882 {
2883 int pc = *pos;
2884 int i;
2885 struct expression *exp; /* Convenience: == *expp. */
2886 enum exp_opcode op = (*expp)->elts[pc].opcode;
2887 struct value **argvec; /* Vector of operand types (alloca'ed). */
2888 int nargs; /* Number of operands. */
2889 int oplen;
2890
2891 argvec = NULL;
2892 nargs = 0;
2893 exp = *expp;
2894
2895 /* Pass one: resolve operands, saving their types and updating *pos,
2896 if needed. */
2897 switch (op)
2898 {
2899 case OP_FUNCALL:
2900 if (exp->elts[pc + 3].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
2901 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
2902 *pos += 7;
2903 else
2904 {
2905 *pos += 3;
2906 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL);
2907 }
2908 nargs = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
2909 break;
2910
2911 case UNOP_ADDR:
2912 *pos += 1;
2913 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL);
2914 break;
2915
2916 case UNOP_QUAL:
2917 *pos += 3;
2918 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 1].type));
2919 break;
2920
2921 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
2922 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
2923 case OP_ATR_TAG:
2924 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
2925 case OP_ATR_LAST:
2926 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
2927 case OP_ATR_POS:
2928 case OP_ATR_VAL:
2929 case OP_ATR_MIN:
2930 case OP_ATR_MAX:
2931 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
2932 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
2933 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
2934 case OP_AGGREGATE:
2935 case OP_OTHERS:
2936 case OP_CHOICES:
2937 case OP_POSITIONAL:
2938 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
2939 case OP_NAME:
2940 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
2941 *pos += oplen;
2942 break;
2943
2944 case BINOP_ASSIGN:
2945 {
2946 struct value *arg1;
2947
2948 *pos += 1;
2949 arg1 = resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL);
2950 if (arg1 == NULL)
2951 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, NULL);
2952 else
2953 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, value_type (arg1));
2954 break;
2955 }
2956
2957 case UNOP_CAST:
2958 *pos += 3;
2959 nargs = 1;
2960 break;
2961
2962 case BINOP_ADD:
2963 case BINOP_SUB:
2964 case BINOP_MUL:
2965 case BINOP_DIV:
2966 case BINOP_REM:
2967 case BINOP_MOD:
2968 case BINOP_EXP:
2969 case BINOP_CONCAT:
2970 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
2971 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
2972 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
2973 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
2974 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
2975
2976 case BINOP_EQUAL:
2977 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
2978 case BINOP_LESS:
2979 case BINOP_GTR:
2980 case BINOP_LEQ:
2981 case BINOP_GEQ:
2982
2983 case BINOP_REPEAT:
2984 case BINOP_SUBSCRIPT:
2985 case BINOP_COMMA:
2986 *pos += 1;
2987 nargs = 2;
2988 break;
2989
2990 case UNOP_NEG:
2991 case UNOP_PLUS:
2992 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
2993 case UNOP_ABS:
2994 case UNOP_IND:
2995 *pos += 1;
2996 nargs = 1;
2997 break;
2998
2999 case OP_LONG:
3000 case OP_DOUBLE:
3001 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
3002 *pos += 4;
3003 break;
3004
3005 case OP_TYPE:
3006 case OP_BOOL:
3007 case OP_LAST:
3008 case OP_INTERNALVAR:
3009 *pos += 3;
3010 break;
3011
3012 case UNOP_MEMVAL:
3013 *pos += 3;
3014 nargs = 1;
3015 break;
3016
3017 case OP_REGISTER:
3018 *pos += 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst + 1);
3019 break;
3020
3021 case STRUCTOP_STRUCT:
3022 *pos += 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst + 1);
3023 nargs = 1;
3024 break;
3025
3026 case TERNOP_SLICE:
3027 *pos += 1;
3028 nargs = 3;
3029 break;
3030
3031 case OP_STRING:
3032 break;
3033
3034 default:
3035 error (_("Unexpected operator during name resolution"));
3036 }
3037
3038 argvec = (struct value * *) alloca (sizeof (struct value *) * (nargs + 1));
3039 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
3040 argvec[i] = resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, NULL);
3041 argvec[i] = NULL;
3042 exp = *expp;
3043
3044 /* Pass two: perform any resolution on principal operator. */
3045 switch (op)
3046 {
3047 default:
3048 break;
3049
3050 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
3051 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
3052 {
3053 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
3054 int n_candidates;
3055
3056 n_candidates =
3057 ada_lookup_symbol_list (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME
3058 (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol),
3059 exp->elts[pc + 1].block, VAR_DOMAIN,
3060 &candidates, 1);
3061
3062 if (n_candidates > 1)
3063 {
3064 /* Types tend to get re-introduced locally, so if there
3065 are any local symbols that are not types, first filter
3066 out all types. */
3067 int j;
3068 for (j = 0; j < n_candidates; j += 1)
3069 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (candidates[j].sym))
3070 {
3071 case LOC_REGISTER:
3072 case LOC_ARG:
3073 case LOC_REF_ARG:
3074 case LOC_REGPARM_ADDR:
3075 case LOC_LOCAL:
3076 case LOC_COMPUTED:
3077 goto FoundNonType;
3078 default:
3079 break;
3080 }
3081 FoundNonType:
3082 if (j < n_candidates)
3083 {
3084 j = 0;
3085 while (j < n_candidates)
3086 {
3087 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (candidates[j].sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
3088 {
3089 candidates[j] = candidates[n_candidates - 1];
3090 n_candidates -= 1;
3091 }
3092 else
3093 j += 1;
3094 }
3095 }
3096 }
3097
3098 if (n_candidates == 0)
3099 error (_("No definition found for %s"),
3100 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
3101 else if (n_candidates == 1)
3102 i = 0;
3103 else if (deprocedure_p
3104 && !is_nonfunction (candidates, n_candidates))
3105 {
3106 i = ada_resolve_function
3107 (candidates, n_candidates, NULL, 0,
3108 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol),
3109 context_type);
3110 if (i < 0)
3111 error (_("Could not find a match for %s"),
3112 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
3113 }
3114 else
3115 {
3116 printf_filtered (_("Multiple matches for %s\n"),
3117 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
3118 user_select_syms (candidates, n_candidates, 1);
3119 i = 0;
3120 }
3121
3122 exp->elts[pc + 1].block = candidates[i].block;
3123 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol = candidates[i].sym;
3124 if (innermost_block == NULL
3125 || contained_in (candidates[i].block, innermost_block))
3126 innermost_block = candidates[i].block;
3127 }
3128
3129 if (deprocedure_p
3130 && (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol))
3131 == TYPE_CODE_FUNC))
3132 {
3133 replace_operator_with_call (expp, pc, 0, 0,
3134 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol,
3135 exp->elts[pc + 1].block);
3136 exp = *expp;
3137 }
3138 break;
3139
3140 case OP_FUNCALL:
3141 {
3142 if (exp->elts[pc + 3].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
3143 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
3144 {
3145 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
3146 int n_candidates;
3147
3148 n_candidates =
3149 ada_lookup_symbol_list (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME
3150 (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol),
3151 exp->elts[pc + 4].block, VAR_DOMAIN,
3152 &candidates, 1);
3153 if (n_candidates == 1)
3154 i = 0;
3155 else
3156 {
3157 i = ada_resolve_function
3158 (candidates, n_candidates,
3159 argvec, nargs,
3160 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol),
3161 context_type);
3162 if (i < 0)
3163 error (_("Could not find a match for %s"),
3164 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol));
3165 }
3166
3167 exp->elts[pc + 4].block = candidates[i].block;
3168 exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol = candidates[i].sym;
3169 if (innermost_block == NULL
3170 || contained_in (candidates[i].block, innermost_block))
3171 innermost_block = candidates[i].block;
3172 }
3173 }
3174 break;
3175 case BINOP_ADD:
3176 case BINOP_SUB:
3177 case BINOP_MUL:
3178 case BINOP_DIV:
3179 case BINOP_REM:
3180 case BINOP_MOD:
3181 case BINOP_CONCAT:
3182 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
3183 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
3184 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
3185 case BINOP_EQUAL:
3186 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
3187 case BINOP_LESS:
3188 case BINOP_GTR:
3189 case BINOP_LEQ:
3190 case BINOP_GEQ:
3191 case BINOP_EXP:
3192 case UNOP_NEG:
3193 case UNOP_PLUS:
3194 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
3195 case UNOP_ABS:
3196 if (possible_user_operator_p (op, argvec))
3197 {
3198 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
3199 int n_candidates;
3200
3201 n_candidates =
3202 ada_lookup_symbol_list (ada_encode (ada_decoded_op_name (op)),
3203 (struct block *) NULL, VAR_DOMAIN,
3204 &candidates, 1);
3205 i = ada_resolve_function (candidates, n_candidates, argvec, nargs,
3206 ada_decoded_op_name (op), NULL);
3207 if (i < 0)
3208 break;
3209
3210 replace_operator_with_call (expp, pc, nargs, 1,
3211 candidates[i].sym, candidates[i].block);
3212 exp = *expp;
3213 }
3214 break;
3215
3216 case OP_TYPE:
3217 case OP_REGISTER:
3218 return NULL;
3219 }
3220
3221 *pos = pc;
3222 return evaluate_subexp_type (exp, pos);
3223 }
3224
3225 /* Return non-zero if formal type FTYPE matches actual type ATYPE. If
3226 MAY_DEREF is non-zero, the formal may be a pointer and the actual
3227 a non-pointer. */
3228 /* The term "match" here is rather loose. The match is heuristic and
3229 liberal. */
3230
3231 static int
3232 ada_type_match (struct type *ftype, struct type *atype, int may_deref)
3233 {
3234 ftype = ada_check_typedef (ftype);
3235 atype = ada_check_typedef (atype);
3236
3237 if (TYPE_CODE (ftype) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
3238 ftype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype);
3239 if (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
3240 atype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (atype);
3241
3242 switch (TYPE_CODE (ftype))
3243 {
3244 default:
3245 return TYPE_CODE (ftype) == TYPE_CODE (atype);
3246 case TYPE_CODE_PTR:
3247 if (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3248 return ada_type_match (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype),
3249 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (atype), 0);
3250 else
3251 return (may_deref
3252 && ada_type_match (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype), atype, 0));
3253 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3254 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3255 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3256 switch (TYPE_CODE (atype))
3257 {
3258 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3259 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3260 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3261 return 1;
3262 default:
3263 return 0;
3264 }
3265
3266 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
3267 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
3268 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3269
3270 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
3271 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (ftype))
3272 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
3273 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3274 else
3275 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
3276 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3277
3278 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
3279 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
3280 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE (ftype));
3281 }
3282 }
3283
3284 /* Return non-zero if the formals of FUNC "sufficiently match" the
3285 vector of actual argument types ACTUALS of size N_ACTUALS. FUNC
3286 may also be an enumeral, in which case it is treated as a 0-
3287 argument function. */
3288
3289 static int
3290 ada_args_match (struct symbol *func, struct value **actuals, int n_actuals)
3291 {
3292 int i;
3293 struct type *func_type = SYMBOL_TYPE (func);
3294
3295 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (func) == LOC_CONST
3296 && TYPE_CODE (func_type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
3297 return (n_actuals == 0);
3298 else if (func_type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (func_type) != TYPE_CODE_FUNC)
3299 return 0;
3300
3301 if (TYPE_NFIELDS (func_type) != n_actuals)
3302 return 0;
3303
3304 for (i = 0; i < n_actuals; i += 1)
3305 {
3306 if (actuals[i] == NULL)
3307 return 0;
3308 else
3309 {
3310 struct type *ftype = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (func_type,
3311 i));
3312 struct type *atype = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actuals[i]));
3313
3314 if (!ada_type_match (ftype, atype, 1))
3315 return 0;
3316 }
3317 }
3318 return 1;
3319 }
3320
3321 /* False iff function type FUNC_TYPE definitely does not produce a value
3322 compatible with type CONTEXT_TYPE. Conservatively returns 1 if
3323 FUNC_TYPE is not a valid function type with a non-null return type
3324 or an enumerated type. A null CONTEXT_TYPE indicates any non-void type. */
3325
3326 static int
3327 return_match (struct type *func_type, struct type *context_type)
3328 {
3329 struct type *return_type;
3330
3331 if (func_type == NULL)
3332 return 1;
3333
3334 if (TYPE_CODE (func_type) == TYPE_CODE_FUNC)
3335 return_type = get_base_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (func_type));
3336 else
3337 return_type = get_base_type (func_type);
3338 if (return_type == NULL)
3339 return 1;
3340
3341 context_type = get_base_type (context_type);
3342
3343 if (TYPE_CODE (return_type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
3344 return context_type == NULL || return_type == context_type;
3345 else if (context_type == NULL)
3346 return TYPE_CODE (return_type) != TYPE_CODE_VOID;
3347 else
3348 return TYPE_CODE (return_type) == TYPE_CODE (context_type);
3349 }
3350
3351
3352 /* Returns the index in SYMS[0..NSYMS-1] that contains the symbol for the
3353 function (if any) that matches the types of the NARGS arguments in
3354 ARGS. If CONTEXT_TYPE is non-null and there is at least one match
3355 that returns that type, then eliminate matches that don't. If
3356 CONTEXT_TYPE is void and there is at least one match that does not
3357 return void, eliminate all matches that do.
3358
3359 Asks the user if there is more than one match remaining. Returns -1
3360 if there is no such symbol or none is selected. NAME is used
3361 solely for messages. May re-arrange and modify SYMS in
3362 the process; the index returned is for the modified vector. */
3363
3364 static int
3365 ada_resolve_function (struct ada_symbol_info syms[],
3366 int nsyms, struct value **args, int nargs,
3367 const char *name, struct type *context_type)
3368 {
3369 int fallback;
3370 int k;
3371 int m; /* Number of hits */
3372
3373 m = 0;
3374 /* In the first pass of the loop, we only accept functions matching
3375 context_type. If none are found, we add a second pass of the loop
3376 where every function is accepted. */
3377 for (fallback = 0; m == 0 && fallback < 2; fallback++)
3378 {
3379 for (k = 0; k < nsyms; k += 1)
3380 {
3381 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[k].sym));
3382
3383 if (ada_args_match (syms[k].sym, args, nargs)
3384 && (fallback || return_match (type, context_type)))
3385 {
3386 syms[m] = syms[k];
3387 m += 1;
3388 }
3389 }
3390 }
3391
3392 if (m == 0)
3393 return -1;
3394 else if (m > 1)
3395 {
3396 printf_filtered (_("Multiple matches for %s\n"), name);
3397 user_select_syms (syms, m, 1);
3398 return 0;
3399 }
3400 return 0;
3401 }
3402
3403 /* Returns true (non-zero) iff decoded name N0 should appear before N1
3404 in a listing of choices during disambiguation (see sort_choices, below).
3405 The idea is that overloadings of a subprogram name from the
3406 same package should sort in their source order. We settle for ordering
3407 such symbols by their trailing number (__N or $N). */
3408
3409 static int
3410 encoded_ordered_before (char *N0, char *N1)
3411 {
3412 if (N1 == NULL)
3413 return 0;
3414 else if (N0 == NULL)
3415 return 1;
3416 else
3417 {
3418 int k0, k1;
3419
3420 for (k0 = strlen (N0) - 1; k0 > 0 && isdigit (N0[k0]); k0 -= 1)
3421 ;
3422 for (k1 = strlen (N1) - 1; k1 > 0 && isdigit (N1[k1]); k1 -= 1)
3423 ;
3424 if ((N0[k0] == '_' || N0[k0] == '$') && N0[k0 + 1] != '\000'
3425 && (N1[k1] == '_' || N1[k1] == '$') && N1[k1 + 1] != '\000')
3426 {
3427 int n0, n1;
3428
3429 n0 = k0;
3430 while (N0[n0] == '_' && n0 > 0 && N0[n0 - 1] == '_')
3431 n0 -= 1;
3432 n1 = k1;
3433 while (N1[n1] == '_' && n1 > 0 && N1[n1 - 1] == '_')
3434 n1 -= 1;
3435 if (n0 == n1 && strncmp (N0, N1, n0) == 0)
3436 return (atoi (N0 + k0 + 1) < atoi (N1 + k1 + 1));
3437 }
3438 return (strcmp (N0, N1) < 0);
3439 }
3440 }
3441
3442 /* Sort SYMS[0..NSYMS-1] to put the choices in a canonical order by the
3443 encoded names. */
3444
3445 static void
3446 sort_choices (struct ada_symbol_info syms[], int nsyms)
3447 {
3448 int i;
3449
3450 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i += 1)
3451 {
3452 struct ada_symbol_info sym = syms[i];
3453 int j;
3454
3455 for (j = i - 1; j >= 0; j -= 1)
3456 {
3457 if (encoded_ordered_before (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym),
3458 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym.sym)))
3459 break;
3460 syms[j + 1] = syms[j];
3461 }
3462 syms[j + 1] = sym;
3463 }
3464 }
3465
3466 /* Given a list of NSYMS symbols in SYMS, select up to MAX_RESULTS>0
3467 by asking the user (if necessary), returning the number selected,
3468 and setting the first elements of SYMS items. Error if no symbols
3469 selected. */
3470
3471 /* NOTE: Adapted from decode_line_2 in symtab.c, with which it ought
3472 to be re-integrated one of these days. */
3473
3474 int
3475 user_select_syms (struct ada_symbol_info *syms, int nsyms, int max_results)
3476 {
3477 int i;
3478 int *chosen = (int *) alloca (sizeof (int) * nsyms);
3479 int n_chosen;
3480 int first_choice = (max_results == 1) ? 1 : 2;
3481 const char *select_mode = multiple_symbols_select_mode ();
3482
3483 if (max_results < 1)
3484 error (_("Request to select 0 symbols!"));
3485 if (nsyms <= 1)
3486 return nsyms;
3487
3488 if (select_mode == multiple_symbols_cancel)
3489 error (_("\
3490 canceled because the command is ambiguous\n\
3491 See set/show multiple-symbol."));
3492
3493 /* If select_mode is "all", then return all possible symbols.
3494 Only do that if more than one symbol can be selected, of course.
3495 Otherwise, display the menu as usual. */
3496 if (select_mode == multiple_symbols_all && max_results > 1)
3497 return nsyms;
3498
3499 printf_unfiltered (_("[0] cancel\n"));
3500 if (max_results > 1)
3501 printf_unfiltered (_("[1] all\n"));
3502
3503 sort_choices (syms, nsyms);
3504
3505 for (i = 0; i < nsyms; i += 1)
3506 {
3507 if (syms[i].sym == NULL)
3508 continue;
3509
3510 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == LOC_BLOCK)
3511 {
3512 struct symtab_and_line sal =
3513 find_function_start_sal (syms[i].sym, 1);
3514
3515 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
3516 printf_unfiltered (_("[%d] %s at <no source file available>:%d\n"),
3517 i + first_choice,
3518 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3519 sal.line);
3520 else
3521 printf_unfiltered (_("[%d] %s at %s:%d\n"), i + first_choice,
3522 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3523 sal.symtab->filename, sal.line);
3524 continue;
3525 }
3526 else
3527 {
3528 int is_enumeral =
3529 (SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == LOC_CONST
3530 && SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym) != NULL
3531 && TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM);
3532 struct symtab *symtab = syms[i].sym->symtab;
3533
3534 if (SYMBOL_LINE (syms[i].sym) != 0 && symtab != NULL)
3535 printf_unfiltered (_("[%d] %s at %s:%d\n"),
3536 i + first_choice,
3537 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3538 symtab->filename, SYMBOL_LINE (syms[i].sym));
3539 else if (is_enumeral
3540 && TYPE_NAME (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != NULL)
3541 {
3542 printf_unfiltered (("[%d] "), i + first_choice);
3543 ada_print_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym), NULL,
3544 gdb_stdout, -1, 0);
3545 printf_unfiltered (_("'(%s) (enumeral)\n"),
3546 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym));
3547 }
3548 else if (symtab != NULL)
3549 printf_unfiltered (is_enumeral
3550 ? _("[%d] %s in %s (enumeral)\n")
3551 : _("[%d] %s at %s:?\n"),
3552 i + first_choice,
3553 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3554 symtab->filename);
3555 else
3556 printf_unfiltered (is_enumeral
3557 ? _("[%d] %s (enumeral)\n")
3558 : _("[%d] %s at ?\n"),
3559 i + first_choice,
3560 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym));
3561 }
3562 }
3563
3564 n_chosen = get_selections (chosen, nsyms, max_results, max_results > 1,
3565 "overload-choice");
3566
3567 for (i = 0; i < n_chosen; i += 1)
3568 syms[i] = syms[chosen[i]];
3569
3570 return n_chosen;
3571 }
3572
3573 /* Read and validate a set of numeric choices from the user in the
3574 range 0 .. N_CHOICES-1. Place the results in increasing
3575 order in CHOICES[0 .. N-1], and return N.
3576
3577 The user types choices as a sequence of numbers on one line
3578 separated by blanks, encoding them as follows:
3579
3580 + A choice of 0 means to cancel the selection, throwing an error.
3581 + If IS_ALL_CHOICE, a choice of 1 selects the entire set 0 .. N_CHOICES-1.
3582 + The user chooses k by typing k+IS_ALL_CHOICE+1.
3583
3584 The user is not allowed to choose more than MAX_RESULTS values.
3585
3586 ANNOTATION_SUFFIX, if present, is used to annotate the input
3587 prompts (for use with the -f switch). */
3588
3589 int
3590 get_selections (int *choices, int n_choices, int max_results,
3591 int is_all_choice, char *annotation_suffix)
3592 {
3593 char *args;
3594 char *prompt;
3595 int n_chosen;
3596 int first_choice = is_all_choice ? 2 : 1;
3597
3598 prompt = getenv ("PS2");
3599 if (prompt == NULL)
3600 prompt = "> ";
3601
3602 args = command_line_input (prompt, 0, annotation_suffix);
3603
3604 if (args == NULL)
3605 error_no_arg (_("one or more choice numbers"));
3606
3607 n_chosen = 0;
3608
3609 /* Set choices[0 .. n_chosen-1] to the users' choices in ascending
3610 order, as given in args. Choices are validated. */
3611 while (1)
3612 {
3613 char *args2;
3614 int choice, j;
3615
3616 args = skip_spaces (args);
3617 if (*args == '\0' && n_chosen == 0)
3618 error_no_arg (_("one or more choice numbers"));
3619 else if (*args == '\0')
3620 break;
3621
3622 choice = strtol (args, &args2, 10);
3623 if (args == args2 || choice < 0
3624 || choice > n_choices + first_choice - 1)
3625 error (_("Argument must be choice number"));
3626 args = args2;
3627
3628 if (choice == 0)
3629 error (_("cancelled"));
3630
3631 if (choice < first_choice)
3632 {
3633 n_chosen = n_choices;
3634 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
3635 choices[j] = j;
3636 break;
3637 }
3638 choice -= first_choice;
3639
3640 for (j = n_chosen - 1; j >= 0 && choice < choices[j]; j -= 1)
3641 {
3642 }
3643
3644 if (j < 0 || choice != choices[j])
3645 {
3646 int k;
3647
3648 for (k = n_chosen - 1; k > j; k -= 1)
3649 choices[k + 1] = choices[k];
3650 choices[j + 1] = choice;
3651 n_chosen += 1;
3652 }
3653 }
3654
3655 if (n_chosen > max_results)
3656 error (_("Select no more than %d of the above"), max_results);
3657
3658 return n_chosen;
3659 }
3660
3661 /* Replace the operator of length OPLEN at position PC in *EXPP with a call
3662 on the function identified by SYM and BLOCK, and taking NARGS
3663 arguments. Update *EXPP as needed to hold more space. */
3664
3665 static void
3666 replace_operator_with_call (struct expression **expp, int pc, int nargs,
3667 int oplen, struct symbol *sym,
3668 struct block *block)
3669 {
3670 /* A new expression, with 6 more elements (3 for funcall, 4 for function
3671 symbol, -oplen for operator being replaced). */
3672 struct expression *newexp = (struct expression *)
3673 xzalloc (sizeof (struct expression)
3674 + EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES ((*expp)->nelts + 7 - oplen));
3675 struct expression *exp = *expp;
3676
3677 newexp->nelts = exp->nelts + 7 - oplen;
3678 newexp->language_defn = exp->language_defn;
3679 newexp->gdbarch = exp->gdbarch;
3680 memcpy (newexp->elts, exp->elts, EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES (pc));
3681 memcpy (newexp->elts + pc + 7, exp->elts + pc + oplen,
3682 EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES (exp->nelts - pc - oplen));
3683
3684 newexp->elts[pc].opcode = newexp->elts[pc + 2].opcode = OP_FUNCALL;
3685 newexp->elts[pc + 1].longconst = (LONGEST) nargs;
3686
3687 newexp->elts[pc + 3].opcode = newexp->elts[pc + 6].opcode = OP_VAR_VALUE;
3688 newexp->elts[pc + 4].block = block;
3689 newexp->elts[pc + 5].symbol = sym;
3690
3691 *expp = newexp;
3692 xfree (exp);
3693 }
3694
3695 /* Type-class predicates */
3696
3697 /* True iff TYPE is numeric (i.e., an INT, RANGE (of numeric type),
3698 or FLOAT). */
3699
3700 static int
3701 numeric_type_p (struct type *type)
3702 {
3703 if (type == NULL)
3704 return 0;
3705 else
3706 {
3707 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3708 {
3709 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3710 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
3711 return 1;
3712 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3713 return (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)
3714 || numeric_type_p (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
3715 default:
3716 return 0;
3717 }
3718 }
3719 }
3720
3721 /* True iff TYPE is integral (an INT or RANGE of INTs). */
3722
3723 static int
3724 integer_type_p (struct type *type)
3725 {
3726 if (type == NULL)
3727 return 0;
3728 else
3729 {
3730 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3731 {
3732 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3733 return 1;
3734 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3735 return (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)
3736 || integer_type_p (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
3737 default:
3738 return 0;
3739 }
3740 }
3741 }
3742
3743 /* True iff TYPE is scalar (INT, RANGE, FLOAT, ENUM). */
3744
3745 static int
3746 scalar_type_p (struct type *type)
3747 {
3748 if (type == NULL)
3749 return 0;
3750 else
3751 {
3752 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3753 {
3754 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3755 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3756 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3757 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
3758 return 1;
3759 default:
3760 return 0;
3761 }
3762 }
3763 }
3764
3765 /* True iff TYPE is discrete (INT, RANGE, ENUM). */
3766
3767 static int
3768 discrete_type_p (struct type *type)
3769 {
3770 if (type == NULL)
3771 return 0;
3772 else
3773 {
3774 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3775 {
3776 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3777 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3778 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3779 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
3780 return 1;
3781 default:
3782 return 0;
3783 }
3784 }
3785 }
3786
3787 /* Returns non-zero if OP with operands in the vector ARGS could be
3788 a user-defined function. Errs on the side of pre-defined operators
3789 (i.e., result 0). */
3790
3791 static int
3792 possible_user_operator_p (enum exp_opcode op, struct value *args[])
3793 {
3794 struct type *type0 =
3795 (args[0] == NULL) ? NULL : ada_check_typedef (value_type (args[0]));
3796 struct type *type1 =
3797 (args[1] == NULL) ? NULL : ada_check_typedef (value_type (args[1]));
3798
3799 if (type0 == NULL)
3800 return 0;
3801
3802 switch (op)
3803 {
3804 default:
3805 return 0;
3806
3807 case BINOP_ADD:
3808 case BINOP_SUB:
3809 case BINOP_MUL:
3810 case BINOP_DIV:
3811 return (!(numeric_type_p (type0) && numeric_type_p (type1)));
3812
3813 case BINOP_REM:
3814 case BINOP_MOD:
3815 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
3816 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
3817 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
3818 return (!(integer_type_p (type0) && integer_type_p (type1)));
3819
3820 case BINOP_EQUAL:
3821 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
3822 case BINOP_LESS:
3823 case BINOP_GTR:
3824 case BINOP_LEQ:
3825 case BINOP_GEQ:
3826 return (!(scalar_type_p (type0) && scalar_type_p (type1)));
3827
3828 case BINOP_CONCAT:
3829 return !ada_is_array_type (type0) || !ada_is_array_type (type1);
3830
3831 case BINOP_EXP:
3832 return (!(numeric_type_p (type0) && integer_type_p (type1)));
3833
3834 case UNOP_NEG:
3835 case UNOP_PLUS:
3836 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
3837 case UNOP_ABS:
3838 return (!numeric_type_p (type0));
3839
3840 }
3841 }
3842 \f
3843 /* Renaming */
3844
3845 /* NOTES:
3846
3847 1. In the following, we assume that a renaming type's name may
3848 have an ___XD suffix. It would be nice if this went away at some
3849 point.
3850 2. We handle both the (old) purely type-based representation of
3851 renamings and the (new) variable-based encoding. At some point,
3852 it is devoutly to be hoped that the former goes away
3853 (FIXME: hilfinger-2007-07-09).
3854 3. Subprogram renamings are not implemented, although the XRS
3855 suffix is recognized (FIXME: hilfinger-2007-07-09). */
3856
3857 /* If SYM encodes a renaming,
3858
3859 <renaming> renames <renamed entity>,
3860
3861 sets *LEN to the length of the renamed entity's name,
3862 *RENAMED_ENTITY to that name (not null-terminated), and *RENAMING_EXPR to
3863 the string describing the subcomponent selected from the renamed
3864 entity. Returns ADA_NOT_RENAMING if SYM does not encode a renaming
3865 (in which case, the values of *RENAMED_ENTITY, *LEN, and *RENAMING_EXPR
3866 are undefined). Otherwise, returns a value indicating the category
3867 of entity renamed: an object (ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING), exception
3868 (ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING), package (ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING), or
3869 subprogram (ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING). Does no allocation; the
3870 strings returned in *RENAMED_ENTITY and *RENAMING_EXPR should not be
3871 deallocated. The values of RENAMED_ENTITY, LEN, or RENAMING_EXPR
3872 may be NULL, in which case they are not assigned.
3873
3874 [Currently, however, GCC does not generate subprogram renamings.] */
3875
3876 enum ada_renaming_category
3877 ada_parse_renaming (struct symbol *sym,
3878 const char **renamed_entity, int *len,
3879 const char **renaming_expr)
3880 {
3881 enum ada_renaming_category kind;
3882 const char *info;
3883 const char *suffix;
3884
3885 if (sym == NULL)
3886 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3887 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym))
3888 {
3889 default:
3890 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3891 case LOC_TYPEDEF:
3892 return parse_old_style_renaming (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym),
3893 renamed_entity, len, renaming_expr);
3894 case LOC_LOCAL:
3895 case LOC_STATIC:
3896 case LOC_COMPUTED:
3897 case LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT:
3898 info = strstr (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), "___XR");
3899 if (info == NULL)
3900 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3901 switch (info[5])
3902 {
3903 case '_':
3904 kind = ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING;
3905 info += 6;
3906 break;
3907 case 'E':
3908 kind = ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING;
3909 info += 7;
3910 break;
3911 case 'P':
3912 kind = ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING;
3913 info += 7;
3914 break;
3915 case 'S':
3916 kind = ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING;
3917 info += 7;
3918 break;
3919 default:
3920 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3921 }
3922 }
3923
3924 if (renamed_entity != NULL)
3925 *renamed_entity = info;
3926 suffix = strstr (info, "___XE");
3927 if (suffix == NULL || suffix == info)
3928 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3929 if (len != NULL)
3930 *len = strlen (info) - strlen (suffix);
3931 suffix += 5;
3932 if (renaming_expr != NULL)
3933 *renaming_expr = suffix;
3934 return kind;
3935 }
3936
3937 /* Assuming TYPE encodes a renaming according to the old encoding in
3938 exp_dbug.ads, returns details of that renaming in *RENAMED_ENTITY,
3939 *LEN, and *RENAMING_EXPR, as for ada_parse_renaming, above. Returns
3940 ADA_NOT_RENAMING otherwise. */
3941 static enum ada_renaming_category
3942 parse_old_style_renaming (struct type *type,
3943 const char **renamed_entity, int *len,
3944 const char **renaming_expr)
3945 {
3946 enum ada_renaming_category kind;
3947 const char *name;
3948 const char *info;
3949 const char *suffix;
3950
3951 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
3952 || TYPE_NFIELDS (type) != 1)
3953 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3954
3955 name = type_name_no_tag (type);
3956 if (name == NULL)
3957 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3958
3959 name = strstr (name, "___XR");
3960 if (name == NULL)
3961 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3962 switch (name[5])
3963 {
3964 case '\0':
3965 case '_':
3966 kind = ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING;
3967 break;
3968 case 'E':
3969 kind = ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING;
3970 break;
3971 case 'P':
3972 kind = ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING;
3973 break;
3974 case 'S':
3975 kind = ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING;
3976 break;
3977 default:
3978 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3979 }
3980
3981 info = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, 0);
3982 if (info == NULL)
3983 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3984 if (renamed_entity != NULL)
3985 *renamed_entity = info;
3986 suffix = strstr (info, "___XE");
3987 if (renaming_expr != NULL)
3988 *renaming_expr = suffix + 5;
3989 if (suffix == NULL || suffix == info)
3990 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3991 if (len != NULL)
3992 *len = suffix - info;
3993 return kind;
3994 }
3995
3996 \f
3997
3998 /* Evaluation: Function Calls */
3999
4000 /* Return an lvalue containing the value VAL. This is the identity on
4001 lvalues, and otherwise has the side-effect of allocating memory
4002 in the inferior where a copy of the value contents is copied. */
4003
4004 static struct value *
4005 ensure_lval (struct value *val)
4006 {
4007 if (VALUE_LVAL (val) == not_lval
4008 || VALUE_LVAL (val) == lval_internalvar)
4009 {
4010 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (value_type (val)));
4011 const CORE_ADDR addr =
4012 value_as_long (value_allocate_space_in_inferior (len));
4013
4014 set_value_address (val, addr);
4015 VALUE_LVAL (val) = lval_memory;
4016 write_memory (addr, value_contents (val), len);
4017 }
4018
4019 return val;
4020 }
4021
4022 /* Return the value ACTUAL, converted to be an appropriate value for a
4023 formal of type FORMAL_TYPE. Use *SP as a stack pointer for
4024 allocating any necessary descriptors (fat pointers), or copies of
4025 values not residing in memory, updating it as needed. */
4026
4027 struct value *
4028 ada_convert_actual (struct value *actual, struct type *formal_type0)
4029 {
4030 struct type *actual_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actual));
4031 struct type *formal_type = ada_check_typedef (formal_type0);
4032 struct type *formal_target =
4033 TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
4034 ? ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (formal_type)) : formal_type;
4035 struct type *actual_target =
4036 TYPE_CODE (actual_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
4037 ? ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (actual_type)) : actual_type;
4038
4039 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (formal_target)
4040 && TYPE_CODE (actual_target) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
4041 return make_array_descriptor (formal_type, actual);
4042 else if (TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
4043 || TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
4044 {
4045 struct value *result;
4046
4047 if (TYPE_CODE (formal_target) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
4048 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (actual_target))
4049 result = desc_data (actual);
4050 else if (TYPE_CODE (actual_type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4051 {
4052 if (VALUE_LVAL (actual) != lval_memory)
4053 {
4054 struct value *val;
4055
4056 actual_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actual));
4057 val = allocate_value (actual_type);
4058 memcpy ((char *) value_contents_raw (val),
4059 (char *) value_contents (actual),
4060 TYPE_LENGTH (actual_type));
4061 actual = ensure_lval (val);
4062 }
4063 result = value_addr (actual);
4064 }
4065 else
4066 return actual;
4067 return value_cast_pointers (formal_type, result);
4068 }
4069 else if (TYPE_CODE (actual_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4070 return ada_value_ind (actual);
4071
4072 return actual;
4073 }
4074
4075 /* Convert VALUE (which must be an address) to a CORE_ADDR that is a pointer of
4076 type TYPE. This is usually an inefficient no-op except on some targets
4077 (such as AVR) where the representation of a pointer and an address
4078 differs. */
4079
4080 static CORE_ADDR
4081 value_pointer (struct value *value, struct type *type)
4082 {
4083 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_type_arch (type);
4084 unsigned len = TYPE_LENGTH (type);
4085 gdb_byte *buf = alloca (len);
4086 CORE_ADDR addr;
4087
4088 addr = value_address (value);
4089 gdbarch_address_to_pointer (gdbarch, type, buf, addr);
4090 addr = extract_unsigned_integer (buf, len, gdbarch_byte_order (gdbarch));
4091 return addr;
4092 }
4093
4094
4095 /* Push a descriptor of type TYPE for array value ARR on the stack at
4096 *SP, updating *SP to reflect the new descriptor. Return either
4097 an lvalue representing the new descriptor, or (if TYPE is a pointer-
4098 to-descriptor type rather than a descriptor type), a struct value *
4099 representing a pointer to this descriptor. */
4100
4101 static struct value *
4102 make_array_descriptor (struct type *type, struct value *arr)
4103 {
4104 struct type *bounds_type = desc_bounds_type (type);
4105 struct type *desc_type = desc_base_type (type);
4106 struct value *descriptor = allocate_value (desc_type);
4107 struct value *bounds = allocate_value (bounds_type);
4108 int i;
4109
4110 for (i = ada_array_arity (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr)));
4111 i > 0; i -= 1)
4112 {
4113 modify_field (value_type (bounds), value_contents_writeable (bounds),
4114 ada_array_bound (arr, i, 0),
4115 desc_bound_bitpos (bounds_type, i, 0),
4116 desc_bound_bitsize (bounds_type, i, 0));
4117 modify_field (value_type (bounds), value_contents_writeable (bounds),
4118 ada_array_bound (arr, i, 1),
4119 desc_bound_bitpos (bounds_type, i, 1),
4120 desc_bound_bitsize (bounds_type, i, 1));
4121 }
4122
4123 bounds = ensure_lval (bounds);
4124
4125 modify_field (value_type (descriptor),
4126 value_contents_writeable (descriptor),
4127 value_pointer (ensure_lval (arr),
4128 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (desc_type, 0)),
4129 fat_pntr_data_bitpos (desc_type),
4130 fat_pntr_data_bitsize (desc_type));
4131
4132 modify_field (value_type (descriptor),
4133 value_contents_writeable (descriptor),
4134 value_pointer (bounds,
4135 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (desc_type, 1)),
4136 fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (desc_type),
4137 fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (desc_type));
4138
4139 descriptor = ensure_lval (descriptor);
4140
4141 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4142 return value_addr (descriptor);
4143 else
4144 return descriptor;
4145 }
4146 \f
4147 /* Dummy definitions for an experimental caching module that is not
4148 * used in the public sources. */
4149
4150 static int
4151 lookup_cached_symbol (const char *name, domain_enum namespace,
4152 struct symbol **sym, struct block **block)
4153 {
4154 return 0;
4155 }
4156
4157 static void
4158 cache_symbol (const char *name, domain_enum namespace, struct symbol *sym,
4159 struct block *block)
4160 {
4161 }
4162 \f
4163 /* Symbol Lookup */
4164
4165 /* Return nonzero if wild matching should be used when searching for
4166 all symbols matching LOOKUP_NAME.
4167
4168 LOOKUP_NAME is expected to be a symbol name after transformation
4169 for Ada lookups (see ada_name_for_lookup). */
4170
4171 static int
4172 should_use_wild_match (const char *lookup_name)
4173 {
4174 return (strstr (lookup_name, "__") == NULL);
4175 }
4176
4177 /* Return the result of a standard (literal, C-like) lookup of NAME in
4178 given DOMAIN, visible from lexical block BLOCK. */
4179
4180 static struct symbol *
4181 standard_lookup (const char *name, const struct block *block,
4182 domain_enum domain)
4183 {
4184 struct symbol *sym;
4185
4186 if (lookup_cached_symbol (name, domain, &sym, NULL))
4187 return sym;
4188 sym = lookup_symbol_in_language (name, block, domain, language_c, 0);
4189 cache_symbol (name, domain, sym, block_found);
4190 return sym;
4191 }
4192
4193
4194 /* Non-zero iff there is at least one non-function/non-enumeral symbol
4195 in the symbol fields of SYMS[0..N-1]. We treat enumerals as functions,
4196 since they contend in overloading in the same way. */
4197 static int
4198 is_nonfunction (struct ada_symbol_info syms[], int n)
4199 {
4200 int i;
4201
4202 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
4203 if (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != TYPE_CODE_FUNC
4204 && (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
4205 || SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) != LOC_CONST))
4206 return 1;
4207
4208 return 0;
4209 }
4210
4211 /* If true (non-zero), then TYPE0 and TYPE1 represent equivalent
4212 struct types. Otherwise, they may not. */
4213
4214 static int
4215 equiv_types (struct type *type0, struct type *type1)
4216 {
4217 if (type0 == type1)
4218 return 1;
4219 if (type0 == NULL || type1 == NULL
4220 || TYPE_CODE (type0) != TYPE_CODE (type1))
4221 return 0;
4222 if ((TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
4223 || TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
4224 && ada_type_name (type0) != NULL && ada_type_name (type1) != NULL
4225 && strcmp (ada_type_name (type0), ada_type_name (type1)) == 0)
4226 return 1;
4227
4228 return 0;
4229 }
4230
4231 /* True iff SYM0 represents the same entity as SYM1, or one that is
4232 no more defined than that of SYM1. */
4233
4234 static int
4235 lesseq_defined_than (struct symbol *sym0, struct symbol *sym1)
4236 {
4237 if (sym0 == sym1)
4238 return 1;
4239 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym0) != SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym1)
4240 || SYMBOL_CLASS (sym0) != SYMBOL_CLASS (sym1))
4241 return 0;
4242
4243 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym0))
4244 {
4245 case LOC_UNDEF:
4246 return 1;
4247 case LOC_TYPEDEF:
4248 {
4249 struct type *type0 = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym0);
4250 struct type *type1 = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym1);
4251 char *name0 = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym0);
4252 char *name1 = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym1);
4253 int len0 = strlen (name0);
4254
4255 return
4256 TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE (type1)
4257 && (equiv_types (type0, type1)
4258 || (len0 < strlen (name1) && strncmp (name0, name1, len0) == 0
4259 && strncmp (name1 + len0, "___XV", 5) == 0));
4260 }
4261 case LOC_CONST:
4262 return SYMBOL_VALUE (sym0) == SYMBOL_VALUE (sym1)
4263 && equiv_types (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym0), SYMBOL_TYPE (sym1));
4264 default:
4265 return 0;
4266 }
4267 }
4268
4269 /* Append (SYM,BLOCK,SYMTAB) to the end of the array of struct ada_symbol_info
4270 records in OBSTACKP. Do nothing if SYM is a duplicate. */
4271
4272 static void
4273 add_defn_to_vec (struct obstack *obstackp,
4274 struct symbol *sym,
4275 struct block *block)
4276 {
4277 int i;
4278 struct ada_symbol_info *prevDefns = defns_collected (obstackp, 0);
4279
4280 /* Do not try to complete stub types, as the debugger is probably
4281 already scanning all symbols matching a certain name at the
4282 time when this function is called. Trying to replace the stub
4283 type by its associated full type will cause us to restart a scan
4284 which may lead to an infinite recursion. Instead, the client
4285 collecting the matching symbols will end up collecting several
4286 matches, with at least one of them complete. It can then filter
4287 out the stub ones if needed. */
4288
4289 for (i = num_defns_collected (obstackp) - 1; i >= 0; i -= 1)
4290 {
4291 if (lesseq_defined_than (sym, prevDefns[i].sym))
4292 return;
4293 else if (lesseq_defined_than (prevDefns[i].sym, sym))
4294 {
4295 prevDefns[i].sym = sym;
4296 prevDefns[i].block = block;
4297 return;
4298 }
4299 }
4300
4301 {
4302 struct ada_symbol_info info;
4303
4304 info.sym = sym;
4305 info.block = block;
4306 obstack_grow (obstackp, &info, sizeof (struct ada_symbol_info));
4307 }
4308 }
4309
4310 /* Number of ada_symbol_info structures currently collected in
4311 current vector in *OBSTACKP. */
4312
4313 static int
4314 num_defns_collected (struct obstack *obstackp)
4315 {
4316 return obstack_object_size (obstackp) / sizeof (struct ada_symbol_info);
4317 }
4318
4319 /* Vector of ada_symbol_info structures currently collected in current
4320 vector in *OBSTACKP. If FINISH, close off the vector and return
4321 its final address. */
4322
4323 static struct ada_symbol_info *
4324 defns_collected (struct obstack *obstackp, int finish)
4325 {
4326 if (finish)
4327 return obstack_finish (obstackp);
4328 else
4329 return (struct ada_symbol_info *) obstack_base (obstackp);
4330 }
4331
4332 /* Return a minimal symbol matching NAME according to Ada decoding
4333 rules. Returns NULL if there is no such minimal symbol. Names
4334 prefixed with "standard__" are handled specially: "standard__" is
4335 first stripped off, and only static and global symbols are searched. */
4336
4337 struct minimal_symbol *
4338 ada_lookup_simple_minsym (const char *name)
4339 {
4340 struct objfile *objfile;
4341 struct minimal_symbol *msymbol;
4342 const int wild_match = should_use_wild_match (name);
4343
4344 /* Special case: If the user specifies a symbol name inside package
4345 Standard, do a non-wild matching of the symbol name without
4346 the "standard__" prefix. This was primarily introduced in order
4347 to allow the user to specifically access the standard exceptions
4348 using, for instance, Standard.Constraint_Error when Constraint_Error
4349 is ambiguous (due to the user defining its own Constraint_Error
4350 entity inside its program). */
4351 if (strncmp (name, "standard__", sizeof ("standard__") - 1) == 0)
4352 name += sizeof ("standard__") - 1;
4353
4354 ALL_MSYMBOLS (objfile, msymbol)
4355 {
4356 if (match_name (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (msymbol), name, wild_match)
4357 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (msymbol) != mst_solib_trampoline)
4358 return msymbol;
4359 }
4360
4361 return NULL;
4362 }
4363
4364 /* For all subprograms that statically enclose the subprogram of the
4365 selected frame, add symbols matching identifier NAME in DOMAIN
4366 and their blocks to the list of data in OBSTACKP, as for
4367 ada_add_block_symbols (q.v.). If WILD, treat as NAME with a
4368 wildcard prefix. */
4369
4370 static void
4371 add_symbols_from_enclosing_procs (struct obstack *obstackp,
4372 const char *name, domain_enum namespace,
4373 int wild_match)
4374 {
4375 }
4376
4377 /* True if TYPE is definitely an artificial type supplied to a symbol
4378 for which no debugging information was given in the symbol file. */
4379
4380 static int
4381 is_nondebugging_type (struct type *type)
4382 {
4383 char *name = ada_type_name (type);
4384
4385 return (name != NULL && strcmp (name, "<variable, no debug info>") == 0);
4386 }
4387
4388 /* Return nonzero if TYPE1 and TYPE2 are two enumeration types
4389 that are deemed "identical" for practical purposes.
4390
4391 This function assumes that TYPE1 and TYPE2 are both TYPE_CODE_ENUM
4392 types and that their number of enumerals is identical (in other
4393 words, TYPE_NFIELDS (type1) == TYPE_NFIELDS (type2)). */
4394
4395 static int
4396 ada_identical_enum_types_p (struct type *type1, struct type *type2)
4397 {
4398 int i;
4399
4400 /* The heuristic we use here is fairly conservative. We consider
4401 that 2 enumerate types are identical if they have the same
4402 number of enumerals and that all enumerals have the same
4403 underlying value and name. */
4404
4405 /* All enums in the type should have an identical underlying value. */
4406 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type1); i++)
4407 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type1, i) != TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type2, i))
4408 return 0;
4409
4410 /* All enumerals should also have the same name (modulo any numerical
4411 suffix). */
4412 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type1); i++)
4413 {
4414 char *name_1 = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type1, i);
4415 char *name_2 = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type2, i);
4416 int len_1 = strlen (name_1);
4417 int len_2 = strlen (name_2);
4418
4419 ada_remove_trailing_digits (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type1, i), &len_1);
4420 ada_remove_trailing_digits (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type2, i), &len_2);
4421 if (len_1 != len_2
4422 || strncmp (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type1, i),
4423 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type2, i),
4424 len_1) != 0)
4425 return 0;
4426 }
4427
4428 return 1;
4429 }
4430
4431 /* Return nonzero if all the symbols in SYMS are all enumeral symbols
4432 that are deemed "identical" for practical purposes. Sometimes,
4433 enumerals are not strictly identical, but their types are so similar
4434 that they can be considered identical.
4435
4436 For instance, consider the following code:
4437
4438 type Color is (Black, Red, Green, Blue, White);
4439 type RGB_Color is new Color range Red .. Blue;
4440
4441 Type RGB_Color is a subrange of an implicit type which is a copy
4442 of type Color. If we call that implicit type RGB_ColorB ("B" is
4443 for "Base Type"), then type RGB_ColorB is a copy of type Color.
4444 As a result, when an expression references any of the enumeral
4445 by name (Eg. "print green"), the expression is technically
4446 ambiguous and the user should be asked to disambiguate. But
4447 doing so would only hinder the user, since it wouldn't matter
4448 what choice he makes, the outcome would always be the same.
4449 So, for practical purposes, we consider them as the same. */
4450
4451 static int
4452 symbols_are_identical_enums (struct ada_symbol_info *syms, int nsyms)
4453 {
4454 int i;
4455
4456 /* Before performing a thorough comparison check of each type,
4457 we perform a series of inexpensive checks. We expect that these
4458 checks will quickly fail in the vast majority of cases, and thus
4459 help prevent the unnecessary use of a more expensive comparison.
4460 Said comparison also expects us to make some of these checks
4461 (see ada_identical_enum_types_p). */
4462
4463 /* Quick check: All symbols should have an enum type. */
4464 for (i = 0; i < nsyms; i++)
4465 if (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
4466 return 0;
4467
4468 /* Quick check: They should all have the same value. */
4469 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i++)
4470 if (SYMBOL_VALUE (syms[i].sym) != SYMBOL_VALUE (syms[0].sym))
4471 return 0;
4472
4473 /* Quick check: They should all have the same number of enumerals. */
4474 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i++)
4475 if (TYPE_NFIELDS (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym))
4476 != TYPE_NFIELDS (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[0].sym)))
4477 return 0;
4478
4479 /* All the sanity checks passed, so we might have a set of
4480 identical enumeration types. Perform a more complete
4481 comparison of the type of each symbol. */
4482 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i++)
4483 if (!ada_identical_enum_types_p (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym),
4484 SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[0].sym)))
4485 return 0;
4486
4487 return 1;
4488 }
4489
4490 /* Remove any non-debugging symbols in SYMS[0 .. NSYMS-1] that definitely
4491 duplicate other symbols in the list (The only case I know of where
4492 this happens is when object files containing stabs-in-ecoff are
4493 linked with files containing ordinary ecoff debugging symbols (or no
4494 debugging symbols)). Modifies SYMS to squeeze out deleted entries.
4495 Returns the number of items in the modified list. */
4496
4497 static int
4498 remove_extra_symbols (struct ada_symbol_info *syms, int nsyms)
4499 {
4500 int i, j;
4501
4502 /* We should never be called with less than 2 symbols, as there
4503 cannot be any extra symbol in that case. But it's easy to
4504 handle, since we have nothing to do in that case. */
4505 if (nsyms < 2)
4506 return nsyms;
4507
4508 i = 0;
4509 while (i < nsyms)
4510 {
4511 int remove_p = 0;
4512
4513 /* If two symbols have the same name and one of them is a stub type,
4514 the get rid of the stub. */
4515
4516 if (TYPE_STUB (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym))
4517 && SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym) != NULL)
4518 {
4519 for (j = 0; j < nsyms; j++)
4520 {
4521 if (j != i
4522 && !TYPE_STUB (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[j].sym))
4523 && SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym) != NULL
4524 && strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym),
4525 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym)) == 0)
4526 remove_p = 1;
4527 }
4528 }
4529
4530 /* Two symbols with the same name, same class and same address
4531 should be identical. */
4532
4533 else if (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym) != NULL
4534 && SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == LOC_STATIC
4535 && is_nondebugging_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)))
4536 {
4537 for (j = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4538 {
4539 if (i != j
4540 && SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym) != NULL
4541 && strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym),
4542 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym)) == 0
4543 && SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[j].sym)
4544 && SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (syms[i].sym)
4545 == SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (syms[j].sym))
4546 remove_p = 1;
4547 }
4548 }
4549
4550 if (remove_p)
4551 {
4552 for (j = i + 1; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4553 syms[j - 1] = syms[j];
4554 nsyms -= 1;
4555 }
4556
4557 i += 1;
4558 }
4559
4560 /* If all the remaining symbols are identical enumerals, then
4561 just keep the first one and discard the rest.
4562
4563 Unlike what we did previously, we do not discard any entry
4564 unless they are ALL identical. This is because the symbol
4565 comparison is not a strict comparison, but rather a practical
4566 comparison. If all symbols are considered identical, then
4567 we can just go ahead and use the first one and discard the rest.
4568 But if we cannot reduce the list to a single element, we have
4569 to ask the user to disambiguate anyways. And if we have to
4570 present a multiple-choice menu, it's less confusing if the list
4571 isn't missing some choices that were identical and yet distinct. */
4572 if (symbols_are_identical_enums (syms, nsyms))
4573 nsyms = 1;
4574
4575 return nsyms;
4576 }
4577
4578 /* Given a type that corresponds to a renaming entity, use the type name
4579 to extract the scope (package name or function name, fully qualified,
4580 and following the GNAT encoding convention) where this renaming has been
4581 defined. The string returned needs to be deallocated after use. */
4582
4583 static char *
4584 xget_renaming_scope (struct type *renaming_type)
4585 {
4586 /* The renaming types adhere to the following convention:
4587 <scope>__<rename>___<XR extension>.
4588 So, to extract the scope, we search for the "___XR" extension,
4589 and then backtrack until we find the first "__". */
4590
4591 const char *name = type_name_no_tag (renaming_type);
4592 char *suffix = strstr (name, "___XR");
4593 char *last;
4594 int scope_len;
4595 char *scope;
4596
4597 /* Now, backtrack a bit until we find the first "__". Start looking
4598 at suffix - 3, as the <rename> part is at least one character long. */
4599
4600 for (last = suffix - 3; last > name; last--)
4601 if (last[0] == '_' && last[1] == '_')
4602 break;
4603
4604 /* Make a copy of scope and return it. */
4605
4606 scope_len = last - name;
4607 scope = (char *) xmalloc ((scope_len + 1) * sizeof (char));
4608
4609 strncpy (scope, name, scope_len);
4610 scope[scope_len] = '\0';
4611
4612 return scope;
4613 }
4614
4615 /* Return nonzero if NAME corresponds to a package name. */
4616
4617 static int
4618 is_package_name (const char *name)
4619 {
4620 /* Here, We take advantage of the fact that no symbols are generated
4621 for packages, while symbols are generated for each function.
4622 So the condition for NAME represent a package becomes equivalent
4623 to NAME not existing in our list of symbols. There is only one
4624 small complication with library-level functions (see below). */
4625
4626 char *fun_name;
4627
4628 /* If it is a function that has not been defined at library level,
4629 then we should be able to look it up in the symbols. */
4630 if (standard_lookup (name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN) != NULL)
4631 return 0;
4632
4633 /* Library-level function names start with "_ada_". See if function
4634 "_ada_" followed by NAME can be found. */
4635
4636 /* Do a quick check that NAME does not contain "__", since library-level
4637 functions names cannot contain "__" in them. */
4638 if (strstr (name, "__") != NULL)
4639 return 0;
4640
4641 fun_name = xstrprintf ("_ada_%s", name);
4642
4643 return (standard_lookup (fun_name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN) == NULL);
4644 }
4645
4646 /* Return nonzero if SYM corresponds to a renaming entity that is
4647 not visible from FUNCTION_NAME. */
4648
4649 static int
4650 old_renaming_is_invisible (const struct symbol *sym, char *function_name)
4651 {
4652 char *scope;
4653
4654 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_TYPEDEF)
4655 return 0;
4656
4657 scope = xget_renaming_scope (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym));
4658
4659 make_cleanup (xfree, scope);
4660
4661 /* If the rename has been defined in a package, then it is visible. */
4662 if (is_package_name (scope))
4663 return 0;
4664
4665 /* Check that the rename is in the current function scope by checking
4666 that its name starts with SCOPE. */
4667
4668 /* If the function name starts with "_ada_", it means that it is
4669 a library-level function. Strip this prefix before doing the
4670 comparison, as the encoding for the renaming does not contain
4671 this prefix. */
4672 if (strncmp (function_name, "_ada_", 5) == 0)
4673 function_name += 5;
4674
4675 return (strncmp (function_name, scope, strlen (scope)) != 0);
4676 }
4677
4678 /* Remove entries from SYMS that corresponds to a renaming entity that
4679 is not visible from the function associated with CURRENT_BLOCK or
4680 that is superfluous due to the presence of more specific renaming
4681 information. Places surviving symbols in the initial entries of
4682 SYMS and returns the number of surviving symbols.
4683
4684 Rationale:
4685 First, in cases where an object renaming is implemented as a
4686 reference variable, GNAT may produce both the actual reference
4687 variable and the renaming encoding. In this case, we discard the
4688 latter.
4689
4690 Second, GNAT emits a type following a specified encoding for each renaming
4691 entity. Unfortunately, STABS currently does not support the definition
4692 of types that are local to a given lexical block, so all renamings types
4693 are emitted at library level. As a consequence, if an application
4694 contains two renaming entities using the same name, and a user tries to
4695 print the value of one of these entities, the result of the ada symbol
4696 lookup will also contain the wrong renaming type.
4697
4698 This function partially covers for this limitation by attempting to
4699 remove from the SYMS list renaming symbols that should be visible
4700 from CURRENT_BLOCK. However, there does not seem be a 100% reliable
4701 method with the current information available. The implementation
4702 below has a couple of limitations (FIXME: brobecker-2003-05-12):
4703
4704 - When the user tries to print a rename in a function while there
4705 is another rename entity defined in a package: Normally, the
4706 rename in the function has precedence over the rename in the
4707 package, so the latter should be removed from the list. This is
4708 currently not the case.
4709
4710 - This function will incorrectly remove valid renames if
4711 the CURRENT_BLOCK corresponds to a function which symbol name
4712 has been changed by an "Export" pragma. As a consequence,
4713 the user will be unable to print such rename entities. */
4714
4715 static int
4716 remove_irrelevant_renamings (struct ada_symbol_info *syms,
4717 int nsyms, const struct block *current_block)
4718 {
4719 struct symbol *current_function;
4720 char *current_function_name;
4721 int i;
4722 int is_new_style_renaming;
4723
4724 /* If there is both a renaming foo___XR... encoded as a variable and
4725 a simple variable foo in the same block, discard the latter.
4726 First, zero out such symbols, then compress. */
4727 is_new_style_renaming = 0;
4728 for (i = 0; i < nsyms; i += 1)
4729 {
4730 struct symbol *sym = syms[i].sym;
4731 struct block *block = syms[i].block;
4732 const char *name;
4733 const char *suffix;
4734
4735 if (sym == NULL || SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
4736 continue;
4737 name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym);
4738 suffix = strstr (name, "___XR");
4739
4740 if (suffix != NULL)
4741 {
4742 int name_len = suffix - name;
4743 int j;
4744
4745 is_new_style_renaming = 1;
4746 for (j = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4747 if (i != j && syms[j].sym != NULL
4748 && strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym),
4749 name_len) == 0
4750 && block == syms[j].block)
4751 syms[j].sym = NULL;
4752 }
4753 }
4754 if (is_new_style_renaming)
4755 {
4756 int j, k;
4757
4758 for (j = k = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4759 if (syms[j].sym != NULL)
4760 {
4761 syms[k] = syms[j];
4762 k += 1;
4763 }
4764 return k;
4765 }
4766
4767 /* Extract the function name associated to CURRENT_BLOCK.
4768 Abort if unable to do so. */
4769
4770 if (current_block == NULL)
4771 return nsyms;
4772
4773 current_function = block_linkage_function (current_block);
4774 if (current_function == NULL)
4775 return nsyms;
4776
4777 current_function_name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (current_function);
4778 if (current_function_name == NULL)
4779 return nsyms;
4780
4781 /* Check each of the symbols, and remove it from the list if it is
4782 a type corresponding to a renaming that is out of the scope of
4783 the current block. */
4784
4785 i = 0;
4786 while (i < nsyms)
4787 {
4788 if (ada_parse_renaming (syms[i].sym, NULL, NULL, NULL)
4789 == ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING
4790 && old_renaming_is_invisible (syms[i].sym, current_function_name))
4791 {
4792 int j;
4793
4794 for (j = i + 1; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4795 syms[j - 1] = syms[j];
4796 nsyms -= 1;
4797 }
4798 else
4799 i += 1;
4800 }
4801
4802 return nsyms;
4803 }
4804
4805 /* Add to OBSTACKP all symbols from BLOCK (and its super-blocks)
4806 whose name and domain match NAME and DOMAIN respectively.
4807 If no match was found, then extend the search to "enclosing"
4808 routines (in other words, if we're inside a nested function,
4809 search the symbols defined inside the enclosing functions).
4810
4811 Note: This function assumes that OBSTACKP has 0 (zero) element in it. */
4812
4813 static void
4814 ada_add_local_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp, const char *name,
4815 struct block *block, domain_enum domain,
4816 int wild_match)
4817 {
4818 int block_depth = 0;
4819
4820 while (block != NULL)
4821 {
4822 block_depth += 1;
4823 ada_add_block_symbols (obstackp, block, name, domain, NULL, wild_match);
4824
4825 /* If we found a non-function match, assume that's the one. */
4826 if (is_nonfunction (defns_collected (obstackp, 0),
4827 num_defns_collected (obstackp)))
4828 return;
4829
4830 block = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (block);
4831 }
4832
4833 /* If no luck so far, try to find NAME as a local symbol in some lexically
4834 enclosing subprogram. */
4835 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) == 0 && block_depth > 2)
4836 add_symbols_from_enclosing_procs (obstackp, name, domain, wild_match);
4837 }
4838
4839 /* An object of this type is used as the user_data argument when
4840 calling the map_matching_symbols method. */
4841
4842 struct match_data
4843 {
4844 struct objfile *objfile;
4845 struct obstack *obstackp;
4846 struct symbol *arg_sym;
4847 int found_sym;
4848 };
4849
4850 /* A callback for add_matching_symbols that adds SYM, found in BLOCK,
4851 to a list of symbols. DATA0 is a pointer to a struct match_data *
4852 containing the obstack that collects the symbol list, the file that SYM
4853 must come from, a flag indicating whether a non-argument symbol has
4854 been found in the current block, and the last argument symbol
4855 passed in SYM within the current block (if any). When SYM is null,
4856 marking the end of a block, the argument symbol is added if no
4857 other has been found. */
4858
4859 static int
4860 aux_add_nonlocal_symbols (struct block *block, struct symbol *sym, void *data0)
4861 {
4862 struct match_data *data = (struct match_data *) data0;
4863
4864 if (sym == NULL)
4865 {
4866 if (!data->found_sym && data->arg_sym != NULL)
4867 add_defn_to_vec (data->obstackp,
4868 fixup_symbol_section (data->arg_sym, data->objfile),
4869 block);
4870 data->found_sym = 0;
4871 data->arg_sym = NULL;
4872 }
4873 else
4874 {
4875 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_UNRESOLVED)
4876 return 0;
4877 else if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
4878 data->arg_sym = sym;
4879 else
4880 {
4881 data->found_sym = 1;
4882 add_defn_to_vec (data->obstackp,
4883 fixup_symbol_section (sym, data->objfile),
4884 block);
4885 }
4886 }
4887 return 0;
4888 }
4889
4890 /* Compare STRING1 to STRING2, with results as for strcmp.
4891 Compatible with strcmp_iw in that strcmp_iw (STRING1, STRING2) <= 0
4892 implies compare_names (STRING1, STRING2) (they may differ as to
4893 what symbols compare equal). */
4894
4895 static int
4896 compare_names (const char *string1, const char *string2)
4897 {
4898 while (*string1 != '\0' && *string2 != '\0')
4899 {
4900 if (isspace (*string1) || isspace (*string2))
4901 return strcmp_iw_ordered (string1, string2);
4902 if (*string1 != *string2)
4903 break;
4904 string1 += 1;
4905 string2 += 1;
4906 }
4907 switch (*string1)
4908 {
4909 case '(':
4910 return strcmp_iw_ordered (string1, string2);
4911 case '_':
4912 if (*string2 == '\0')
4913 {
4914 if (is_name_suffix (string1))
4915 return 0;
4916 else
4917 return 1;
4918 }
4919 /* FALLTHROUGH */
4920 default:
4921 if (*string2 == '(')
4922 return strcmp_iw_ordered (string1, string2);
4923 else
4924 return *string1 - *string2;
4925 }
4926 }
4927
4928 /* Add to OBSTACKP all non-local symbols whose name and domain match
4929 NAME and DOMAIN respectively. The search is performed on GLOBAL_BLOCK
4930 symbols if GLOBAL is non-zero, or on STATIC_BLOCK symbols otherwise. */
4931
4932 static void
4933 add_nonlocal_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp, const char *name,
4934 domain_enum domain, int global,
4935 int is_wild_match)
4936 {
4937 struct objfile *objfile;
4938 struct match_data data;
4939
4940 memset (&data, 0, sizeof data);
4941 data.obstackp = obstackp;
4942
4943 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
4944 {
4945 data.objfile = objfile;
4946
4947 if (is_wild_match)
4948 objfile->sf->qf->map_matching_symbols (name, domain, objfile, global,
4949 aux_add_nonlocal_symbols, &data,
4950 wild_match, NULL);
4951 else
4952 objfile->sf->qf->map_matching_symbols (name, domain, objfile, global,
4953 aux_add_nonlocal_symbols, &data,
4954 full_match, compare_names);
4955 }
4956
4957 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) == 0 && global && !is_wild_match)
4958 {
4959 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
4960 {
4961 char *name1 = alloca (strlen (name) + sizeof ("_ada_"));
4962 strcpy (name1, "_ada_");
4963 strcpy (name1 + sizeof ("_ada_") - 1, name);
4964 data.objfile = objfile;
4965 objfile->sf->qf->map_matching_symbols (name1, domain,
4966 objfile, global,
4967 aux_add_nonlocal_symbols,
4968 &data,
4969 full_match, compare_names);
4970 }
4971 }
4972 }
4973
4974 /* Find symbols in DOMAIN matching NAME0, in BLOCK0 and enclosing
4975 scope and in global scopes, returning the number of matches. Sets
4976 *RESULTS to point to a vector of (SYM,BLOCK) tuples,
4977 indicating the symbols found and the blocks and symbol tables (if
4978 any) in which they were found. This vector are transient---good only to
4979 the next call of ada_lookup_symbol_list. Any non-function/non-enumeral
4980 symbol match within the nest of blocks whose innermost member is BLOCK0,
4981 is the one match returned (no other matches in that or
4982 enclosing blocks is returned). If there are any matches in or
4983 surrounding BLOCK0, then these alone are returned. Otherwise, if
4984 FULL_SEARCH is non-zero, then the search extends to global and
4985 file-scope (static) symbol tables.
4986 Names prefixed with "standard__" are handled specially: "standard__"
4987 is first stripped off, and only static and global symbols are searched. */
4988
4989 int
4990 ada_lookup_symbol_list (const char *name0, const struct block *block0,
4991 domain_enum namespace,
4992 struct ada_symbol_info **results,
4993 int full_search)
4994 {
4995 struct symbol *sym;
4996 struct block *block;
4997 const char *name;
4998 const int wild_match = should_use_wild_match (name0);
4999 int cacheIfUnique;
5000 int ndefns;
5001
5002 obstack_free (&symbol_list_obstack, NULL);
5003 obstack_init (&symbol_list_obstack);
5004
5005 cacheIfUnique = 0;
5006
5007 /* Search specified block and its superiors. */
5008
5009 name = name0;
5010 block = (struct block *) block0; /* FIXME: No cast ought to be
5011 needed, but adding const will
5012 have a cascade effect. */
5013
5014 /* Special case: If the user specifies a symbol name inside package
5015 Standard, do a non-wild matching of the symbol name without
5016 the "standard__" prefix. This was primarily introduced in order
5017 to allow the user to specifically access the standard exceptions
5018 using, for instance, Standard.Constraint_Error when Constraint_Error
5019 is ambiguous (due to the user defining its own Constraint_Error
5020 entity inside its program). */
5021 if (strncmp (name0, "standard__", sizeof ("standard__") - 1) == 0)
5022 {
5023 block = NULL;
5024 name = name0 + sizeof ("standard__") - 1;
5025 }
5026
5027 /* Check the non-global symbols. If we have ANY match, then we're done. */
5028
5029 ada_add_local_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, name, block, namespace,
5030 wild_match);
5031 if (num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack) > 0 || !full_search)
5032 goto done;
5033
5034 /* No non-global symbols found. Check our cache to see if we have
5035 already performed this search before. If we have, then return
5036 the same result. */
5037
5038 cacheIfUnique = 1;
5039 if (lookup_cached_symbol (name0, namespace, &sym, &block))
5040 {
5041 if (sym != NULL)
5042 add_defn_to_vec (&symbol_list_obstack, sym, block);
5043 goto done;
5044 }
5045
5046 /* Search symbols from all global blocks. */
5047
5048 add_nonlocal_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, name, namespace, 1,
5049 wild_match);
5050
5051 /* Now add symbols from all per-file blocks if we've gotten no hits
5052 (not strictly correct, but perhaps better than an error). */
5053
5054 if (num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack) == 0)
5055 add_nonlocal_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, name, namespace, 0,
5056 wild_match);
5057
5058 done:
5059 ndefns = num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack);
5060 *results = defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack, 1);
5061
5062 ndefns = remove_extra_symbols (*results, ndefns);
5063
5064 if (ndefns == 0)
5065 cache_symbol (name0, namespace, NULL, NULL);
5066
5067 if (ndefns == 1 && cacheIfUnique)
5068 cache_symbol (name0, namespace, (*results)[0].sym, (*results)[0].block);
5069
5070 ndefns = remove_irrelevant_renamings (*results, ndefns, block0);
5071
5072 return ndefns;
5073 }
5074
5075 /* If NAME is the name of an entity, return a string that should
5076 be used to look that entity up in Ada units. This string should
5077 be deallocated after use using xfree.
5078
5079 NAME can have any form that the "break" or "print" commands might
5080 recognize. In other words, it does not have to be the "natural"
5081 name, or the "encoded" name. */
5082
5083 char *
5084 ada_name_for_lookup (const char *name)
5085 {
5086 char *canon;
5087 int nlen = strlen (name);
5088
5089 if (name[0] == '<' && name[nlen - 1] == '>')
5090 {
5091 canon = xmalloc (nlen - 1);
5092 memcpy (canon, name + 1, nlen - 2);
5093 canon[nlen - 2] = '\0';
5094 }
5095 else
5096 canon = xstrdup (ada_encode (ada_fold_name (name)));
5097 return canon;
5098 }
5099
5100 /* Implementation of the la_iterate_over_symbols method. */
5101
5102 static void
5103 ada_iterate_over_symbols (const struct block *block,
5104 const char *name, domain_enum domain,
5105 int (*callback) (struct symbol *, void *),
5106 void *data)
5107 {
5108 int ndefs, i;
5109 struct ada_symbol_info *results;
5110
5111 ndefs = ada_lookup_symbol_list (name, block, domain, &results, 0);
5112 for (i = 0; i < ndefs; ++i)
5113 {
5114 if (! (*callback) (results[i].sym, data))
5115 break;
5116 }
5117 }
5118
5119 struct symbol *
5120 ada_lookup_encoded_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block0,
5121 domain_enum namespace, struct block **block_found)
5122 {
5123 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
5124 int n_candidates;
5125
5126 n_candidates = ada_lookup_symbol_list (name, block0, namespace, &candidates,
5127 1);
5128
5129 if (n_candidates == 0)
5130 return NULL;
5131
5132 if (block_found != NULL)
5133 *block_found = candidates[0].block;
5134
5135 return fixup_symbol_section (candidates[0].sym, NULL);
5136 }
5137
5138 /* Return a symbol in DOMAIN matching NAME, in BLOCK0 and enclosing
5139 scope and in global scopes, or NULL if none. NAME is folded and
5140 encoded first. Otherwise, the result is as for ada_lookup_symbol_list,
5141 choosing the first symbol if there are multiple choices.
5142 *IS_A_FIELD_OF_THIS is set to 0 and *SYMTAB is set to the symbol
5143 table in which the symbol was found (in both cases, these
5144 assignments occur only if the pointers are non-null). */
5145 struct symbol *
5146 ada_lookup_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block0,
5147 domain_enum namespace, int *is_a_field_of_this)
5148 {
5149 if (is_a_field_of_this != NULL)
5150 *is_a_field_of_this = 0;
5151
5152 return
5153 ada_lookup_encoded_symbol (ada_encode (ada_fold_name (name)),
5154 block0, namespace, NULL);
5155 }
5156
5157 static struct symbol *
5158 ada_lookup_symbol_nonlocal (const char *name,
5159 const struct block *block,
5160 const domain_enum domain)
5161 {
5162 return ada_lookup_symbol (name, block_static_block (block), domain, NULL);
5163 }
5164
5165
5166 /* True iff STR is a possible encoded suffix of a normal Ada name
5167 that is to be ignored for matching purposes. Suffixes of parallel
5168 names (e.g., XVE) are not included here. Currently, the possible suffixes
5169 are given by any of the regular expressions:
5170
5171 [.$][0-9]+ [nested subprogram suffix, on platforms such as GNU/Linux]
5172 ___[0-9]+ [nested subprogram suffix, on platforms such as HP/UX]
5173 TKB [subprogram suffix for task bodies]
5174 _E[0-9]+[bs]$ [protected object entry suffixes]
5175 (X[nb]*)?((\$|__)[0-9](_?[0-9]+)|___(JM|LJM|X([FDBUP].*|R[^T]?)))?$
5176
5177 Also, any leading "__[0-9]+" sequence is skipped before the suffix
5178 match is performed. This sequence is used to differentiate homonyms,
5179 is an optional part of a valid name suffix. */
5180
5181 static int
5182 is_name_suffix (const char *str)
5183 {
5184 int k;
5185 const char *matching;
5186 const int len = strlen (str);
5187
5188 /* Skip optional leading __[0-9]+. */
5189
5190 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str[1] == '_' && isdigit (str[2]))
5191 {
5192 str += 3;
5193 while (isdigit (str[0]))
5194 str += 1;
5195 }
5196
5197 /* [.$][0-9]+ */
5198
5199 if (str[0] == '.' || str[0] == '$')
5200 {
5201 matching = str + 1;
5202 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
5203 matching += 1;
5204 if (matching[0] == '\0')
5205 return 1;
5206 }
5207
5208 /* ___[0-9]+ */
5209
5210 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str[1] == '_' && str[2] == '_')
5211 {
5212 matching = str + 3;
5213 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
5214 matching += 1;
5215 if (matching[0] == '\0')
5216 return 1;
5217 }
5218
5219 /* "TKB" suffixes are used for subprograms implementing task bodies. */
5220
5221 if (strcmp (str, "TKB") == 0)
5222 return 1;
5223
5224 #if 0
5225 /* FIXME: brobecker/2005-09-23: Protected Object subprograms end
5226 with a N at the end. Unfortunately, the compiler uses the same
5227 convention for other internal types it creates. So treating
5228 all entity names that end with an "N" as a name suffix causes
5229 some regressions. For instance, consider the case of an enumerated
5230 type. To support the 'Image attribute, it creates an array whose
5231 name ends with N.
5232 Having a single character like this as a suffix carrying some
5233 information is a bit risky. Perhaps we should change the encoding
5234 to be something like "_N" instead. In the meantime, do not do
5235 the following check. */
5236 /* Protected Object Subprograms */
5237 if (len == 1 && str [0] == 'N')
5238 return 1;
5239 #endif
5240
5241 /* _E[0-9]+[bs]$ */
5242 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str [1] == 'E' && isdigit (str[2]))
5243 {
5244 matching = str + 3;
5245 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
5246 matching += 1;
5247 if ((matching[0] == 'b' || matching[0] == 's')
5248 && matching [1] == '\0')
5249 return 1;
5250 }
5251
5252 /* ??? We should not modify STR directly, as we are doing below. This
5253 is fine in this case, but may become problematic later if we find
5254 that this alternative did not work, and want to try matching
5255 another one from the begining of STR. Since we modified it, we
5256 won't be able to find the begining of the string anymore! */
5257 if (str[0] == 'X')
5258 {
5259 str += 1;
5260 while (str[0] != '_' && str[0] != '\0')
5261 {
5262 if (str[0] != 'n' && str[0] != 'b')
5263 return 0;
5264 str += 1;
5265 }
5266 }
5267
5268 if (str[0] == '\000')
5269 return 1;
5270
5271 if (str[0] == '_')
5272 {
5273 if (str[1] != '_' || str[2] == '\000')
5274 return 0;
5275 if (str[2] == '_')
5276 {
5277 if (strcmp (str + 3, "JM") == 0)
5278 return 1;
5279 /* FIXME: brobecker/2004-09-30: GNAT will soon stop using
5280 the LJM suffix in favor of the JM one. But we will
5281 still accept LJM as a valid suffix for a reasonable
5282 amount of time, just to allow ourselves to debug programs
5283 compiled using an older version of GNAT. */
5284 if (strcmp (str + 3, "LJM") == 0)
5285 return 1;
5286 if (str[3] != 'X')
5287 return 0;
5288 if (str[4] == 'F' || str[4] == 'D' || str[4] == 'B'
5289 || str[4] == 'U' || str[4] == 'P')
5290 return 1;
5291 if (str[4] == 'R' && str[5] != 'T')
5292 return 1;
5293 return 0;
5294 }
5295 if (!isdigit (str[2]))
5296 return 0;
5297 for (k = 3; str[k] != '\0'; k += 1)
5298 if (!isdigit (str[k]) && str[k] != '_')
5299 return 0;
5300 return 1;
5301 }
5302 if (str[0] == '$' && isdigit (str[1]))
5303 {
5304 for (k = 2; str[k] != '\0'; k += 1)
5305 if (!isdigit (str[k]) && str[k] != '_')
5306 return 0;
5307 return 1;
5308 }
5309 return 0;
5310 }
5311
5312 /* Return non-zero if the string starting at NAME and ending before
5313 NAME_END contains no capital letters. */
5314
5315 static int
5316 is_valid_name_for_wild_match (const char *name0)
5317 {
5318 const char *decoded_name = ada_decode (name0);
5319 int i;
5320
5321 /* If the decoded name starts with an angle bracket, it means that
5322 NAME0 does not follow the GNAT encoding format. It should then
5323 not be allowed as a possible wild match. */
5324 if (decoded_name[0] == '<')
5325 return 0;
5326
5327 for (i=0; decoded_name[i] != '\0'; i++)
5328 if (isalpha (decoded_name[i]) && !islower (decoded_name[i]))
5329 return 0;
5330
5331 return 1;
5332 }
5333
5334 /* Advance *NAMEP to next occurrence of TARGET0 in the string NAME0
5335 that could start a simple name. Assumes that *NAMEP points into
5336 the string beginning at NAME0. */
5337
5338 static int
5339 advance_wild_match (const char **namep, const char *name0, int target0)
5340 {
5341 const char *name = *namep;
5342
5343 while (1)
5344 {
5345 int t0, t1;
5346
5347 t0 = *name;
5348 if (t0 == '_')
5349 {
5350 t1 = name[1];
5351 if ((t1 >= 'a' && t1 <= 'z') || (t1 >= '0' && t1 <= '9'))
5352 {
5353 name += 1;
5354 if (name == name0 + 5 && strncmp (name0, "_ada", 4) == 0)
5355 break;
5356 else
5357 name += 1;
5358 }
5359 else if (t1 == '_' && ((name[2] >= 'a' && name[2] <= 'z')
5360 || name[2] == target0))
5361 {
5362 name += 2;
5363 break;
5364 }
5365 else
5366 return 0;
5367 }
5368 else if ((t0 >= 'a' && t0 <= 'z') || (t0 >= '0' && t0 <= '9'))
5369 name += 1;
5370 else
5371 return 0;
5372 }
5373
5374 *namep = name;
5375 return 1;
5376 }
5377
5378 /* Return 0 iff NAME encodes a name of the form prefix.PATN. Ignores any
5379 informational suffixes of NAME (i.e., for which is_name_suffix is
5380 true). Assumes that PATN is a lower-cased Ada simple name. */
5381
5382 static int
5383 wild_match (const char *name, const char *patn)
5384 {
5385 const char *p, *n;
5386 const char *name0 = name;
5387
5388 while (1)
5389 {
5390 const char *match = name;
5391
5392 if (*name == *patn)
5393 {
5394 for (name += 1, p = patn + 1; *p != '\0'; name += 1, p += 1)
5395 if (*p != *name)
5396 break;
5397 if (*p == '\0' && is_name_suffix (name))
5398 return match != name0 && !is_valid_name_for_wild_match (name0);
5399
5400 if (name[-1] == '_')
5401 name -= 1;
5402 }
5403 if (!advance_wild_match (&name, name0, *patn))
5404 return 1;
5405 }
5406 }
5407
5408 /* Returns 0 iff symbol name SYM_NAME matches SEARCH_NAME, apart from
5409 informational suffix. */
5410
5411 static int
5412 full_match (const char *sym_name, const char *search_name)
5413 {
5414 return !match_name (sym_name, search_name, 0);
5415 }
5416
5417
5418 /* Add symbols from BLOCK matching identifier NAME in DOMAIN to
5419 vector *defn_symbols, updating the list of symbols in OBSTACKP
5420 (if necessary). If WILD, treat as NAME with a wildcard prefix.
5421 OBJFILE is the section containing BLOCK.
5422 SYMTAB is recorded with each symbol added. */
5423
5424 static void
5425 ada_add_block_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp,
5426 struct block *block, const char *name,
5427 domain_enum domain, struct objfile *objfile,
5428 int wild)
5429 {
5430 struct dict_iterator iter;
5431 int name_len = strlen (name);
5432 /* A matching argument symbol, if any. */
5433 struct symbol *arg_sym;
5434 /* Set true when we find a matching non-argument symbol. */
5435 int found_sym;
5436 struct symbol *sym;
5437
5438 arg_sym = NULL;
5439 found_sym = 0;
5440 if (wild)
5441 {
5442 for (sym = dict_iter_match_first (BLOCK_DICT (block), name,
5443 wild_match, &iter);
5444 sym != NULL; sym = dict_iter_match_next (name, wild_match, &iter))
5445 {
5446 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym),
5447 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain)
5448 && wild_match (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), name) == 0)
5449 {
5450 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_UNRESOLVED)
5451 continue;
5452 else if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
5453 arg_sym = sym;
5454 else
5455 {
5456 found_sym = 1;
5457 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5458 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
5459 block);
5460 }
5461 }
5462 }
5463 }
5464 else
5465 {
5466 for (sym = dict_iter_match_first (BLOCK_DICT (block), name,
5467 full_match, &iter);
5468 sym != NULL; sym = dict_iter_match_next (name, full_match, &iter))
5469 {
5470 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym),
5471 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain))
5472 {
5473 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED)
5474 {
5475 if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
5476 arg_sym = sym;
5477 else
5478 {
5479 found_sym = 1;
5480 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5481 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
5482 block);
5483 }
5484 }
5485 }
5486 }
5487 }
5488
5489 if (!found_sym && arg_sym != NULL)
5490 {
5491 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5492 fixup_symbol_section (arg_sym, objfile),
5493 block);
5494 }
5495
5496 if (!wild)
5497 {
5498 arg_sym = NULL;
5499 found_sym = 0;
5500
5501 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (block, iter, sym)
5502 {
5503 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym),
5504 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain))
5505 {
5506 int cmp;
5507
5508 cmp = (int) '_' - (int) SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym)[0];
5509 if (cmp == 0)
5510 {
5511 cmp = strncmp ("_ada_", SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), 5);
5512 if (cmp == 0)
5513 cmp = strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym) + 5,
5514 name_len);
5515 }
5516
5517 if (cmp == 0
5518 && is_name_suffix (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym) + name_len + 5))
5519 {
5520 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED)
5521 {
5522 if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
5523 arg_sym = sym;
5524 else
5525 {
5526 found_sym = 1;
5527 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5528 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
5529 block);
5530 }
5531 }
5532 }
5533 }
5534 }
5535
5536 /* NOTE: This really shouldn't be needed for _ada_ symbols.
5537 They aren't parameters, right? */
5538 if (!found_sym && arg_sym != NULL)
5539 {
5540 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5541 fixup_symbol_section (arg_sym, objfile),
5542 block);
5543 }
5544 }
5545 }
5546 \f
5547
5548 /* Symbol Completion */
5549
5550 /* If SYM_NAME is a completion candidate for TEXT, return this symbol
5551 name in a form that's appropriate for the completion. The result
5552 does not need to be deallocated, but is only good until the next call.
5553
5554 TEXT_LEN is equal to the length of TEXT.
5555 Perform a wild match if WILD_MATCH is set.
5556 ENCODED should be set if TEXT represents the start of a symbol name
5557 in its encoded form. */
5558
5559 static const char *
5560 symbol_completion_match (const char *sym_name,
5561 const char *text, int text_len,
5562 int wild_match, int encoded)
5563 {
5564 const int verbatim_match = (text[0] == '<');
5565 int match = 0;
5566
5567 if (verbatim_match)
5568 {
5569 /* Strip the leading angle bracket. */
5570 text = text + 1;
5571 text_len--;
5572 }
5573
5574 /* First, test against the fully qualified name of the symbol. */
5575
5576 if (strncmp (sym_name, text, text_len) == 0)
5577 match = 1;
5578
5579 if (match && !encoded)
5580 {
5581 /* One needed check before declaring a positive match is to verify
5582 that iff we are doing a verbatim match, the decoded version
5583 of the symbol name starts with '<'. Otherwise, this symbol name
5584 is not a suitable completion. */
5585 const char *sym_name_copy = sym_name;
5586 int has_angle_bracket;
5587
5588 sym_name = ada_decode (sym_name);
5589 has_angle_bracket = (sym_name[0] == '<');
5590 match = (has_angle_bracket == verbatim_match);
5591 sym_name = sym_name_copy;
5592 }
5593
5594 if (match && !verbatim_match)
5595 {
5596 /* When doing non-verbatim match, another check that needs to
5597 be done is to verify that the potentially matching symbol name
5598 does not include capital letters, because the ada-mode would
5599 not be able to understand these symbol names without the
5600 angle bracket notation. */
5601 const char *tmp;
5602
5603 for (tmp = sym_name; *tmp != '\0' && !isupper (*tmp); tmp++);
5604 if (*tmp != '\0')
5605 match = 0;
5606 }
5607
5608 /* Second: Try wild matching... */
5609
5610 if (!match && wild_match)
5611 {
5612 /* Since we are doing wild matching, this means that TEXT
5613 may represent an unqualified symbol name. We therefore must
5614 also compare TEXT against the unqualified name of the symbol. */
5615 sym_name = ada_unqualified_name (ada_decode (sym_name));
5616
5617 if (strncmp (sym_name, text, text_len) == 0)
5618 match = 1;
5619 }
5620
5621 /* Finally: If we found a mach, prepare the result to return. */
5622
5623 if (!match)
5624 return NULL;
5625
5626 if (verbatim_match)
5627 sym_name = add_angle_brackets (sym_name);
5628
5629 if (!encoded)
5630 sym_name = ada_decode (sym_name);
5631
5632 return sym_name;
5633 }
5634
5635 /* A companion function to ada_make_symbol_completion_list().
5636 Check if SYM_NAME represents a symbol which name would be suitable
5637 to complete TEXT (TEXT_LEN is the length of TEXT), in which case
5638 it is appended at the end of the given string vector SV.
5639
5640 ORIG_TEXT is the string original string from the user command
5641 that needs to be completed. WORD is the entire command on which
5642 completion should be performed. These two parameters are used to
5643 determine which part of the symbol name should be added to the
5644 completion vector.
5645 if WILD_MATCH is set, then wild matching is performed.
5646 ENCODED should be set if TEXT represents a symbol name in its
5647 encoded formed (in which case the completion should also be
5648 encoded). */
5649
5650 static void
5651 symbol_completion_add (VEC(char_ptr) **sv,
5652 const char *sym_name,
5653 const char *text, int text_len,
5654 const char *orig_text, const char *word,
5655 int wild_match, int encoded)
5656 {
5657 const char *match = symbol_completion_match (sym_name, text, text_len,
5658 wild_match, encoded);
5659 char *completion;
5660
5661 if (match == NULL)
5662 return;
5663
5664 /* We found a match, so add the appropriate completion to the given
5665 string vector. */
5666
5667 if (word == orig_text)
5668 {
5669 completion = xmalloc (strlen (match) + 5);
5670 strcpy (completion, match);
5671 }
5672 else if (word > orig_text)
5673 {
5674 /* Return some portion of sym_name. */
5675 completion = xmalloc (strlen (match) + 5);
5676 strcpy (completion, match + (word - orig_text));
5677 }
5678 else
5679 {
5680 /* Return some of ORIG_TEXT plus sym_name. */
5681 completion = xmalloc (strlen (match) + (orig_text - word) + 5);
5682 strncpy (completion, word, orig_text - word);
5683 completion[orig_text - word] = '\0';
5684 strcat (completion, match);
5685 }
5686
5687 VEC_safe_push (char_ptr, *sv, completion);
5688 }
5689
5690 /* An object of this type is passed as the user_data argument to the
5691 expand_partial_symbol_names method. */
5692 struct add_partial_datum
5693 {
5694 VEC(char_ptr) **completions;
5695 char *text;
5696 int text_len;
5697 char *text0;
5698 char *word;
5699 int wild_match;
5700 int encoded;
5701 };
5702
5703 /* A callback for expand_partial_symbol_names. */
5704 static int
5705 ada_expand_partial_symbol_name (const char *name, void *user_data)
5706 {
5707 struct add_partial_datum *data = user_data;
5708
5709 return symbol_completion_match (name, data->text, data->text_len,
5710 data->wild_match, data->encoded) != NULL;
5711 }
5712
5713 /* Return a list of possible symbol names completing TEXT0. The list
5714 is NULL terminated. WORD is the entire command on which completion
5715 is made. */
5716
5717 static char **
5718 ada_make_symbol_completion_list (char *text0, char *word)
5719 {
5720 char *text;
5721 int text_len;
5722 int wild_match;
5723 int encoded;
5724 VEC(char_ptr) *completions = VEC_alloc (char_ptr, 128);
5725 struct symbol *sym;
5726 struct symtab *s;
5727 struct minimal_symbol *msymbol;
5728 struct objfile *objfile;
5729 struct block *b, *surrounding_static_block = 0;
5730 int i;
5731 struct dict_iterator iter;
5732
5733 if (text0[0] == '<')
5734 {
5735 text = xstrdup (text0);
5736 make_cleanup (xfree, text);
5737 text_len = strlen (text);
5738 wild_match = 0;
5739 encoded = 1;
5740 }
5741 else
5742 {
5743 text = xstrdup (ada_encode (text0));
5744 make_cleanup (xfree, text);
5745 text_len = strlen (text);
5746 for (i = 0; i < text_len; i++)
5747 text[i] = tolower (text[i]);
5748
5749 encoded = (strstr (text0, "__") != NULL);
5750 /* If the name contains a ".", then the user is entering a fully
5751 qualified entity name, and the match must not be done in wild
5752 mode. Similarly, if the user wants to complete what looks like
5753 an encoded name, the match must not be done in wild mode. */
5754 wild_match = (strchr (text0, '.') == NULL && !encoded);
5755 }
5756
5757 /* First, look at the partial symtab symbols. */
5758 {
5759 struct add_partial_datum data;
5760
5761 data.completions = &completions;
5762 data.text = text;
5763 data.text_len = text_len;
5764 data.text0 = text0;
5765 data.word = word;
5766 data.wild_match = wild_match;
5767 data.encoded = encoded;
5768 expand_partial_symbol_names (ada_expand_partial_symbol_name, &data);
5769 }
5770
5771 /* At this point scan through the misc symbol vectors and add each
5772 symbol you find to the list. Eventually we want to ignore
5773 anything that isn't a text symbol (everything else will be
5774 handled by the psymtab code above). */
5775
5776 ALL_MSYMBOLS (objfile, msymbol)
5777 {
5778 QUIT;
5779 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (msymbol),
5780 text, text_len, text0, word, wild_match, encoded);
5781 }
5782
5783 /* Search upwards from currently selected frame (so that we can
5784 complete on local vars. */
5785
5786 for (b = get_selected_block (0); b != NULL; b = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (b))
5787 {
5788 if (!BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (b))
5789 surrounding_static_block = b; /* For elmin of dups */
5790
5791 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
5792 {
5793 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym),
5794 text, text_len, text0, word,
5795 wild_match, encoded);
5796 }
5797 }
5798
5799 /* Go through the symtabs and check the externs and statics for
5800 symbols which match. */
5801
5802 ALL_SYMTABS (objfile, s)
5803 {
5804 QUIT;
5805 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (BLOCKVECTOR (s), GLOBAL_BLOCK);
5806 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
5807 {
5808 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym),
5809 text, text_len, text0, word,
5810 wild_match, encoded);
5811 }
5812 }
5813
5814 ALL_SYMTABS (objfile, s)
5815 {
5816 QUIT;
5817 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (BLOCKVECTOR (s), STATIC_BLOCK);
5818 /* Don't do this block twice. */
5819 if (b == surrounding_static_block)
5820 continue;
5821 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
5822 {
5823 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym),
5824 text, text_len, text0, word,
5825 wild_match, encoded);
5826 }
5827 }
5828
5829 /* Append the closing NULL entry. */
5830 VEC_safe_push (char_ptr, completions, NULL);
5831
5832 /* Make a copy of the COMPLETIONS VEC before we free it, and then
5833 return the copy. It's unfortunate that we have to make a copy
5834 of an array that we're about to destroy, but there is nothing much
5835 we can do about it. Fortunately, it's typically not a very large
5836 array. */
5837 {
5838 const size_t completions_size =
5839 VEC_length (char_ptr, completions) * sizeof (char *);
5840 char **result = xmalloc (completions_size);
5841
5842 memcpy (result, VEC_address (char_ptr, completions), completions_size);
5843
5844 VEC_free (char_ptr, completions);
5845 return result;
5846 }
5847 }
5848
5849 /* Field Access */
5850
5851 /* Return non-zero if TYPE is a pointer to the GNAT dispatch table used
5852 for tagged types. */
5853
5854 static int
5855 ada_is_dispatch_table_ptr_type (struct type *type)
5856 {
5857 char *name;
5858
5859 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
5860 return 0;
5861
5862 name = TYPE_NAME (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
5863 if (name == NULL)
5864 return 0;
5865
5866 return (strcmp (name, "ada__tags__dispatch_table") == 0);
5867 }
5868
5869 /* True if field number FIELD_NUM in struct or union type TYPE is supposed
5870 to be invisible to users. */
5871
5872 int
5873 ada_is_ignored_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
5874 {
5875 if (field_num < 0 || field_num > TYPE_NFIELDS (type))
5876 return 1;
5877
5878 /* Check the name of that field. */
5879 {
5880 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
5881
5882 /* Anonymous field names should not be printed.
5883 brobecker/2007-02-20: I don't think this can actually happen
5884 but we don't want to print the value of annonymous fields anyway. */
5885 if (name == NULL)
5886 return 1;
5887
5888 /* A field named "_parent" is internally generated by GNAT for
5889 tagged types, and should not be printed either. */
5890 if (name[0] == '_' && strncmp (name, "_parent", 7) != 0)
5891 return 1;
5892 }
5893
5894 /* If this is the dispatch table of a tagged type, then ignore. */
5895 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type, 1)
5896 && ada_is_dispatch_table_ptr_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num)))
5897 return 1;
5898
5899 /* Not a special field, so it should not be ignored. */
5900 return 0;
5901 }
5902
5903 /* True iff TYPE has a tag field. If REFOK, then TYPE may also be a
5904 pointer or reference type whose ultimate target has a tag field. */
5905
5906 int
5907 ada_is_tagged_type (struct type *type, int refok)
5908 {
5909 return (ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "_tag", refok, 1, NULL) != NULL);
5910 }
5911
5912 /* True iff TYPE represents the type of X'Tag */
5913
5914 int
5915 ada_is_tag_type (struct type *type)
5916 {
5917 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
5918 return 0;
5919 else
5920 {
5921 const char *name = ada_type_name (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
5922
5923 return (name != NULL
5924 && strcmp (name, "ada__tags__dispatch_table") == 0);
5925 }
5926 }
5927
5928 /* The type of the tag on VAL. */
5929
5930 struct type *
5931 ada_tag_type (struct value *val)
5932 {
5933 return ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (value_type (val), "_tag", 1, 0, NULL);
5934 }
5935
5936 /* The value of the tag on VAL. */
5937
5938 struct value *
5939 ada_value_tag (struct value *val)
5940 {
5941 return ada_value_struct_elt (val, "_tag", 0);
5942 }
5943
5944 /* The value of the tag on the object of type TYPE whose contents are
5945 saved at VALADDR, if it is non-null, or is at memory address
5946 ADDRESS. */
5947
5948 static struct value *
5949 value_tag_from_contents_and_address (struct type *type,
5950 const gdb_byte *valaddr,
5951 CORE_ADDR address)
5952 {
5953 int tag_byte_offset;
5954 struct type *tag_type;
5955
5956 if (find_struct_field ("_tag", type, 0, &tag_type, &tag_byte_offset,
5957 NULL, NULL, NULL))
5958 {
5959 const gdb_byte *valaddr1 = ((valaddr == NULL)
5960 ? NULL
5961 : valaddr + tag_byte_offset);
5962 CORE_ADDR address1 = (address == 0) ? 0 : address + tag_byte_offset;
5963
5964 return value_from_contents_and_address (tag_type, valaddr1, address1);
5965 }
5966 return NULL;
5967 }
5968
5969 static struct type *
5970 type_from_tag (struct value *tag)
5971 {
5972 const char *type_name = ada_tag_name (tag);
5973
5974 if (type_name != NULL)
5975 return ada_find_any_type (ada_encode (type_name));
5976 return NULL;
5977 }
5978
5979 struct tag_args
5980 {
5981 struct value *tag;
5982 char *name;
5983 };
5984
5985
5986 static int ada_tag_name_1 (void *);
5987 static int ada_tag_name_2 (struct tag_args *);
5988
5989 /* Wrapper function used by ada_tag_name. Given a struct tag_args*
5990 value ARGS, sets ARGS->name to the tag name of ARGS->tag.
5991 The value stored in ARGS->name is valid until the next call to
5992 ada_tag_name_1. */
5993
5994 static int
5995 ada_tag_name_1 (void *args0)
5996 {
5997 struct tag_args *args = (struct tag_args *) args0;
5998 static char name[1024];
5999 char *p;
6000 struct value *val;
6001
6002 args->name = NULL;
6003 val = ada_value_struct_elt (args->tag, "tsd", 1);
6004 if (val == NULL)
6005 return ada_tag_name_2 (args);
6006 val = ada_value_struct_elt (val, "expanded_name", 1);
6007 if (val == NULL)
6008 return 0;
6009 read_memory_string (value_as_address (val), name, sizeof (name) - 1);
6010 for (p = name; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
6011 if (isalpha (*p))
6012 *p = tolower (*p);
6013 args->name = name;
6014 return 0;
6015 }
6016
6017 /* Return the "ada__tags__type_specific_data" type. */
6018
6019 static struct type *
6020 ada_get_tsd_type (struct inferior *inf)
6021 {
6022 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (inf);
6023
6024 if (data->tsd_type == 0)
6025 data->tsd_type = ada_find_any_type ("ada__tags__type_specific_data");
6026 return data->tsd_type;
6027 }
6028
6029 /* Utility function for ada_tag_name_1 that tries the second
6030 representation for the dispatch table (in which there is no
6031 explicit 'tsd' field in the referent of the tag pointer, and instead
6032 the tsd pointer is stored just before the dispatch table. */
6033
6034 static int
6035 ada_tag_name_2 (struct tag_args *args)
6036 {
6037 struct type *info_type;
6038 static char name[1024];
6039 char *p;
6040 struct value *val, *valp;
6041
6042 args->name = NULL;
6043 info_type = ada_get_tsd_type (current_inferior());
6044 if (info_type == NULL)
6045 return 0;
6046 info_type = lookup_pointer_type (lookup_pointer_type (info_type));
6047 valp = value_cast (info_type, args->tag);
6048 if (valp == NULL)
6049 return 0;
6050 val = value_ind (value_ptradd (valp, -1));
6051 if (val == NULL)
6052 return 0;
6053 val = ada_value_struct_elt (val, "expanded_name", 1);
6054 if (val == NULL)
6055 return 0;
6056 read_memory_string (value_as_address (val), name, sizeof (name) - 1);
6057 for (p = name; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
6058 if (isalpha (*p))
6059 *p = tolower (*p);
6060 args->name = name;
6061 return 0;
6062 }
6063
6064 /* The type name of the dynamic type denoted by the 'tag value TAG, as
6065 a C string. */
6066
6067 const char *
6068 ada_tag_name (struct value *tag)
6069 {
6070 struct tag_args args;
6071
6072 if (!ada_is_tag_type (value_type (tag)))
6073 return NULL;
6074 args.tag = tag;
6075 args.name = NULL;
6076 catch_errors (ada_tag_name_1, &args, NULL, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
6077 return args.name;
6078 }
6079
6080 /* The parent type of TYPE, or NULL if none. */
6081
6082 struct type *
6083 ada_parent_type (struct type *type)
6084 {
6085 int i;
6086
6087 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6088
6089 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
6090 return NULL;
6091
6092 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6093 if (ada_is_parent_field (type, i))
6094 {
6095 struct type *parent_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i);
6096
6097 /* If the _parent field is a pointer, then dereference it. */
6098 if (TYPE_CODE (parent_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6099 parent_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (parent_type);
6100 /* If there is a parallel XVS type, get the actual base type. */
6101 parent_type = ada_get_base_type (parent_type);
6102
6103 return ada_check_typedef (parent_type);
6104 }
6105
6106 return NULL;
6107 }
6108
6109 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure type TYPE contains the
6110 parent-type (inherited) fields of a derived type. Assumes TYPE is
6111 a structure type with at least FIELD_NUM+1 fields. */
6112
6113 int
6114 ada_is_parent_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
6115 {
6116 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (ada_check_typedef (type), field_num);
6117
6118 return (name != NULL
6119 && (strncmp (name, "PARENT", 6) == 0
6120 || strncmp (name, "_parent", 7) == 0));
6121 }
6122
6123 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure type TYPE is a
6124 transparent wrapper field (which should be silently traversed when doing
6125 field selection and flattened when printing). Assumes TYPE is a
6126 structure type with at least FIELD_NUM+1 fields. Such fields are always
6127 structures. */
6128
6129 int
6130 ada_is_wrapper_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
6131 {
6132 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
6133
6134 return (name != NULL
6135 && (strncmp (name, "PARENT", 6) == 0
6136 || strcmp (name, "REP") == 0
6137 || strncmp (name, "_parent", 7) == 0
6138 || name[0] == 'S' || name[0] == 'R' || name[0] == 'O'));
6139 }
6140
6141 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure or union type TYPE
6142 is a variant wrapper. Assumes TYPE is a structure type with at least
6143 FIELD_NUM+1 fields. */
6144
6145 int
6146 ada_is_variant_part (struct type *type, int field_num)
6147 {
6148 struct type *field_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num);
6149
6150 return (TYPE_CODE (field_type) == TYPE_CODE_UNION
6151 || (is_dynamic_field (type, field_num)
6152 && (TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (field_type))
6153 == TYPE_CODE_UNION)));
6154 }
6155
6156 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is a variant wrapper (type of the variant part)
6157 whose discriminants are contained in the record type OUTER_TYPE,
6158 returns the type of the controlling discriminant for the variant.
6159 May return NULL if the type could not be found. */
6160
6161 struct type *
6162 ada_variant_discrim_type (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type)
6163 {
6164 char *name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
6165
6166 return ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (outer_type, name, 1, 1, NULL);
6167 }
6168
6169 /* Assuming that TYPE is the type of a variant wrapper, and FIELD_NUM is a
6170 valid field number within it, returns 1 iff field FIELD_NUM of TYPE
6171 represents a 'when others' clause; otherwise 0. */
6172
6173 int
6174 ada_is_others_clause (struct type *type, int field_num)
6175 {
6176 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
6177
6178 return (name != NULL && name[0] == 'O');
6179 }
6180
6181 /* Assuming that TYPE0 is the type of the variant part of a record,
6182 returns the name of the discriminant controlling the variant.
6183 The value is valid until the next call to ada_variant_discrim_name. */
6184
6185 char *
6186 ada_variant_discrim_name (struct type *type0)
6187 {
6188 static char *result = NULL;
6189 static size_t result_len = 0;
6190 struct type *type;
6191 const char *name;
6192 const char *discrim_end;
6193 const char *discrim_start;
6194
6195 if (TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6196 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0);
6197 else
6198 type = type0;
6199
6200 name = ada_type_name (type);
6201
6202 if (name == NULL || name[0] == '\000')
6203 return "";
6204
6205 for (discrim_end = name + strlen (name) - 6; discrim_end != name;
6206 discrim_end -= 1)
6207 {
6208 if (strncmp (discrim_end, "___XVN", 6) == 0)
6209 break;
6210 }
6211 if (discrim_end == name)
6212 return "";
6213
6214 for (discrim_start = discrim_end; discrim_start != name + 3;
6215 discrim_start -= 1)
6216 {
6217 if (discrim_start == name + 1)
6218 return "";
6219 if ((discrim_start > name + 3
6220 && strncmp (discrim_start - 3, "___", 3) == 0)
6221 || discrim_start[-1] == '.')
6222 break;
6223 }
6224
6225 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, discrim_end - discrim_start + 1);
6226 strncpy (result, discrim_start, discrim_end - discrim_start);
6227 result[discrim_end - discrim_start] = '\0';
6228 return result;
6229 }
6230
6231 /* Scan STR for a subtype-encoded number, beginning at position K.
6232 Put the position of the character just past the number scanned in
6233 *NEW_K, if NEW_K!=NULL. Put the scanned number in *R, if R!=NULL.
6234 Return 1 if there was a valid number at the given position, and 0
6235 otherwise. A "subtype-encoded" number consists of the absolute value
6236 in decimal, followed by the letter 'm' to indicate a negative number.
6237 Assumes 0m does not occur. */
6238
6239 int
6240 ada_scan_number (const char str[], int k, LONGEST * R, int *new_k)
6241 {
6242 ULONGEST RU;
6243
6244 if (!isdigit (str[k]))
6245 return 0;
6246
6247 /* Do it the hard way so as not to make any assumption about
6248 the relationship of unsigned long (%lu scan format code) and
6249 LONGEST. */
6250 RU = 0;
6251 while (isdigit (str[k]))
6252 {
6253 RU = RU * 10 + (str[k] - '0');
6254 k += 1;
6255 }
6256
6257 if (str[k] == 'm')
6258 {
6259 if (R != NULL)
6260 *R = (-(LONGEST) (RU - 1)) - 1;
6261 k += 1;
6262 }
6263 else if (R != NULL)
6264 *R = (LONGEST) RU;
6265
6266 /* NOTE on the above: Technically, C does not say what the results of
6267 - (LONGEST) RU or (LONGEST) -RU are for RU == largest positive
6268 number representable as a LONGEST (although either would probably work
6269 in most implementations). When RU>0, the locution in the then branch
6270 above is always equivalent to the negative of RU. */
6271
6272 if (new_k != NULL)
6273 *new_k = k;
6274 return 1;
6275 }
6276
6277 /* Assuming that TYPE is a variant part wrapper type (a VARIANTS field),
6278 and FIELD_NUM is a valid field number within it, returns 1 iff VAL is
6279 in the range encoded by field FIELD_NUM of TYPE; otherwise 0. */
6280
6281 int
6282 ada_in_variant (LONGEST val, struct type *type, int field_num)
6283 {
6284 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
6285 int p;
6286
6287 p = 0;
6288 while (1)
6289 {
6290 switch (name[p])
6291 {
6292 case '\0':
6293 return 0;
6294 case 'S':
6295 {
6296 LONGEST W;
6297
6298 if (!ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &W, &p))
6299 return 0;
6300 if (val == W)
6301 return 1;
6302 break;
6303 }
6304 case 'R':
6305 {
6306 LONGEST L, U;
6307
6308 if (!ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &L, &p)
6309 || name[p] != 'T' || !ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &U, &p))
6310 return 0;
6311 if (val >= L && val <= U)
6312 return 1;
6313 break;
6314 }
6315 case 'O':
6316 return 1;
6317 default:
6318 return 0;
6319 }
6320 }
6321 }
6322
6323 /* FIXME: Lots of redundancy below. Try to consolidate. */
6324
6325 /* Given a value ARG1 (offset by OFFSET bytes) of a struct or union type
6326 ARG_TYPE, extract and return the value of one of its (non-static)
6327 fields. FIELDNO says which field. Differs from value_primitive_field
6328 only in that it can handle packed values of arbitrary type. */
6329
6330 static struct value *
6331 ada_value_primitive_field (struct value *arg1, int offset, int fieldno,
6332 struct type *arg_type)
6333 {
6334 struct type *type;
6335
6336 arg_type = ada_check_typedef (arg_type);
6337 type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (arg_type, fieldno);
6338
6339 /* Handle packed fields. */
6340
6341 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (arg_type, fieldno) != 0)
6342 {
6343 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (arg_type, fieldno);
6344 int bit_size = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (arg_type, fieldno);
6345
6346 return ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arg1, value_contents (arg1),
6347 offset + bit_pos / 8,
6348 bit_pos % 8, bit_size, type);
6349 }
6350 else
6351 return value_primitive_field (arg1, offset, fieldno, arg_type);
6352 }
6353
6354 /* Find field with name NAME in object of type TYPE. If found,
6355 set the following for each argument that is non-null:
6356 - *FIELD_TYPE_P to the field's type;
6357 - *BYTE_OFFSET_P to OFFSET + the byte offset of the field within
6358 an object of that type;
6359 - *BIT_OFFSET_P to the bit offset modulo byte size of the field;
6360 - *BIT_SIZE_P to its size in bits if the field is packed, and
6361 0 otherwise;
6362 If INDEX_P is non-null, increment *INDEX_P by the number of source-visible
6363 fields up to but not including the desired field, or by the total
6364 number of fields if not found. A NULL value of NAME never
6365 matches; the function just counts visible fields in this case.
6366
6367 Returns 1 if found, 0 otherwise. */
6368
6369 static int
6370 find_struct_field (char *name, struct type *type, int offset,
6371 struct type **field_type_p,
6372 int *byte_offset_p, int *bit_offset_p, int *bit_size_p,
6373 int *index_p)
6374 {
6375 int i;
6376
6377 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6378
6379 if (field_type_p != NULL)
6380 *field_type_p = NULL;
6381 if (byte_offset_p != NULL)
6382 *byte_offset_p = 0;
6383 if (bit_offset_p != NULL)
6384 *bit_offset_p = 0;
6385 if (bit_size_p != NULL)
6386 *bit_size_p = 0;
6387
6388 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6389 {
6390 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i);
6391 int fld_offset = offset + bit_pos / 8;
6392 char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
6393
6394 if (t_field_name == NULL)
6395 continue;
6396
6397 else if (name != NULL && field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
6398 {
6399 int bit_size = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, i);
6400
6401 if (field_type_p != NULL)
6402 *field_type_p = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i);
6403 if (byte_offset_p != NULL)
6404 *byte_offset_p = fld_offset;
6405 if (bit_offset_p != NULL)
6406 *bit_offset_p = bit_pos % 8;
6407 if (bit_size_p != NULL)
6408 *bit_size_p = bit_size;
6409 return 1;
6410 }
6411 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
6412 {
6413 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), fld_offset,
6414 field_type_p, byte_offset_p, bit_offset_p,
6415 bit_size_p, index_p))
6416 return 1;
6417 }
6418 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
6419 {
6420 /* PNH: Wait. Do we ever execute this section, or is ARG always of
6421 fixed type?? */
6422 int j;
6423 struct type *field_type
6424 = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6425
6426 for (j = 0; j < TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type); j += 1)
6427 {
6428 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j),
6429 fld_offset
6430 + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, j) / 8,
6431 field_type_p, byte_offset_p,
6432 bit_offset_p, bit_size_p, index_p))
6433 return 1;
6434 }
6435 }
6436 else if (index_p != NULL)
6437 *index_p += 1;
6438 }
6439 return 0;
6440 }
6441
6442 /* Number of user-visible fields in record type TYPE. */
6443
6444 static int
6445 num_visible_fields (struct type *type)
6446 {
6447 int n;
6448
6449 n = 0;
6450 find_struct_field (NULL, type, 0, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, &n);
6451 return n;
6452 }
6453
6454 /* Look for a field NAME in ARG. Adjust the address of ARG by OFFSET bytes,
6455 and search in it assuming it has (class) type TYPE.
6456 If found, return value, else return NULL.
6457
6458 Searches recursively through wrapper fields (e.g., '_parent'). */
6459
6460 static struct value *
6461 ada_search_struct_field (char *name, struct value *arg, int offset,
6462 struct type *type)
6463 {
6464 int i;
6465
6466 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6467 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6468 {
6469 char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
6470
6471 if (t_field_name == NULL)
6472 continue;
6473
6474 else if (field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
6475 return ada_value_primitive_field (arg, offset, i, type);
6476
6477 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
6478 {
6479 struct value *v = /* Do not let indent join lines here. */
6480 ada_search_struct_field (name, arg,
6481 offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8,
6482 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6483
6484 if (v != NULL)
6485 return v;
6486 }
6487
6488 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
6489 {
6490 /* PNH: Do we ever get here? See find_struct_field. */
6491 int j;
6492 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type,
6493 i));
6494 int var_offset = offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
6495
6496 for (j = 0; j < TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type); j += 1)
6497 {
6498 struct value *v = ada_search_struct_field /* Force line
6499 break. */
6500 (name, arg,
6501 var_offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, j) / 8,
6502 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j));
6503
6504 if (v != NULL)
6505 return v;
6506 }
6507 }
6508 }
6509 return NULL;
6510 }
6511
6512 static struct value *ada_index_struct_field_1 (int *, struct value *,
6513 int, struct type *);
6514
6515
6516 /* Return field #INDEX in ARG, where the index is that returned by
6517 * find_struct_field through its INDEX_P argument. Adjust the address
6518 * of ARG by OFFSET bytes, and search in it assuming it has (class) type TYPE.
6519 * If found, return value, else return NULL. */
6520
6521 static struct value *
6522 ada_index_struct_field (int index, struct value *arg, int offset,
6523 struct type *type)
6524 {
6525 return ada_index_struct_field_1 (&index, arg, offset, type);
6526 }
6527
6528
6529 /* Auxiliary function for ada_index_struct_field. Like
6530 * ada_index_struct_field, but takes index from *INDEX_P and modifies
6531 * *INDEX_P. */
6532
6533 static struct value *
6534 ada_index_struct_field_1 (int *index_p, struct value *arg, int offset,
6535 struct type *type)
6536 {
6537 int i;
6538 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6539
6540 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6541 {
6542 if (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i) == NULL)
6543 continue;
6544 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
6545 {
6546 struct value *v = /* Do not let indent join lines here. */
6547 ada_index_struct_field_1 (index_p, arg,
6548 offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8,
6549 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6550
6551 if (v != NULL)
6552 return v;
6553 }
6554
6555 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
6556 {
6557 /* PNH: Do we ever get here? See ada_search_struct_field,
6558 find_struct_field. */
6559 error (_("Cannot assign this kind of variant record"));
6560 }
6561 else if (*index_p == 0)
6562 return ada_value_primitive_field (arg, offset, i, type);
6563 else
6564 *index_p -= 1;
6565 }
6566 return NULL;
6567 }
6568
6569 /* Given ARG, a value of type (pointer or reference to a)*
6570 structure/union, extract the component named NAME from the ultimate
6571 target structure/union and return it as a value with its
6572 appropriate type.
6573
6574 The routine searches for NAME among all members of the structure itself
6575 and (recursively) among all members of any wrapper members
6576 (e.g., '_parent').
6577
6578 If NO_ERR, then simply return NULL in case of error, rather than
6579 calling error. */
6580
6581 struct value *
6582 ada_value_struct_elt (struct value *arg, char *name, int no_err)
6583 {
6584 struct type *t, *t1;
6585 struct value *v;
6586
6587 v = NULL;
6588 t1 = t = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg));
6589 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
6590 {
6591 t1 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t);
6592 if (t1 == NULL)
6593 goto BadValue;
6594 t1 = ada_check_typedef (t1);
6595 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6596 {
6597 arg = coerce_ref (arg);
6598 t = t1;
6599 }
6600 }
6601
6602 while (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6603 {
6604 t1 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t);
6605 if (t1 == NULL)
6606 goto BadValue;
6607 t1 = ada_check_typedef (t1);
6608 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6609 {
6610 arg = value_ind (arg);
6611 t = t1;
6612 }
6613 else
6614 break;
6615 }
6616
6617 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT && TYPE_CODE (t1) != TYPE_CODE_UNION)
6618 goto BadValue;
6619
6620 if (t1 == t)
6621 v = ada_search_struct_field (name, arg, 0, t);
6622 else
6623 {
6624 int bit_offset, bit_size, byte_offset;
6625 struct type *field_type;
6626 CORE_ADDR address;
6627
6628 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6629 address = value_as_address (arg);
6630 else
6631 address = unpack_pointer (t, value_contents (arg));
6632
6633 t1 = ada_to_fixed_type (ada_get_base_type (t1), NULL, address, NULL, 1);
6634 if (find_struct_field (name, t1, 0,
6635 &field_type, &byte_offset, &bit_offset,
6636 &bit_size, NULL))
6637 {
6638 if (bit_size != 0)
6639 {
6640 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
6641 arg = ada_coerce_ref (arg);
6642 else
6643 arg = ada_value_ind (arg);
6644 v = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arg, NULL, byte_offset,
6645 bit_offset, bit_size,
6646 field_type);
6647 }
6648 else
6649 v = value_at_lazy (field_type, address + byte_offset);
6650 }
6651 }
6652
6653 if (v != NULL || no_err)
6654 return v;
6655 else
6656 error (_("There is no member named %s."), name);
6657
6658 BadValue:
6659 if (no_err)
6660 return NULL;
6661 else
6662 error (_("Attempt to extract a component of "
6663 "a value that is not a record."));
6664 }
6665
6666 /* Given a type TYPE, look up the type of the component of type named NAME.
6667 If DISPP is non-null, add its byte displacement from the beginning of a
6668 structure (pointed to by a value) of type TYPE to *DISPP (does not
6669 work for packed fields).
6670
6671 Matches any field whose name has NAME as a prefix, possibly
6672 followed by "___".
6673
6674 TYPE can be either a struct or union. If REFOK, TYPE may also
6675 be a (pointer or reference)+ to a struct or union, and the
6676 ultimate target type will be searched.
6677
6678 Looks recursively into variant clauses and parent types.
6679
6680 If NOERR is nonzero, return NULL if NAME is not suitably defined or
6681 TYPE is not a type of the right kind. */
6682
6683 static struct type *
6684 ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (struct type *type, char *name, int refok,
6685 int noerr, int *dispp)
6686 {
6687 int i;
6688
6689 if (name == NULL)
6690 goto BadName;
6691
6692 if (refok && type != NULL)
6693 while (1)
6694 {
6695 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6696 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR
6697 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_REF)
6698 break;
6699 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
6700 }
6701
6702 if (type == NULL
6703 || (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
6704 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_UNION))
6705 {
6706 if (noerr)
6707 return NULL;
6708 else
6709 {
6710 target_terminal_ours ();
6711 gdb_flush (gdb_stdout);
6712 if (type == NULL)
6713 error (_("Type (null) is not a structure or union type"));
6714 else
6715 {
6716 /* XXX: type_sprint */
6717 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stderr, _("Type "));
6718 type_print (type, "", gdb_stderr, -1);
6719 error (_(" is not a structure or union type"));
6720 }
6721 }
6722 }
6723
6724 type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
6725
6726 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6727 {
6728 char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
6729 struct type *t;
6730 int disp;
6731
6732 if (t_field_name == NULL)
6733 continue;
6734
6735 else if (field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
6736 {
6737 if (dispp != NULL)
6738 *dispp += TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
6739 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6740 }
6741
6742 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
6743 {
6744 disp = 0;
6745 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), name,
6746 0, 1, &disp);
6747 if (t != NULL)
6748 {
6749 if (dispp != NULL)
6750 *dispp += disp + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
6751 return t;
6752 }
6753 }
6754
6755 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
6756 {
6757 int j;
6758 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type,
6759 i));
6760
6761 for (j = TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type) - 1; j >= 0; j -= 1)
6762 {
6763 /* FIXME pnh 2008/01/26: We check for a field that is
6764 NOT wrapped in a struct, since the compiler sometimes
6765 generates these for unchecked variant types. Revisit
6766 if the compiler changes this practice. */
6767 char *v_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (field_type, j);
6768 disp = 0;
6769 if (v_field_name != NULL
6770 && field_name_match (v_field_name, name))
6771 t = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j));
6772 else
6773 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type,
6774 j),
6775 name, 0, 1, &disp);
6776
6777 if (t != NULL)
6778 {
6779 if (dispp != NULL)
6780 *dispp += disp + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
6781 return t;
6782 }
6783 }
6784 }
6785
6786 }
6787
6788 BadName:
6789 if (!noerr)
6790 {
6791 target_terminal_ours ();
6792 gdb_flush (gdb_stdout);
6793 if (name == NULL)
6794 {
6795 /* XXX: type_sprint */
6796 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stderr, _("Type "));
6797 type_print (type, "", gdb_stderr, -1);
6798 error (_(" has no component named <null>"));
6799 }
6800 else
6801 {
6802 /* XXX: type_sprint */
6803 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stderr, _("Type "));
6804 type_print (type, "", gdb_stderr, -1);
6805 error (_(" has no component named %s"), name);
6806 }
6807 }
6808
6809 return NULL;
6810 }
6811
6812 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is the type of a variant part of a record (a union),
6813 within a value of type OUTER_TYPE, return true iff VAR_TYPE
6814 represents an unchecked union (that is, the variant part of a
6815 record that is named in an Unchecked_Union pragma). */
6816
6817 static int
6818 is_unchecked_variant (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type)
6819 {
6820 char *discrim_name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
6821
6822 return (ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (outer_type, discrim_name, 0, 1, NULL)
6823 == NULL);
6824 }
6825
6826
6827 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is the type of a variant part of a record (a union),
6828 within a value of type OUTER_TYPE that is stored in GDB at
6829 OUTER_VALADDR, determine which variant clause (field number in VAR_TYPE,
6830 numbering from 0) is applicable. Returns -1 if none are. */
6831
6832 int
6833 ada_which_variant_applies (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type,
6834 const gdb_byte *outer_valaddr)
6835 {
6836 int others_clause;
6837 int i;
6838 char *discrim_name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
6839 struct value *outer;
6840 struct value *discrim;
6841 LONGEST discrim_val;
6842
6843 outer = value_from_contents_and_address (outer_type, outer_valaddr, 0);
6844 discrim = ada_value_struct_elt (outer, discrim_name, 1);
6845 if (discrim == NULL)
6846 return -1;
6847 discrim_val = value_as_long (discrim);
6848
6849 others_clause = -1;
6850 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (var_type); i += 1)
6851 {
6852 if (ada_is_others_clause (var_type, i))
6853 others_clause = i;
6854 else if (ada_in_variant (discrim_val, var_type, i))
6855 return i;
6856 }
6857
6858 return others_clause;
6859 }
6860 \f
6861
6862
6863 /* Dynamic-Sized Records */
6864
6865 /* Strategy: The type ostensibly attached to a value with dynamic size
6866 (i.e., a size that is not statically recorded in the debugging
6867 data) does not accurately reflect the size or layout of the value.
6868 Our strategy is to convert these values to values with accurate,
6869 conventional types that are constructed on the fly. */
6870
6871 /* There is a subtle and tricky problem here. In general, we cannot
6872 determine the size of dynamic records without its data. However,
6873 the 'struct value' data structure, which GDB uses to represent
6874 quantities in the inferior process (the target), requires the size
6875 of the type at the time of its allocation in order to reserve space
6876 for GDB's internal copy of the data. That's why the
6877 'to_fixed_xxx_type' routines take (target) addresses as parameters,
6878 rather than struct value*s.
6879
6880 However, GDB's internal history variables ($1, $2, etc.) are
6881 struct value*s containing internal copies of the data that are not, in
6882 general, the same as the data at their corresponding addresses in
6883 the target. Fortunately, the types we give to these values are all
6884 conventional, fixed-size types (as per the strategy described
6885 above), so that we don't usually have to perform the
6886 'to_fixed_xxx_type' conversions to look at their values.
6887 Unfortunately, there is one exception: if one of the internal
6888 history variables is an array whose elements are unconstrained
6889 records, then we will need to create distinct fixed types for each
6890 element selected. */
6891
6892 /* The upshot of all of this is that many routines take a (type, host
6893 address, target address) triple as arguments to represent a value.
6894 The host address, if non-null, is supposed to contain an internal
6895 copy of the relevant data; otherwise, the program is to consult the
6896 target at the target address. */
6897
6898 /* Assuming that VAL0 represents a pointer value, the result of
6899 dereferencing it. Differs from value_ind in its treatment of
6900 dynamic-sized types. */
6901
6902 struct value *
6903 ada_value_ind (struct value *val0)
6904 {
6905 struct value *val = unwrap_value (value_ind (val0));
6906
6907 return ada_to_fixed_value (val);
6908 }
6909
6910 /* The value resulting from dereferencing any "reference to"
6911 qualifiers on VAL0. */
6912
6913 static struct value *
6914 ada_coerce_ref (struct value *val0)
6915 {
6916 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (val0)) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
6917 {
6918 struct value *val = val0;
6919
6920 val = coerce_ref (val);
6921 val = unwrap_value (val);
6922 return ada_to_fixed_value (val);
6923 }
6924 else
6925 return val0;
6926 }
6927
6928 /* Return OFF rounded upward if necessary to a multiple of
6929 ALIGNMENT (a power of 2). */
6930
6931 static unsigned int
6932 align_value (unsigned int off, unsigned int alignment)
6933 {
6934 return (off + alignment - 1) & ~(alignment - 1);
6935 }
6936
6937 /* Return the bit alignment required for field #F of template type TYPE. */
6938
6939 static unsigned int
6940 field_alignment (struct type *type, int f)
6941 {
6942 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
6943 int len;
6944 int align_offset;
6945
6946 /* The field name should never be null, unless the debugging information
6947 is somehow malformed. In this case, we assume the field does not
6948 require any alignment. */
6949 if (name == NULL)
6950 return 1;
6951
6952 len = strlen (name);
6953
6954 if (!isdigit (name[len - 1]))
6955 return 1;
6956
6957 if (isdigit (name[len - 2]))
6958 align_offset = len - 2;
6959 else
6960 align_offset = len - 1;
6961
6962 if (align_offset < 7 || strncmp ("___XV", name + align_offset - 6, 5) != 0)
6963 return TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
6964
6965 return atoi (name + align_offset) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
6966 }
6967
6968 /* Find a symbol named NAME. Ignores ambiguity. */
6969
6970 struct symbol *
6971 ada_find_any_symbol (const char *name)
6972 {
6973 struct symbol *sym;
6974
6975 sym = standard_lookup (name, get_selected_block (NULL), VAR_DOMAIN);
6976 if (sym != NULL && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
6977 return sym;
6978
6979 sym = standard_lookup (name, NULL, STRUCT_DOMAIN);
6980 return sym;
6981 }
6982
6983 /* Find a type named NAME. Ignores ambiguity. This routine will look
6984 solely for types defined by debug info, it will not search the GDB
6985 primitive types. */
6986
6987 struct type *
6988 ada_find_any_type (const char *name)
6989 {
6990 struct symbol *sym = ada_find_any_symbol (name);
6991
6992 if (sym != NULL)
6993 return SYMBOL_TYPE (sym);
6994
6995 return NULL;
6996 }
6997
6998 /* Given NAME and an associated BLOCK, search all symbols for
6999 NAME suffixed with "___XR", which is the ``renaming'' symbol
7000 associated to NAME. Return this symbol if found, return
7001 NULL otherwise. */
7002
7003 struct symbol *
7004 ada_find_renaming_symbol (const char *name, struct block *block)
7005 {
7006 struct symbol *sym;
7007
7008 sym = find_old_style_renaming_symbol (name, block);
7009
7010 if (sym != NULL)
7011 return sym;
7012
7013 /* Not right yet. FIXME pnh 7/20/2007. */
7014 sym = ada_find_any_symbol (name);
7015 if (sym != NULL && strstr (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), "___XR") != NULL)
7016 return sym;
7017 else
7018 return NULL;
7019 }
7020
7021 static struct symbol *
7022 find_old_style_renaming_symbol (const char *name, struct block *block)
7023 {
7024 const struct symbol *function_sym = block_linkage_function (block);
7025 char *rename;
7026
7027 if (function_sym != NULL)
7028 {
7029 /* If the symbol is defined inside a function, NAME is not fully
7030 qualified. This means we need to prepend the function name
7031 as well as adding the ``___XR'' suffix to build the name of
7032 the associated renaming symbol. */
7033 char *function_name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (function_sym);
7034 /* Function names sometimes contain suffixes used
7035 for instance to qualify nested subprograms. When building
7036 the XR type name, we need to make sure that this suffix is
7037 not included. So do not include any suffix in the function
7038 name length below. */
7039 int function_name_len = ada_name_prefix_len (function_name);
7040 const int rename_len = function_name_len + 2 /* "__" */
7041 + strlen (name) + 6 /* "___XR\0" */ ;
7042
7043 /* Strip the suffix if necessary. */
7044 ada_remove_trailing_digits (function_name, &function_name_len);
7045 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (function_name, &function_name_len);
7046 ada_remove_Xbn_suffix (function_name, &function_name_len);
7047
7048 /* Library-level functions are a special case, as GNAT adds
7049 a ``_ada_'' prefix to the function name to avoid namespace
7050 pollution. However, the renaming symbols themselves do not
7051 have this prefix, so we need to skip this prefix if present. */
7052 if (function_name_len > 5 /* "_ada_" */
7053 && strstr (function_name, "_ada_") == function_name)
7054 {
7055 function_name += 5;
7056 function_name_len -= 5;
7057 }
7058
7059 rename = (char *) alloca (rename_len * sizeof (char));
7060 strncpy (rename, function_name, function_name_len);
7061 xsnprintf (rename + function_name_len, rename_len - function_name_len,
7062 "__%s___XR", name);
7063 }
7064 else
7065 {
7066 const int rename_len = strlen (name) + 6;
7067
7068 rename = (char *) alloca (rename_len * sizeof (char));
7069 xsnprintf (rename, rename_len * sizeof (char), "%s___XR", name);
7070 }
7071
7072 return ada_find_any_symbol (rename);
7073 }
7074
7075 /* Because of GNAT encoding conventions, several GDB symbols may match a
7076 given type name. If the type denoted by TYPE0 is to be preferred to
7077 that of TYPE1 for purposes of type printing, return non-zero;
7078 otherwise return 0. */
7079
7080 int
7081 ada_prefer_type (struct type *type0, struct type *type1)
7082 {
7083 if (type1 == NULL)
7084 return 1;
7085 else if (type0 == NULL)
7086 return 0;
7087 else if (TYPE_CODE (type1) == TYPE_CODE_VOID)
7088 return 1;
7089 else if (TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_VOID)
7090 return 0;
7091 else if (TYPE_NAME (type1) == NULL && TYPE_NAME (type0) != NULL)
7092 return 1;
7093 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type0))
7094 return 1;
7095 else if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type0)
7096 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type1))
7097 return 1;
7098 else
7099 {
7100 const char *type0_name = type_name_no_tag (type0);
7101 const char *type1_name = type_name_no_tag (type1);
7102
7103 if (type0_name != NULL && strstr (type0_name, "___XR") != NULL
7104 && (type1_name == NULL || strstr (type1_name, "___XR") == NULL))
7105 return 1;
7106 }
7107 return 0;
7108 }
7109
7110 /* The name of TYPE, which is either its TYPE_NAME, or, if that is
7111 null, its TYPE_TAG_NAME. Null if TYPE is null. */
7112
7113 char *
7114 ada_type_name (struct type *type)
7115 {
7116 if (type == NULL)
7117 return NULL;
7118 else if (TYPE_NAME (type) != NULL)
7119 return TYPE_NAME (type);
7120 else
7121 return TYPE_TAG_NAME (type);
7122 }
7123
7124 /* Search the list of "descriptive" types associated to TYPE for a type
7125 whose name is NAME. */
7126
7127 static struct type *
7128 find_parallel_type_by_descriptive_type (struct type *type, const char *name)
7129 {
7130 struct type *result;
7131
7132 /* If there no descriptive-type info, then there is no parallel type
7133 to be found. */
7134 if (!HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (type))
7135 return NULL;
7136
7137 result = TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE_TYPE (type);
7138 while (result != NULL)
7139 {
7140 char *result_name = ada_type_name (result);
7141
7142 if (result_name == NULL)
7143 {
7144 warning (_("unexpected null name on descriptive type"));
7145 return NULL;
7146 }
7147
7148 /* If the names match, stop. */
7149 if (strcmp (result_name, name) == 0)
7150 break;
7151
7152 /* Otherwise, look at the next item on the list, if any. */
7153 if (HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (result))
7154 result = TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE_TYPE (result);
7155 else
7156 result = NULL;
7157 }
7158
7159 /* If we didn't find a match, see whether this is a packed array. With
7160 older compilers, the descriptive type information is either absent or
7161 irrelevant when it comes to packed arrays so the above lookup fails.
7162 Fall back to using a parallel lookup by name in this case. */
7163 if (result == NULL && ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type))
7164 return ada_find_any_type (name);
7165
7166 return result;
7167 }
7168
7169 /* Find a parallel type to TYPE with the specified NAME, using the
7170 descriptive type taken from the debugging information, if available,
7171 and otherwise using the (slower) name-based method. */
7172
7173 static struct type *
7174 ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (struct type *type, const char *name)
7175 {
7176 struct type *result = NULL;
7177
7178 if (HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (type))
7179 result = find_parallel_type_by_descriptive_type (type, name);
7180 else
7181 result = ada_find_any_type (name);
7182
7183 return result;
7184 }
7185
7186 /* Same as above, but specify the name of the parallel type by appending
7187 SUFFIX to the name of TYPE. */
7188
7189 struct type *
7190 ada_find_parallel_type (struct type *type, const char *suffix)
7191 {
7192 char *name, *typename = ada_type_name (type);
7193 int len;
7194
7195 if (typename == NULL)
7196 return NULL;
7197
7198 len = strlen (typename);
7199
7200 name = (char *) alloca (len + strlen (suffix) + 1);
7201
7202 strcpy (name, typename);
7203 strcpy (name + len, suffix);
7204
7205 return ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (type, name);
7206 }
7207
7208 /* If TYPE is a variable-size record type, return the corresponding template
7209 type describing its fields. Otherwise, return NULL. */
7210
7211 static struct type *
7212 dynamic_template_type (struct type *type)
7213 {
7214 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7215
7216 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7217 || ada_type_name (type) == NULL)
7218 return NULL;
7219 else
7220 {
7221 int len = strlen (ada_type_name (type));
7222
7223 if (len > 6 && strcmp (ada_type_name (type) + len - 6, "___XVE") == 0)
7224 return type;
7225 else
7226 return ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVE");
7227 }
7228 }
7229
7230 /* Assuming that TEMPL_TYPE is a union or struct type, returns
7231 non-zero iff field FIELD_NUM of TEMPL_TYPE has dynamic size. */
7232
7233 static int
7234 is_dynamic_field (struct type *templ_type, int field_num)
7235 {
7236 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (templ_type, field_num);
7237
7238 return name != NULL
7239 && TYPE_CODE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (templ_type, field_num)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
7240 && strstr (name, "___XVL") != NULL;
7241 }
7242
7243 /* The index of the variant field of TYPE, or -1 if TYPE does not
7244 represent a variant record type. */
7245
7246 static int
7247 variant_field_index (struct type *type)
7248 {
7249 int f;
7250
7251 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
7252 return -1;
7253
7254 for (f = 0; f < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); f += 1)
7255 {
7256 if (ada_is_variant_part (type, f))
7257 return f;
7258 }
7259 return -1;
7260 }
7261
7262 /* A record type with no fields. */
7263
7264 static struct type *
7265 empty_record (struct type *template)
7266 {
7267 struct type *type = alloc_type_copy (template);
7268
7269 TYPE_CODE (type) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
7270 TYPE_NFIELDS (type) = 0;
7271 TYPE_FIELDS (type) = NULL;
7272 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (type);
7273 TYPE_NAME (type) = "<empty>";
7274 TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) = NULL;
7275 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = 0;
7276 return type;
7277 }
7278
7279 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
7280 the value of type TYPE at VALADDR or ADDRESS (see comments at
7281 the beginning of this section) VAL according to GNAT conventions.
7282 DVAL0 should describe the (portion of a) record that contains any
7283 necessary discriminants. It should be NULL if value_type (VAL) is
7284 an outer-level type (i.e., as opposed to a branch of a variant.) A
7285 variant field (unless unchecked) is replaced by a particular branch
7286 of the variant.
7287
7288 If not KEEP_DYNAMIC_FIELDS, then all fields whose position or
7289 length are not statically known are discarded. As a consequence,
7290 VALADDR, ADDRESS and DVAL0 are ignored.
7291
7292 NOTE: Limitations: For now, we assume that dynamic fields and
7293 variants occupy whole numbers of bytes. However, they need not be
7294 byte-aligned. */
7295
7296 struct type *
7297 ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 (struct type *type,
7298 const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7299 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0,
7300 int keep_dynamic_fields)
7301 {
7302 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
7303 struct value *dval;
7304 struct type *rtype;
7305 int nfields, bit_len;
7306 int variant_field;
7307 long off;
7308 int fld_bit_len;
7309 int f;
7310
7311 /* Compute the number of fields in this record type that are going
7312 to be processed: unless keep_dynamic_fields, this includes only
7313 fields whose position and length are static will be processed. */
7314 if (keep_dynamic_fields)
7315 nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type);
7316 else
7317 {
7318 nfields = 0;
7319 while (nfields < TYPE_NFIELDS (type)
7320 && !ada_is_variant_part (type, nfields)
7321 && !is_dynamic_field (type, nfields))
7322 nfields++;
7323 }
7324
7325 rtype = alloc_type_copy (type);
7326 TYPE_CODE (rtype) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
7327 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (rtype);
7328 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) = nfields;
7329 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype) = (struct field *)
7330 TYPE_ALLOC (rtype, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
7331 memset (TYPE_FIELDS (rtype), 0, sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
7332 TYPE_NAME (rtype) = ada_type_name (type);
7333 TYPE_TAG_NAME (rtype) = NULL;
7334 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (rtype) = 1;
7335
7336 off = 0;
7337 bit_len = 0;
7338 variant_field = -1;
7339
7340 for (f = 0; f < nfields; f += 1)
7341 {
7342 off = align_value (off, field_alignment (type, f))
7343 + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, f);
7344 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (rtype, f) = off;
7345 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, f) = 0;
7346
7347 if (ada_is_variant_part (type, f))
7348 {
7349 variant_field = f;
7350 fld_bit_len = 0;
7351 }
7352 else if (is_dynamic_field (type, f))
7353 {
7354 const gdb_byte *field_valaddr = valaddr;
7355 CORE_ADDR field_address = address;
7356 struct type *field_type =
7357 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f));
7358
7359 if (dval0 == NULL)
7360 {
7361 /* rtype's length is computed based on the run-time
7362 value of discriminants. If the discriminants are not
7363 initialized, the type size may be completely bogus and
7364 GDB may fail to allocate a value for it. So check the
7365 size first before creating the value. */
7366 check_size (rtype);
7367 dval = value_from_contents_and_address (rtype, valaddr, address);
7368 }
7369 else
7370 dval = dval0;
7371
7372 /* If the type referenced by this field is an aligner type, we need
7373 to unwrap that aligner type, because its size might not be set.
7374 Keeping the aligner type would cause us to compute the wrong
7375 size for this field, impacting the offset of the all the fields
7376 that follow this one. */
7377 if (ada_is_aligner_type (field_type))
7378 {
7379 long field_offset = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, f);
7380
7381 field_valaddr = cond_offset_host (field_valaddr, field_offset);
7382 field_address = cond_offset_target (field_address, field_offset);
7383 field_type = ada_aligned_type (field_type);
7384 }
7385
7386 field_valaddr = cond_offset_host (field_valaddr,
7387 off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
7388 field_address = cond_offset_target (field_address,
7389 off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
7390
7391 /* Get the fixed type of the field. Note that, in this case,
7392 we do not want to get the real type out of the tag: if
7393 the current field is the parent part of a tagged record,
7394 we will get the tag of the object. Clearly wrong: the real
7395 type of the parent is not the real type of the child. We
7396 would end up in an infinite loop. */
7397 field_type = ada_get_base_type (field_type);
7398 field_type = ada_to_fixed_type (field_type, field_valaddr,
7399 field_address, dval, 0);
7400 /* If the field size is already larger than the maximum
7401 object size, then the record itself will necessarily
7402 be larger than the maximum object size. We need to make
7403 this check now, because the size might be so ridiculously
7404 large (due to an uninitialized variable in the inferior)
7405 that it would cause an overflow when adding it to the
7406 record size. */
7407 check_size (field_type);
7408
7409 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f) = field_type;
7410 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
7411 /* The multiplication can potentially overflow. But because
7412 the field length has been size-checked just above, and
7413 assuming that the maximum size is a reasonable value,
7414 an overflow should not happen in practice. So rather than
7415 adding overflow recovery code to this already complex code,
7416 we just assume that it's not going to happen. */
7417 fld_bit_len =
7418 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7419 }
7420 else
7421 {
7422 struct type *field_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f);
7423
7424 /* If our field is a typedef type (most likely a typedef of
7425 a fat pointer, encoding an array access), then we need to
7426 look at its target type to determine its characteristics.
7427 In particular, we would miscompute the field size if we took
7428 the size of the typedef (zero), instead of the size of
7429 the target type. */
7430 if (TYPE_CODE (field_type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
7431 field_type = ada_typedef_target_type (field_type);
7432
7433 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f) = field_type;
7434 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
7435 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, f) > 0)
7436 fld_bit_len =
7437 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, f);
7438 else
7439 fld_bit_len =
7440 TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (field_type)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7441 }
7442 if (off + fld_bit_len > bit_len)
7443 bit_len = off + fld_bit_len;
7444 off += fld_bit_len;
7445 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) =
7446 align_value (bit_len, TARGET_CHAR_BIT) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7447 }
7448
7449 /* We handle the variant part, if any, at the end because of certain
7450 odd cases in which it is re-ordered so as NOT to be the last field of
7451 the record. This can happen in the presence of representation
7452 clauses. */
7453 if (variant_field >= 0)
7454 {
7455 struct type *branch_type;
7456
7457 off = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (rtype, variant_field);
7458
7459 if (dval0 == NULL)
7460 dval = value_from_contents_and_address (rtype, valaddr, address);
7461 else
7462 dval = dval0;
7463
7464 branch_type =
7465 to_fixed_variant_branch_type
7466 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field),
7467 cond_offset_host (valaddr, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT),
7468 cond_offset_target (address, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), dval);
7469 if (branch_type == NULL)
7470 {
7471 for (f = variant_field + 1; f < TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype); f += 1)
7472 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f - 1] = TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f];
7473 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) -= 1;
7474 }
7475 else
7476 {
7477 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field) = branch_type;
7478 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, variant_field) = "S";
7479 fld_bit_len =
7480 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field)) *
7481 TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7482 if (off + fld_bit_len > bit_len)
7483 bit_len = off + fld_bit_len;
7484 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) =
7485 align_value (bit_len, TARGET_CHAR_BIT) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7486 }
7487 }
7488
7489 /* According to exp_dbug.ads, the size of TYPE for variable-size records
7490 should contain the alignment of that record, which should be a strictly
7491 positive value. If null or negative, then something is wrong, most
7492 probably in the debug info. In that case, we don't round up the size
7493 of the resulting type. If this record is not part of another structure,
7494 the current RTYPE length might be good enough for our purposes. */
7495 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) <= 0)
7496 {
7497 if (TYPE_NAME (rtype))
7498 warning (_("Invalid type size for `%s' detected: %d."),
7499 TYPE_NAME (rtype), TYPE_LENGTH (type));
7500 else
7501 warning (_("Invalid type size for <unnamed> detected: %d."),
7502 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
7503 }
7504 else
7505 {
7506 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) = align_value (TYPE_LENGTH (rtype),
7507 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
7508 }
7509
7510 value_free_to_mark (mark);
7511 if (TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) > varsize_limit)
7512 error (_("record type with dynamic size is larger than varsize-limit"));
7513 return rtype;
7514 }
7515
7516 /* As for ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 with KEEP_DYNAMIC_FIELDS
7517 of 1. */
7518
7519 static struct type *
7520 template_to_fixed_record_type (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7521 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0)
7522 {
7523 return ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 (type, valaddr,
7524 address, dval0, 1);
7525 }
7526
7527 /* An ordinary record type in which ___XVL-convention fields and
7528 ___XVU- and ___XVN-convention field types in TYPE0 are replaced with
7529 static approximations, containing all possible fields. Uses
7530 no runtime values. Useless for use in values, but that's OK,
7531 since the results are used only for type determinations. Works on both
7532 structs and unions. Representation note: to save space, we memorize
7533 the result of this function in the TYPE_TARGET_TYPE of the
7534 template type. */
7535
7536 static struct type *
7537 template_to_static_fixed_type (struct type *type0)
7538 {
7539 struct type *type;
7540 int nfields;
7541 int f;
7542
7543 if (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) != NULL)
7544 return TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0);
7545
7546 nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type0);
7547 type = type0;
7548
7549 for (f = 0; f < nfields; f += 1)
7550 {
7551 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type0, f));
7552 struct type *new_type;
7553
7554 if (is_dynamic_field (type0, f))
7555 new_type = to_static_fixed_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (field_type));
7556 else
7557 new_type = static_unwrap_type (field_type);
7558 if (type == type0 && new_type != field_type)
7559 {
7560 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) = type = alloc_type_copy (type0);
7561 TYPE_CODE (type) = TYPE_CODE (type0);
7562 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (type);
7563 TYPE_NFIELDS (type) = nfields;
7564 TYPE_FIELDS (type) = (struct field *)
7565 TYPE_ALLOC (type, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
7566 memcpy (TYPE_FIELDS (type), TYPE_FIELDS (type0),
7567 sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
7568 TYPE_NAME (type) = ada_type_name (type0);
7569 TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) = NULL;
7570 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type) = 1;
7571 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = 0;
7572 }
7573 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f) = new_type;
7574 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type0, f);
7575 }
7576 return type;
7577 }
7578
7579 /* Given an object of type TYPE whose contents are at VALADDR and
7580 whose address in memory is ADDRESS, returns a revision of TYPE,
7581 which should be a non-dynamic-sized record, in which the variant
7582 part, if any, is replaced with the appropriate branch. Looks
7583 for discriminant values in DVAL0, which can be NULL if the record
7584 contains the necessary discriminant values. */
7585
7586 static struct type *
7587 to_record_with_fixed_variant_part (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7588 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0)
7589 {
7590 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
7591 struct value *dval;
7592 struct type *rtype;
7593 struct type *branch_type;
7594 int nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type);
7595 int variant_field = variant_field_index (type);
7596
7597 if (variant_field == -1)
7598 return type;
7599
7600 if (dval0 == NULL)
7601 dval = value_from_contents_and_address (type, valaddr, address);
7602 else
7603 dval = dval0;
7604
7605 rtype = alloc_type_copy (type);
7606 TYPE_CODE (rtype) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
7607 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (rtype);
7608 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) = nfields;
7609 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype) =
7610 (struct field *) TYPE_ALLOC (rtype, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
7611 memcpy (TYPE_FIELDS (rtype), TYPE_FIELDS (type),
7612 sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
7613 TYPE_NAME (rtype) = ada_type_name (type);
7614 TYPE_TAG_NAME (rtype) = NULL;
7615 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (rtype) = 1;
7616 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) = TYPE_LENGTH (type);
7617
7618 branch_type = to_fixed_variant_branch_type
7619 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field),
7620 cond_offset_host (valaddr,
7621 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, variant_field)
7622 / TARGET_CHAR_BIT),
7623 cond_offset_target (address,
7624 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, variant_field)
7625 / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), dval);
7626 if (branch_type == NULL)
7627 {
7628 int f;
7629
7630 for (f = variant_field + 1; f < nfields; f += 1)
7631 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f - 1] = TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f];
7632 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) -= 1;
7633 }
7634 else
7635 {
7636 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field) = branch_type;
7637 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, variant_field) = "S";
7638 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, variant_field) = 0;
7639 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) += TYPE_LENGTH (branch_type);
7640 }
7641 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) -= TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field));
7642
7643 value_free_to_mark (mark);
7644 return rtype;
7645 }
7646
7647 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
7648 the value at (TYPE0, VALADDR, ADDRESS) [see explanation at
7649 beginning of this section]. Any necessary discriminants' values
7650 should be in DVAL, a record value; it may be NULL if the object
7651 at ADDR itself contains any necessary discriminant values.
7652 Additionally, VALADDR and ADDRESS may also be NULL if no discriminant
7653 values from the record are needed. Except in the case that DVAL,
7654 VALADDR, and ADDRESS are all 0 or NULL, a variant field (unless
7655 unchecked) is replaced by a particular branch of the variant.
7656
7657 NOTE: the case in which DVAL and VALADDR are NULL and ADDRESS is 0
7658 is questionable and may be removed. It can arise during the
7659 processing of an unconstrained-array-of-record type where all the
7660 variant branches have exactly the same size. This is because in
7661 such cases, the compiler does not bother to use the XVS convention
7662 when encoding the record. I am currently dubious of this
7663 shortcut and suspect the compiler should be altered. FIXME. */
7664
7665 static struct type *
7666 to_fixed_record_type (struct type *type0, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7667 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval)
7668 {
7669 struct type *templ_type;
7670
7671 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
7672 return type0;
7673
7674 templ_type = dynamic_template_type (type0);
7675
7676 if (templ_type != NULL)
7677 return template_to_fixed_record_type (templ_type, valaddr, address, dval);
7678 else if (variant_field_index (type0) >= 0)
7679 {
7680 if (dval == NULL && valaddr == NULL && address == 0)
7681 return type0;
7682 return to_record_with_fixed_variant_part (type0, valaddr, address,
7683 dval);
7684 }
7685 else
7686 {
7687 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0) = 1;
7688 return type0;
7689 }
7690
7691 }
7692
7693 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
7694 the value at (VAR_TYPE0, VALADDR, ADDRESS), where VAR_TYPE0 is a
7695 union type. Any necessary discriminants' values should be in DVAL,
7696 a record value. That is, this routine selects the appropriate
7697 branch of the union at ADDR according to the discriminant value
7698 indicated in the union's type name. Returns VAR_TYPE0 itself if
7699 it represents a variant subject to a pragma Unchecked_Union. */
7700
7701 static struct type *
7702 to_fixed_variant_branch_type (struct type *var_type0, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7703 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval)
7704 {
7705 int which;
7706 struct type *templ_type;
7707 struct type *var_type;
7708
7709 if (TYPE_CODE (var_type0) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
7710 var_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (var_type0);
7711 else
7712 var_type = var_type0;
7713
7714 templ_type = ada_find_parallel_type (var_type, "___XVU");
7715
7716 if (templ_type != NULL)
7717 var_type = templ_type;
7718
7719 if (is_unchecked_variant (var_type, value_type (dval)))
7720 return var_type0;
7721 which =
7722 ada_which_variant_applies (var_type,
7723 value_type (dval), value_contents (dval));
7724
7725 if (which < 0)
7726 return empty_record (var_type);
7727 else if (is_dynamic_field (var_type, which))
7728 return to_fixed_record_type
7729 (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which)),
7730 valaddr, address, dval);
7731 else if (variant_field_index (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which)) >= 0)
7732 return
7733 to_fixed_record_type
7734 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which), valaddr, address, dval);
7735 else
7736 return TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which);
7737 }
7738
7739 /* Assuming that TYPE0 is an array type describing the type of a value
7740 at ADDR, and that DVAL describes a record containing any
7741 discriminants used in TYPE0, returns a type for the value that
7742 contains no dynamic components (that is, no components whose sizes
7743 are determined by run-time quantities). Unless IGNORE_TOO_BIG is
7744 true, gives an error message if the resulting type's size is over
7745 varsize_limit. */
7746
7747 static struct type *
7748 to_fixed_array_type (struct type *type0, struct value *dval,
7749 int ignore_too_big)
7750 {
7751 struct type *index_type_desc;
7752 struct type *result;
7753 int constrained_packed_array_p;
7754
7755 type0 = ada_check_typedef (type0);
7756 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
7757 return type0;
7758
7759 constrained_packed_array_p = ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type0);
7760 if (constrained_packed_array_p)
7761 type0 = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type0);
7762
7763 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type0, "___XA");
7764 ada_fixup_array_indexes_type (index_type_desc);
7765 if (index_type_desc == NULL)
7766 {
7767 struct type *elt_type0 = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0));
7768
7769 /* NOTE: elt_type---the fixed version of elt_type0---should never
7770 depend on the contents of the array in properly constructed
7771 debugging data. */
7772 /* Create a fixed version of the array element type.
7773 We're not providing the address of an element here,
7774 and thus the actual object value cannot be inspected to do
7775 the conversion. This should not be a problem, since arrays of
7776 unconstrained objects are not allowed. In particular, all
7777 the elements of an array of a tagged type should all be of
7778 the same type specified in the debugging info. No need to
7779 consult the object tag. */
7780 struct type *elt_type = ada_to_fixed_type (elt_type0, 0, 0, dval, 1);
7781
7782 /* Make sure we always create a new array type when dealing with
7783 packed array types, since we're going to fix-up the array
7784 type length and element bitsize a little further down. */
7785 if (elt_type0 == elt_type && !constrained_packed_array_p)
7786 result = type0;
7787 else
7788 result = create_array_type (alloc_type_copy (type0),
7789 elt_type, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0));
7790 }
7791 else
7792 {
7793 int i;
7794 struct type *elt_type0;
7795
7796 elt_type0 = type0;
7797 for (i = TYPE_NFIELDS (index_type_desc); i > 0; i -= 1)
7798 elt_type0 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type0);
7799
7800 /* NOTE: result---the fixed version of elt_type0---should never
7801 depend on the contents of the array in properly constructed
7802 debugging data. */
7803 /* Create a fixed version of the array element type.
7804 We're not providing the address of an element here,
7805 and thus the actual object value cannot be inspected to do
7806 the conversion. This should not be a problem, since arrays of
7807 unconstrained objects are not allowed. In particular, all
7808 the elements of an array of a tagged type should all be of
7809 the same type specified in the debugging info. No need to
7810 consult the object tag. */
7811 result =
7812 ada_to_fixed_type (ada_check_typedef (elt_type0), 0, 0, dval, 1);
7813
7814 elt_type0 = type0;
7815 for (i = TYPE_NFIELDS (index_type_desc) - 1; i >= 0; i -= 1)
7816 {
7817 struct type *range_type =
7818 to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_type_desc, i), dval);
7819
7820 result = create_array_type (alloc_type_copy (elt_type0),
7821 result, range_type);
7822 elt_type0 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type0);
7823 }
7824 if (!ignore_too_big && TYPE_LENGTH (result) > varsize_limit)
7825 error (_("array type with dynamic size is larger than varsize-limit"));
7826 }
7827
7828 if (constrained_packed_array_p)
7829 {
7830 /* So far, the resulting type has been created as if the original
7831 type was a regular (non-packed) array type. As a result, the
7832 bitsize of the array elements needs to be set again, and the array
7833 length needs to be recomputed based on that bitsize. */
7834 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (result) / TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (result));
7835 int elt_bitsize = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type0, 0);
7836
7837 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (result, 0) = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type0, 0);
7838 TYPE_LENGTH (result) = len * elt_bitsize / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
7839 if (TYPE_LENGTH (result) * HOST_CHAR_BIT < len * elt_bitsize)
7840 TYPE_LENGTH (result)++;
7841 }
7842
7843 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (result) = 1;
7844 return result;
7845 }
7846
7847
7848 /* A standard type (containing no dynamically sized components)
7849 corresponding to TYPE for the value (TYPE, VALADDR, ADDRESS)
7850 DVAL describes a record containing any discriminants used in TYPE0,
7851 and may be NULL if there are none, or if the object of type TYPE at
7852 ADDRESS or in VALADDR contains these discriminants.
7853
7854 If CHECK_TAG is not null, in the case of tagged types, this function
7855 attempts to locate the object's tag and use it to compute the actual
7856 type. However, when ADDRESS is null, we cannot use it to determine the
7857 location of the tag, and therefore compute the tagged type's actual type.
7858 So we return the tagged type without consulting the tag. */
7859
7860 static struct type *
7861 ada_to_fixed_type_1 (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7862 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval, int check_tag)
7863 {
7864 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7865 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
7866 {
7867 default:
7868 return type;
7869 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
7870 {
7871 struct type *static_type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
7872 struct type *fixed_record_type =
7873 to_fixed_record_type (type, valaddr, address, NULL);
7874
7875 /* If STATIC_TYPE is a tagged type and we know the object's address,
7876 then we can determine its tag, and compute the object's actual
7877 type from there. Note that we have to use the fixed record
7878 type (the parent part of the record may have dynamic fields
7879 and the way the location of _tag is expressed may depend on
7880 them). */
7881
7882 if (check_tag && address != 0 && ada_is_tagged_type (static_type, 0))
7883 {
7884 struct type *real_type =
7885 type_from_tag (value_tag_from_contents_and_address
7886 (fixed_record_type,
7887 valaddr,
7888 address));
7889
7890 if (real_type != NULL)
7891 return to_fixed_record_type (real_type, valaddr, address, NULL);
7892 }
7893
7894 /* Check to see if there is a parallel ___XVZ variable.
7895 If there is, then it provides the actual size of our type. */
7896 else if (ada_type_name (fixed_record_type) != NULL)
7897 {
7898 char *name = ada_type_name (fixed_record_type);
7899 char *xvz_name = alloca (strlen (name) + 7 /* "___XVZ\0" */);
7900 int xvz_found = 0;
7901 LONGEST size;
7902
7903 xsnprintf (xvz_name, strlen (name) + 7, "%s___XVZ", name);
7904 size = get_int_var_value (xvz_name, &xvz_found);
7905 if (xvz_found && TYPE_LENGTH (fixed_record_type) != size)
7906 {
7907 fixed_record_type = copy_type (fixed_record_type);
7908 TYPE_LENGTH (fixed_record_type) = size;
7909
7910 /* The FIXED_RECORD_TYPE may have be a stub. We have
7911 observed this when the debugging info is STABS, and
7912 apparently it is something that is hard to fix.
7913
7914 In practice, we don't need the actual type definition
7915 at all, because the presence of the XVZ variable allows us
7916 to assume that there must be a XVS type as well, which we
7917 should be able to use later, when we need the actual type
7918 definition.
7919
7920 In the meantime, pretend that the "fixed" type we are
7921 returning is NOT a stub, because this can cause trouble
7922 when using this type to create new types targeting it.
7923 Indeed, the associated creation routines often check
7924 whether the target type is a stub and will try to replace
7925 it, thus using a type with the wrong size. This, in turn,
7926 might cause the new type to have the wrong size too.
7927 Consider the case of an array, for instance, where the size
7928 of the array is computed from the number of elements in
7929 our array multiplied by the size of its element. */
7930 TYPE_STUB (fixed_record_type) = 0;
7931 }
7932 }
7933 return fixed_record_type;
7934 }
7935 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
7936 return to_fixed_array_type (type, dval, 1);
7937 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
7938 if (dval == NULL)
7939 return type;
7940 else
7941 return to_fixed_variant_branch_type (type, valaddr, address, dval);
7942 }
7943 }
7944
7945 /* The same as ada_to_fixed_type_1, except that it preserves the type
7946 if it is a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF of a type that is already fixed.
7947
7948 The typedef layer needs be preserved in order to differentiate between
7949 arrays and array pointers when both types are implemented using the same
7950 fat pointer. In the array pointer case, the pointer is encoded as
7951 a typedef of the pointer type. For instance, considering:
7952
7953 type String_Access is access String;
7954 S1 : String_Access := null;
7955
7956 To the debugger, S1 is defined as a typedef of type String. But
7957 to the user, it is a pointer. So if the user tries to print S1,
7958 we should not dereference the array, but print the array address
7959 instead.
7960
7961 If we didn't preserve the typedef layer, we would lose the fact that
7962 the type is to be presented as a pointer (needs de-reference before
7963 being printed). And we would also use the source-level type name. */
7964
7965 struct type *
7966 ada_to_fixed_type (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7967 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval, int check_tag)
7968
7969 {
7970 struct type *fixed_type =
7971 ada_to_fixed_type_1 (type, valaddr, address, dval, check_tag);
7972
7973 /* If TYPE is a typedef and its target type is the same as the FIXED_TYPE,
7974 then preserve the typedef layer.
7975
7976 Implementation note: We can only check the main-type portion of
7977 the TYPE and FIXED_TYPE, because eliminating the typedef layer
7978 from TYPE now returns a type that has the same instance flags
7979 as TYPE. For instance, if TYPE is a "typedef const", and its
7980 target type is a "struct", then the typedef elimination will return
7981 a "const" version of the target type. See check_typedef for more
7982 details about how the typedef layer elimination is done.
7983
7984 brobecker/2010-11-19: It seems to me that the only case where it is
7985 useful to preserve the typedef layer is when dealing with fat pointers.
7986 Perhaps, we could add a check for that and preserve the typedef layer
7987 only in that situation. But this seems unecessary so far, probably
7988 because we call check_typedef/ada_check_typedef pretty much everywhere.
7989 */
7990 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
7991 && (TYPE_MAIN_TYPE (ada_typedef_target_type (type))
7992 == TYPE_MAIN_TYPE (fixed_type)))
7993 return type;
7994
7995 return fixed_type;
7996 }
7997
7998 /* A standard (static-sized) type corresponding as well as possible to
7999 TYPE0, but based on no runtime data. */
8000
8001 static struct type *
8002 to_static_fixed_type (struct type *type0)
8003 {
8004 struct type *type;
8005
8006 if (type0 == NULL)
8007 return NULL;
8008
8009 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
8010 return type0;
8011
8012 type0 = ada_check_typedef (type0);
8013
8014 switch (TYPE_CODE (type0))
8015 {
8016 default:
8017 return type0;
8018 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
8019 type = dynamic_template_type (type0);
8020 if (type != NULL)
8021 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type);
8022 else
8023 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type0);
8024 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
8025 type = ada_find_parallel_type (type0, "___XVU");
8026 if (type != NULL)
8027 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type);
8028 else
8029 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type0);
8030 }
8031 }
8032
8033 /* A static approximation of TYPE with all type wrappers removed. */
8034
8035 static struct type *
8036 static_unwrap_type (struct type *type)
8037 {
8038 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
8039 {
8040 struct type *type1 = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (ada_check_typedef (type), 0);
8041 if (ada_type_name (type1) == NULL)
8042 TYPE_NAME (type1) = ada_type_name (type);
8043
8044 return static_unwrap_type (type1);
8045 }
8046 else
8047 {
8048 struct type *raw_real_type = ada_get_base_type (type);
8049
8050 if (raw_real_type == type)
8051 return type;
8052 else
8053 return to_static_fixed_type (raw_real_type);
8054 }
8055 }
8056
8057 /* In some cases, incomplete and private types require
8058 cross-references that are not resolved as records (for example,
8059 type Foo;
8060 type FooP is access Foo;
8061 V: FooP;
8062 type Foo is array ...;
8063 ). In these cases, since there is no mechanism for producing
8064 cross-references to such types, we instead substitute for FooP a
8065 stub enumeration type that is nowhere resolved, and whose tag is
8066 the name of the actual type. Call these types "non-record stubs". */
8067
8068 /* A type equivalent to TYPE that is not a non-record stub, if one
8069 exists, otherwise TYPE. */
8070
8071 struct type *
8072 ada_check_typedef (struct type *type)
8073 {
8074 if (type == NULL)
8075 return NULL;
8076
8077 /* If our type is a typedef type of a fat pointer, then we're done.
8078 We don't want to strip the TYPE_CODE_TYPDEF layer, because this is
8079 what allows us to distinguish between fat pointers that represent
8080 array types, and fat pointers that represent array access types
8081 (in both cases, the compiler implements them as fat pointers). */
8082 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
8083 && is_thick_pntr (ada_typedef_target_type (type)))
8084 return type;
8085
8086 CHECK_TYPEDEF (type);
8087 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
8088 || !TYPE_STUB (type)
8089 || TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) == NULL)
8090 return type;
8091 else
8092 {
8093 char *name = TYPE_TAG_NAME (type);
8094 struct type *type1 = ada_find_any_type (name);
8095
8096 if (type1 == NULL)
8097 return type;
8098
8099 /* TYPE1 might itself be a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF (this can happen with
8100 stubs pointing to arrays, as we don't create symbols for array
8101 types, only for the typedef-to-array types). If that's the case,
8102 strip the typedef layer. */
8103 if (TYPE_CODE (type1) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
8104 type1 = ada_check_typedef (type1);
8105
8106 return type1;
8107 }
8108 }
8109
8110 /* A value representing the data at VALADDR/ADDRESS as described by
8111 type TYPE0, but with a standard (static-sized) type that correctly
8112 describes it. If VAL0 is not NULL and TYPE0 already is a standard
8113 type, then return VAL0 [this feature is simply to avoid redundant
8114 creation of struct values]. */
8115
8116 static struct value *
8117 ada_to_fixed_value_create (struct type *type0, CORE_ADDR address,
8118 struct value *val0)
8119 {
8120 struct type *type = ada_to_fixed_type (type0, 0, address, NULL, 1);
8121
8122 if (type == type0 && val0 != NULL)
8123 return val0;
8124 else
8125 return value_from_contents_and_address (type, 0, address);
8126 }
8127
8128 /* A value representing VAL, but with a standard (static-sized) type
8129 that correctly describes it. Does not necessarily create a new
8130 value. */
8131
8132 struct value *
8133 ada_to_fixed_value (struct value *val)
8134 {
8135 return ada_to_fixed_value_create (value_type (val),
8136 value_address (val),
8137 val);
8138 }
8139 \f
8140
8141 /* Attributes */
8142
8143 /* Table mapping attribute numbers to names.
8144 NOTE: Keep up to date with enum ada_attribute definition in ada-lang.h. */
8145
8146 static const char *attribute_names[] = {
8147 "<?>",
8148
8149 "first",
8150 "last",
8151 "length",
8152 "image",
8153 "max",
8154 "min",
8155 "modulus",
8156 "pos",
8157 "size",
8158 "tag",
8159 "val",
8160 0
8161 };
8162
8163 const char *
8164 ada_attribute_name (enum exp_opcode n)
8165 {
8166 if (n >= OP_ATR_FIRST && n <= (int) OP_ATR_VAL)
8167 return attribute_names[n - OP_ATR_FIRST + 1];
8168 else
8169 return attribute_names[0];
8170 }
8171
8172 /* Evaluate the 'POS attribute applied to ARG. */
8173
8174 static LONGEST
8175 pos_atr (struct value *arg)
8176 {
8177 struct value *val = coerce_ref (arg);
8178 struct type *type = value_type (val);
8179
8180 if (!discrete_type_p (type))
8181 error (_("'POS only defined on discrete types"));
8182
8183 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
8184 {
8185 int i;
8186 LONGEST v = value_as_long (val);
8187
8188 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
8189 {
8190 if (v == TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i))
8191 return i;
8192 }
8193 error (_("enumeration value is invalid: can't find 'POS"));
8194 }
8195 else
8196 return value_as_long (val);
8197 }
8198
8199 static struct value *
8200 value_pos_atr (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
8201 {
8202 return value_from_longest (type, pos_atr (arg));
8203 }
8204
8205 /* Evaluate the TYPE'VAL attribute applied to ARG. */
8206
8207 static struct value *
8208 value_val_atr (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
8209 {
8210 if (!discrete_type_p (type))
8211 error (_("'VAL only defined on discrete types"));
8212 if (!integer_type_p (value_type (arg)))
8213 error (_("'VAL requires integral argument"));
8214
8215 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
8216 {
8217 long pos = value_as_long (arg);
8218
8219 if (pos < 0 || pos >= TYPE_NFIELDS (type))
8220 error (_("argument to 'VAL out of range"));
8221 return value_from_longest (type, TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, pos));
8222 }
8223 else
8224 return value_from_longest (type, value_as_long (arg));
8225 }
8226 \f
8227
8228 /* Evaluation */
8229
8230 /* True if TYPE appears to be an Ada character type.
8231 [At the moment, this is true only for Character and Wide_Character;
8232 It is a heuristic test that could stand improvement]. */
8233
8234 int
8235 ada_is_character_type (struct type *type)
8236 {
8237 const char *name;
8238
8239 /* If the type code says it's a character, then assume it really is,
8240 and don't check any further. */
8241 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_CHAR)
8242 return 1;
8243
8244 /* Otherwise, assume it's a character type iff it is a discrete type
8245 with a known character type name. */
8246 name = ada_type_name (type);
8247 return (name != NULL
8248 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT
8249 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
8250 && (strcmp (name, "character") == 0
8251 || strcmp (name, "wide_character") == 0
8252 || strcmp (name, "wide_wide_character") == 0
8253 || strcmp (name, "unsigned char") == 0));
8254 }
8255
8256 /* True if TYPE appears to be an Ada string type. */
8257
8258 int
8259 ada_is_string_type (struct type *type)
8260 {
8261 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
8262 if (type != NULL
8263 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR
8264 && (ada_is_simple_array_type (type)
8265 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
8266 && ada_array_arity (type) == 1)
8267 {
8268 struct type *elttype = ada_array_element_type (type, 1);
8269
8270 return ada_is_character_type (elttype);
8271 }
8272 else
8273 return 0;
8274 }
8275
8276 /* The compiler sometimes provides a parallel XVS type for a given
8277 PAD type. Normally, it is safe to follow the PAD type directly,
8278 but older versions of the compiler have a bug that causes the offset
8279 of its "F" field to be wrong. Following that field in that case
8280 would lead to incorrect results, but this can be worked around
8281 by ignoring the PAD type and using the associated XVS type instead.
8282
8283 Set to True if the debugger should trust the contents of PAD types.
8284 Otherwise, ignore the PAD type if there is a parallel XVS type. */
8285 static int trust_pad_over_xvs = 1;
8286
8287 /* True if TYPE is a struct type introduced by the compiler to force the
8288 alignment of a value. Such types have a single field with a
8289 distinctive name. */
8290
8291 int
8292 ada_is_aligner_type (struct type *type)
8293 {
8294 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
8295
8296 if (!trust_pad_over_xvs && ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVS") != NULL)
8297 return 0;
8298
8299 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
8300 && TYPE_NFIELDS (type) == 1
8301 && strcmp (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, 0), "F") == 0);
8302 }
8303
8304 /* If there is an ___XVS-convention type parallel to SUBTYPE, return
8305 the parallel type. */
8306
8307 struct type *
8308 ada_get_base_type (struct type *raw_type)
8309 {
8310 struct type *real_type_namer;
8311 struct type *raw_real_type;
8312
8313 if (raw_type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (raw_type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
8314 return raw_type;
8315
8316 if (ada_is_aligner_type (raw_type))
8317 /* The encoding specifies that we should always use the aligner type.
8318 So, even if this aligner type has an associated XVS type, we should
8319 simply ignore it.
8320
8321 According to the compiler gurus, an XVS type parallel to an aligner
8322 type may exist because of a stabs limitation. In stabs, aligner
8323 types are empty because the field has a variable-sized type, and
8324 thus cannot actually be used as an aligner type. As a result,
8325 we need the associated parallel XVS type to decode the type.
8326 Since the policy in the compiler is to not change the internal
8327 representation based on the debugging info format, we sometimes
8328 end up having a redundant XVS type parallel to the aligner type. */
8329 return raw_type;
8330
8331 real_type_namer = ada_find_parallel_type (raw_type, "___XVS");
8332 if (real_type_namer == NULL
8333 || TYPE_CODE (real_type_namer) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
8334 || TYPE_NFIELDS (real_type_namer) != 1)
8335 return raw_type;
8336
8337 if (TYPE_CODE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (real_type_namer, 0)) != TYPE_CODE_REF)
8338 {
8339 /* This is an older encoding form where the base type needs to be
8340 looked up by name. We prefer the newer enconding because it is
8341 more efficient. */
8342 raw_real_type = ada_find_any_type (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (real_type_namer, 0));
8343 if (raw_real_type == NULL)
8344 return raw_type;
8345 else
8346 return raw_real_type;
8347 }
8348
8349 /* The field in our XVS type is a reference to the base type. */
8350 return TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (real_type_namer, 0));
8351 }
8352
8353 /* The type of value designated by TYPE, with all aligners removed. */
8354
8355 struct type *
8356 ada_aligned_type (struct type *type)
8357 {
8358 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
8359 return ada_aligned_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0));
8360 else
8361 return ada_get_base_type (type);
8362 }
8363
8364
8365 /* The address of the aligned value in an object at address VALADDR
8366 having type TYPE. Assumes ada_is_aligner_type (TYPE). */
8367
8368 const gdb_byte *
8369 ada_aligned_value_addr (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr)
8370 {
8371 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
8372 return ada_aligned_value_addr (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0),
8373 valaddr +
8374 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type,
8375 0) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
8376 else
8377 return valaddr;
8378 }
8379
8380
8381
8382 /* The printed representation of an enumeration literal with encoded
8383 name NAME. The value is good to the next call of ada_enum_name. */
8384 const char *
8385 ada_enum_name (const char *name)
8386 {
8387 static char *result;
8388 static size_t result_len = 0;
8389 char *tmp;
8390
8391 /* First, unqualify the enumeration name:
8392 1. Search for the last '.' character. If we find one, then skip
8393 all the preceding characters, the unqualified name starts
8394 right after that dot.
8395 2. Otherwise, we may be debugging on a target where the compiler
8396 translates dots into "__". Search forward for double underscores,
8397 but stop searching when we hit an overloading suffix, which is
8398 of the form "__" followed by digits. */
8399
8400 tmp = strrchr (name, '.');
8401 if (tmp != NULL)
8402 name = tmp + 1;
8403 else
8404 {
8405 while ((tmp = strstr (name, "__")) != NULL)
8406 {
8407 if (isdigit (tmp[2]))
8408 break;
8409 else
8410 name = tmp + 2;
8411 }
8412 }
8413
8414 if (name[0] == 'Q')
8415 {
8416 int v;
8417
8418 if (name[1] == 'U' || name[1] == 'W')
8419 {
8420 if (sscanf (name + 2, "%x", &v) != 1)
8421 return name;
8422 }
8423 else
8424 return name;
8425
8426 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, 16);
8427 if (isascii (v) && isprint (v))
8428 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "'%c'", v);
8429 else if (name[1] == 'U')
8430 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "[\"%02x\"]", v);
8431 else
8432 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "[\"%04x\"]", v);
8433
8434 return result;
8435 }
8436 else
8437 {
8438 tmp = strstr (name, "__");
8439 if (tmp == NULL)
8440 tmp = strstr (name, "$");
8441 if (tmp != NULL)
8442 {
8443 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, tmp - name + 1);
8444 strncpy (result, name, tmp - name);
8445 result[tmp - name] = '\0';
8446 return result;
8447 }
8448
8449 return name;
8450 }
8451 }
8452
8453 /* Evaluate the subexpression of EXP starting at *POS as for
8454 evaluate_type, updating *POS to point just past the evaluated
8455 expression. */
8456
8457 static struct value *
8458 evaluate_subexp_type (struct expression *exp, int *pos)
8459 {
8460 return evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS);
8461 }
8462
8463 /* If VAL is wrapped in an aligner or subtype wrapper, return the
8464 value it wraps. */
8465
8466 static struct value *
8467 unwrap_value (struct value *val)
8468 {
8469 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (val));
8470
8471 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
8472 {
8473 struct value *v = ada_value_struct_elt (val, "F", 0);
8474 struct type *val_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (v));
8475
8476 if (ada_type_name (val_type) == NULL)
8477 TYPE_NAME (val_type) = ada_type_name (type);
8478
8479 return unwrap_value (v);
8480 }
8481 else
8482 {
8483 struct type *raw_real_type =
8484 ada_check_typedef (ada_get_base_type (type));
8485
8486 /* If there is no parallel XVS or XVE type, then the value is
8487 already unwrapped. Return it without further modification. */
8488 if ((type == raw_real_type)
8489 && ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVE") == NULL)
8490 return val;
8491
8492 return
8493 coerce_unspec_val_to_type
8494 (val, ada_to_fixed_type (raw_real_type, 0,
8495 value_address (val),
8496 NULL, 1));
8497 }
8498 }
8499
8500 static struct value *
8501 cast_to_fixed (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
8502 {
8503 LONGEST val;
8504
8505 if (type == value_type (arg))
8506 return arg;
8507 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg)))
8508 val = ada_float_to_fixed (type,
8509 ada_fixed_to_float (value_type (arg),
8510 value_as_long (arg)));
8511 else
8512 {
8513 DOUBLEST argd = value_as_double (arg);
8514
8515 val = ada_float_to_fixed (type, argd);
8516 }
8517
8518 return value_from_longest (type, val);
8519 }
8520
8521 static struct value *
8522 cast_from_fixed (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
8523 {
8524 DOUBLEST val = ada_fixed_to_float (value_type (arg),
8525 value_as_long (arg));
8526
8527 return value_from_double (type, val);
8528 }
8529
8530 /* Coerce VAL as necessary for assignment to an lval of type TYPE, and
8531 return the converted value. */
8532
8533 static struct value *
8534 coerce_for_assign (struct type *type, struct value *val)
8535 {
8536 struct type *type2 = value_type (val);
8537
8538 if (type == type2)
8539 return val;
8540
8541 type2 = ada_check_typedef (type2);
8542 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
8543
8544 if (TYPE_CODE (type2) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
8545 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
8546 {
8547 val = ada_value_ind (val);
8548 type2 = value_type (val);
8549 }
8550
8551 if (TYPE_CODE (type2) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
8552 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
8553 {
8554 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type2) != TYPE_LENGTH (type)
8555 || TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2))
8556 != TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2)))
8557 error (_("Incompatible types in assignment"));
8558 deprecated_set_value_type (val, type);
8559 }
8560 return val;
8561 }
8562
8563 static struct value *
8564 ada_value_binop (struct value *arg1, struct value *arg2, enum exp_opcode op)
8565 {
8566 struct value *val;
8567 struct type *type1, *type2;
8568 LONGEST v, v1, v2;
8569
8570 arg1 = coerce_ref (arg1);
8571 arg2 = coerce_ref (arg2);
8572 type1 = get_base_type (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1)));
8573 type2 = get_base_type (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2)));
8574
8575 if (TYPE_CODE (type1) != TYPE_CODE_INT
8576 || TYPE_CODE (type2) != TYPE_CODE_INT)
8577 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
8578
8579 switch (op)
8580 {
8581 case BINOP_MOD:
8582 case BINOP_DIV:
8583 case BINOP_REM:
8584 break;
8585 default:
8586 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
8587 }
8588
8589 v2 = value_as_long (arg2);
8590 if (v2 == 0)
8591 error (_("second operand of %s must not be zero."), op_string (op));
8592
8593 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type1) || op == BINOP_MOD)
8594 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
8595
8596 v1 = value_as_long (arg1);
8597 switch (op)
8598 {
8599 case BINOP_DIV:
8600 v = v1 / v2;
8601 if (!TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO && v1 * (v1 % v2) < 0)
8602 v += v > 0 ? -1 : 1;
8603 break;
8604 case BINOP_REM:
8605 v = v1 % v2;
8606 if (v * v1 < 0)
8607 v -= v2;
8608 break;
8609 default:
8610 /* Should not reach this point. */
8611 v = 0;
8612 }
8613
8614 val = allocate_value (type1);
8615 store_unsigned_integer (value_contents_raw (val),
8616 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (val)),
8617 gdbarch_byte_order (get_type_arch (type1)), v);
8618 return val;
8619 }
8620
8621 static int
8622 ada_value_equal (struct value *arg1, struct value *arg2)
8623 {
8624 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (arg1))
8625 || ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (arg2)))
8626 {
8627 /* Automatically dereference any array reference before
8628 we attempt to perform the comparison. */
8629 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
8630 arg2 = ada_coerce_ref (arg2);
8631
8632 arg1 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
8633 arg2 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg2);
8634 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
8635 || TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg2)) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
8636 error (_("Attempt to compare array with non-array"));
8637 /* FIXME: The following works only for types whose
8638 representations use all bits (no padding or undefined bits)
8639 and do not have user-defined equality. */
8640 return
8641 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg2))
8642 && memcmp (value_contents (arg1), value_contents (arg2),
8643 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg1))) == 0;
8644 }
8645 return value_equal (arg1, arg2);
8646 }
8647
8648 /* Total number of component associations in the aggregate starting at
8649 index PC in EXP. Assumes that index PC is the start of an
8650 OP_AGGREGATE. */
8651
8652 static int
8653 num_component_specs (struct expression *exp, int pc)
8654 {
8655 int n, m, i;
8656
8657 m = exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst;
8658 pc += 3;
8659 n = 0;
8660 for (i = 0; i < m; i += 1)
8661 {
8662 switch (exp->elts[pc].opcode)
8663 {
8664 default:
8665 n += 1;
8666 break;
8667 case OP_CHOICES:
8668 n += exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst;
8669 break;
8670 }
8671 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &pc, EVAL_SKIP);
8672 }
8673 return n;
8674 }
8675
8676 /* Assign the result of evaluating EXP starting at *POS to the INDEXth
8677 component of LHS (a simple array or a record), updating *POS past
8678 the expression, assuming that LHS is contained in CONTAINER. Does
8679 not modify the inferior's memory, nor does it modify LHS (unless
8680 LHS == CONTAINER). */
8681
8682 static void
8683 assign_component (struct value *container, struct value *lhs, LONGEST index,
8684 struct expression *exp, int *pos)
8685 {
8686 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
8687 struct value *elt;
8688
8689 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (lhs)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
8690 {
8691 struct type *index_type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
8692 struct value *index_val = value_from_longest (index_type, index);
8693
8694 elt = unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript (lhs, 1, &index_val));
8695 }
8696 else
8697 {
8698 elt = ada_index_struct_field (index, lhs, 0, value_type (lhs));
8699 elt = ada_to_fixed_value (unwrap_value (elt));
8700 }
8701
8702 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_AGGREGATE)
8703 assign_aggregate (container, elt, exp, pos, EVAL_NORMAL);
8704 else
8705 value_assign_to_component (container, elt,
8706 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
8707 EVAL_NORMAL));
8708
8709 value_free_to_mark (mark);
8710 }
8711
8712 /* Assuming that LHS represents an lvalue having a record or array
8713 type, and EXP->ELTS[*POS] is an OP_AGGREGATE, evaluate an assignment
8714 of that aggregate's value to LHS, advancing *POS past the
8715 aggregate. NOSIDE is as for evaluate_subexp. CONTAINER is an
8716 lvalue containing LHS (possibly LHS itself). Does not modify
8717 the inferior's memory, nor does it modify the contents of
8718 LHS (unless == CONTAINER). Returns the modified CONTAINER. */
8719
8720 static struct value *
8721 assign_aggregate (struct value *container,
8722 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
8723 int *pos, enum noside noside)
8724 {
8725 struct type *lhs_type;
8726 int n = exp->elts[*pos+1].longconst;
8727 LONGEST low_index, high_index;
8728 int num_specs;
8729 LONGEST *indices;
8730 int max_indices, num_indices;
8731 int is_array_aggregate;
8732 int i;
8733
8734 *pos += 3;
8735 if (noside != EVAL_NORMAL)
8736 {
8737 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
8738 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, noside);
8739 return container;
8740 }
8741
8742 container = ada_coerce_ref (container);
8743 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (container)))
8744 container = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (container);
8745 lhs = ada_coerce_ref (lhs);
8746 if (!deprecated_value_modifiable (lhs))
8747 error (_("Left operand of assignment is not a modifiable lvalue."));
8748
8749 lhs_type = value_type (lhs);
8750 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (lhs_type))
8751 {
8752 lhs = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (lhs);
8753 lhs_type = value_type (lhs);
8754 low_index = TYPE_ARRAY_LOWER_BOUND_VALUE (lhs_type);
8755 high_index = TYPE_ARRAY_UPPER_BOUND_VALUE (lhs_type);
8756 is_array_aggregate = 1;
8757 }
8758 else if (TYPE_CODE (lhs_type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
8759 {
8760 low_index = 0;
8761 high_index = num_visible_fields (lhs_type) - 1;
8762 is_array_aggregate = 0;
8763 }
8764 else
8765 error (_("Left-hand side must be array or record."));
8766
8767 num_specs = num_component_specs (exp, *pos - 3);
8768 max_indices = 4 * num_specs + 4;
8769 indices = alloca (max_indices * sizeof (indices[0]));
8770 indices[0] = indices[1] = low_index - 1;
8771 indices[2] = indices[3] = high_index + 1;
8772 num_indices = 4;
8773
8774 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
8775 {
8776 switch (exp->elts[*pos].opcode)
8777 {
8778 case OP_CHOICES:
8779 aggregate_assign_from_choices (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
8780 &num_indices, max_indices,
8781 low_index, high_index);
8782 break;
8783 case OP_POSITIONAL:
8784 aggregate_assign_positional (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
8785 &num_indices, max_indices,
8786 low_index, high_index);
8787 break;
8788 case OP_OTHERS:
8789 if (i != n-1)
8790 error (_("Misplaced 'others' clause"));
8791 aggregate_assign_others (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
8792 num_indices, low_index, high_index);
8793 break;
8794 default:
8795 error (_("Internal error: bad aggregate clause"));
8796 }
8797 }
8798
8799 return container;
8800 }
8801
8802 /* Assign into the component of LHS indexed by the OP_POSITIONAL
8803 construct at *POS, updating *POS past the construct, given that
8804 the positions are relative to lower bound LOW, where HIGH is the
8805 upper bound. Record the position in INDICES[0 .. MAX_INDICES-1]
8806 updating *NUM_INDICES as needed. CONTAINER is as for
8807 assign_aggregate. */
8808 static void
8809 aggregate_assign_positional (struct value *container,
8810 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
8811 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int *num_indices,
8812 int max_indices, LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
8813 {
8814 LONGEST ind = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos + 1].longconst) + low;
8815
8816 if (ind - 1 == high)
8817 warning (_("Extra components in aggregate ignored."));
8818 if (ind <= high)
8819 {
8820 add_component_interval (ind, ind, indices, num_indices, max_indices);
8821 *pos += 3;
8822 assign_component (container, lhs, ind, exp, pos);
8823 }
8824 else
8825 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8826 }
8827
8828 /* Assign into the components of LHS indexed by the OP_CHOICES
8829 construct at *POS, updating *POS past the construct, given that
8830 the allowable indices are LOW..HIGH. Record the indices assigned
8831 to in INDICES[0 .. MAX_INDICES-1], updating *NUM_INDICES as
8832 needed. CONTAINER is as for assign_aggregate. */
8833 static void
8834 aggregate_assign_from_choices (struct value *container,
8835 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
8836 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int *num_indices,
8837 int max_indices, LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
8838 {
8839 int j;
8840 int n_choices = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos+1].longconst);
8841 int choice_pos, expr_pc;
8842 int is_array = ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (lhs));
8843
8844 choice_pos = *pos += 3;
8845
8846 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
8847 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8848 expr_pc = *pos;
8849 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8850
8851 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
8852 {
8853 LONGEST lower, upper;
8854 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[choice_pos].opcode;
8855
8856 if (op == OP_DISCRETE_RANGE)
8857 {
8858 choice_pos += 1;
8859 lower = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
8860 EVAL_NORMAL));
8861 upper = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
8862 EVAL_NORMAL));
8863 }
8864 else if (is_array)
8865 {
8866 lower = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &choice_pos,
8867 EVAL_NORMAL));
8868 upper = lower;
8869 }
8870 else
8871 {
8872 int ind;
8873 char *name;
8874
8875 switch (op)
8876 {
8877 case OP_NAME:
8878 name = &exp->elts[choice_pos + 2].string;
8879 break;
8880 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
8881 name = SYMBOL_NATURAL_NAME (exp->elts[choice_pos + 2].symbol);
8882 break;
8883 default:
8884 error (_("Invalid record component association."));
8885 }
8886 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &choice_pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8887 ind = 0;
8888 if (! find_struct_field (name, value_type (lhs), 0,
8889 NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, &ind))
8890 error (_("Unknown component name: %s."), name);
8891 lower = upper = ind;
8892 }
8893
8894 if (lower <= upper && (lower < low || upper > high))
8895 error (_("Index in component association out of bounds."));
8896
8897 add_component_interval (lower, upper, indices, num_indices,
8898 max_indices);
8899 while (lower <= upper)
8900 {
8901 int pos1;
8902
8903 pos1 = expr_pc;
8904 assign_component (container, lhs, lower, exp, &pos1);
8905 lower += 1;
8906 }
8907 }
8908 }
8909
8910 /* Assign the value of the expression in the OP_OTHERS construct in
8911 EXP at *POS into the components of LHS indexed from LOW .. HIGH that
8912 have not been previously assigned. The index intervals already assigned
8913 are in INDICES[0 .. NUM_INDICES-1]. Updates *POS to after the
8914 OP_OTHERS clause. CONTAINER is as for assign_aggregate. */
8915 static void
8916 aggregate_assign_others (struct value *container,
8917 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
8918 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int num_indices,
8919 LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
8920 {
8921 int i;
8922 int expr_pc = *pos + 1;
8923
8924 for (i = 0; i < num_indices - 2; i += 2)
8925 {
8926 LONGEST ind;
8927
8928 for (ind = indices[i + 1] + 1; ind < indices[i + 2]; ind += 1)
8929 {
8930 int localpos;
8931
8932 localpos = expr_pc;
8933 assign_component (container, lhs, ind, exp, &localpos);
8934 }
8935 }
8936 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8937 }
8938
8939 /* Add the interval [LOW .. HIGH] to the sorted set of intervals
8940 [ INDICES[0] .. INDICES[1] ],..., [ INDICES[*SIZE-2] .. INDICES[*SIZE-1] ],
8941 modifying *SIZE as needed. It is an error if *SIZE exceeds
8942 MAX_SIZE. The resulting intervals do not overlap. */
8943 static void
8944 add_component_interval (LONGEST low, LONGEST high,
8945 LONGEST* indices, int *size, int max_size)
8946 {
8947 int i, j;
8948
8949 for (i = 0; i < *size; i += 2) {
8950 if (high >= indices[i] && low <= indices[i + 1])
8951 {
8952 int kh;
8953
8954 for (kh = i + 2; kh < *size; kh += 2)
8955 if (high < indices[kh])
8956 break;
8957 if (low < indices[i])
8958 indices[i] = low;
8959 indices[i + 1] = indices[kh - 1];
8960 if (high > indices[i + 1])
8961 indices[i + 1] = high;
8962 memcpy (indices + i + 2, indices + kh, *size - kh);
8963 *size -= kh - i - 2;
8964 return;
8965 }
8966 else if (high < indices[i])
8967 break;
8968 }
8969
8970 if (*size == max_size)
8971 error (_("Internal error: miscounted aggregate components."));
8972 *size += 2;
8973 for (j = *size-1; j >= i+2; j -= 1)
8974 indices[j] = indices[j - 2];
8975 indices[i] = low;
8976 indices[i + 1] = high;
8977 }
8978
8979 /* Perform and Ada cast of ARG2 to type TYPE if the type of ARG2
8980 is different. */
8981
8982 static struct value *
8983 ada_value_cast (struct type *type, struct value *arg2, enum noside noside)
8984 {
8985 if (type == ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2)))
8986 return arg2;
8987
8988 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (type))
8989 return (cast_to_fixed (type, arg2));
8990
8991 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
8992 return cast_from_fixed (type, arg2);
8993
8994 return value_cast (type, arg2);
8995 }
8996
8997 /* Evaluating Ada expressions, and printing their result.
8998 ------------------------------------------------------
8999
9000 1. Introduction:
9001 ----------------
9002
9003 We usually evaluate an Ada expression in order to print its value.
9004 We also evaluate an expression in order to print its type, which
9005 happens during the EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS phase of the evaluation,
9006 but we'll focus mostly on the EVAL_NORMAL phase. In practice, the
9007 EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS phase allows us to simplify certain aspects of
9008 the evaluation compared to the EVAL_NORMAL, but is otherwise very
9009 similar.
9010
9011 Evaluating expressions is a little more complicated for Ada entities
9012 than it is for entities in languages such as C. The main reason for
9013 this is that Ada provides types whose definition might be dynamic.
9014 One example of such types is variant records. Or another example
9015 would be an array whose bounds can only be known at run time.
9016
9017 The following description is a general guide as to what should be
9018 done (and what should NOT be done) in order to evaluate an expression
9019 involving such types, and when. This does not cover how the semantic
9020 information is encoded by GNAT as this is covered separatly. For the
9021 document used as the reference for the GNAT encoding, see exp_dbug.ads
9022 in the GNAT sources.
9023
9024 Ideally, we should embed each part of this description next to its
9025 associated code. Unfortunately, the amount of code is so vast right
9026 now that it's hard to see whether the code handling a particular
9027 situation might be duplicated or not. One day, when the code is
9028 cleaned up, this guide might become redundant with the comments
9029 inserted in the code, and we might want to remove it.
9030
9031 2. ``Fixing'' an Entity, the Simple Case:
9032 -----------------------------------------
9033
9034 When evaluating Ada expressions, the tricky issue is that they may
9035 reference entities whose type contents and size are not statically
9036 known. Consider for instance a variant record:
9037
9038 type Rec (Empty : Boolean := True) is record
9039 case Empty is
9040 when True => null;
9041 when False => Value : Integer;
9042 end case;
9043 end record;
9044 Yes : Rec := (Empty => False, Value => 1);
9045 No : Rec := (empty => True);
9046
9047 The size and contents of that record depends on the value of the
9048 descriminant (Rec.Empty). At this point, neither the debugging
9049 information nor the associated type structure in GDB are able to
9050 express such dynamic types. So what the debugger does is to create
9051 "fixed" versions of the type that applies to the specific object.
9052 We also informally refer to this opperation as "fixing" an object,
9053 which means creating its associated fixed type.
9054
9055 Example: when printing the value of variable "Yes" above, its fixed
9056 type would look like this:
9057
9058 type Rec is record
9059 Empty : Boolean;
9060 Value : Integer;
9061 end record;
9062
9063 On the other hand, if we printed the value of "No", its fixed type
9064 would become:
9065
9066 type Rec is record
9067 Empty : Boolean;
9068 end record;
9069
9070 Things become a little more complicated when trying to fix an entity
9071 with a dynamic type that directly contains another dynamic type,
9072 such as an array of variant records, for instance. There are
9073 two possible cases: Arrays, and records.
9074
9075 3. ``Fixing'' Arrays:
9076 ---------------------
9077
9078 The type structure in GDB describes an array in terms of its bounds,
9079 and the type of its elements. By design, all elements in the array
9080 have the same type and we cannot represent an array of variant elements
9081 using the current type structure in GDB. When fixing an array,
9082 we cannot fix the array element, as we would potentially need one
9083 fixed type per element of the array. As a result, the best we can do
9084 when fixing an array is to produce an array whose bounds and size
9085 are correct (allowing us to read it from memory), but without having
9086 touched its element type. Fixing each element will be done later,
9087 when (if) necessary.
9088
9089 Arrays are a little simpler to handle than records, because the same
9090 amount of memory is allocated for each element of the array, even if
9091 the amount of space actually used by each element differs from element
9092 to element. Consider for instance the following array of type Rec:
9093
9094 type Rec_Array is array (1 .. 2) of Rec;
9095
9096 The actual amount of memory occupied by each element might be different
9097 from element to element, depending on the value of their discriminant.
9098 But the amount of space reserved for each element in the array remains
9099 fixed regardless. So we simply need to compute that size using
9100 the debugging information available, from which we can then determine
9101 the array size (we multiply the number of elements of the array by
9102 the size of each element).
9103
9104 The simplest case is when we have an array of a constrained element
9105 type. For instance, consider the following type declarations:
9106
9107 type Bounded_String (Max_Size : Integer) is
9108 Length : Integer;
9109 Buffer : String (1 .. Max_Size);
9110 end record;
9111 type Bounded_String_Array is array (1 ..2) of Bounded_String (80);
9112
9113 In this case, the compiler describes the array as an array of
9114 variable-size elements (identified by its XVS suffix) for which
9115 the size can be read in the parallel XVZ variable.
9116
9117 In the case of an array of an unconstrained element type, the compiler
9118 wraps the array element inside a private PAD type. This type should not
9119 be shown to the user, and must be "unwrap"'ed before printing. Note
9120 that we also use the adjective "aligner" in our code to designate
9121 these wrapper types.
9122
9123 In some cases, the size allocated for each element is statically
9124 known. In that case, the PAD type already has the correct size,
9125 and the array element should remain unfixed.
9126
9127 But there are cases when this size is not statically known.
9128 For instance, assuming that "Five" is an integer variable:
9129
9130 type Dynamic is array (1 .. Five) of Integer;
9131 type Wrapper (Has_Length : Boolean := False) is record
9132 Data : Dynamic;
9133 case Has_Length is
9134 when True => Length : Integer;
9135 when False => null;
9136 end case;
9137 end record;
9138 type Wrapper_Array is array (1 .. 2) of Wrapper;
9139
9140 Hello : Wrapper_Array := (others => (Has_Length => True,
9141 Data => (others => 17),
9142 Length => 1));
9143
9144
9145 The debugging info would describe variable Hello as being an
9146 array of a PAD type. The size of that PAD type is not statically
9147 known, but can be determined using a parallel XVZ variable.
9148 In that case, a copy of the PAD type with the correct size should
9149 be used for the fixed array.
9150
9151 3. ``Fixing'' record type objects:
9152 ----------------------------------
9153
9154 Things are slightly different from arrays in the case of dynamic
9155 record types. In this case, in order to compute the associated
9156 fixed type, we need to determine the size and offset of each of
9157 its components. This, in turn, requires us to compute the fixed
9158 type of each of these components.
9159
9160 Consider for instance the example:
9161
9162 type Bounded_String (Max_Size : Natural) is record
9163 Str : String (1 .. Max_Size);
9164 Length : Natural;
9165 end record;
9166 My_String : Bounded_String (Max_Size => 10);
9167
9168 In that case, the position of field "Length" depends on the size
9169 of field Str, which itself depends on the value of the Max_Size
9170 discriminant. In order to fix the type of variable My_String,
9171 we need to fix the type of field Str. Therefore, fixing a variant
9172 record requires us to fix each of its components.
9173
9174 However, if a component does not have a dynamic size, the component
9175 should not be fixed. In particular, fields that use a PAD type
9176 should not fixed. Here is an example where this might happen
9177 (assuming type Rec above):
9178
9179 type Container (Big : Boolean) is record
9180 First : Rec;
9181 After : Integer;
9182 case Big is
9183 when True => Another : Integer;
9184 when False => null;
9185 end case;
9186 end record;
9187 My_Container : Container := (Big => False,
9188 First => (Empty => True),
9189 After => 42);
9190
9191 In that example, the compiler creates a PAD type for component First,
9192 whose size is constant, and then positions the component After just
9193 right after it. The offset of component After is therefore constant
9194 in this case.
9195
9196 The debugger computes the position of each field based on an algorithm
9197 that uses, among other things, the actual position and size of the field
9198 preceding it. Let's now imagine that the user is trying to print
9199 the value of My_Container. If the type fixing was recursive, we would
9200 end up computing the offset of field After based on the size of the
9201 fixed version of field First. And since in our example First has
9202 only one actual field, the size of the fixed type is actually smaller
9203 than the amount of space allocated to that field, and thus we would
9204 compute the wrong offset of field After.
9205
9206 To make things more complicated, we need to watch out for dynamic
9207 components of variant records (identified by the ___XVL suffix in
9208 the component name). Even if the target type is a PAD type, the size
9209 of that type might not be statically known. So the PAD type needs
9210 to be unwrapped and the resulting type needs to be fixed. Otherwise,
9211 we might end up with the wrong size for our component. This can be
9212 observed with the following type declarations:
9213
9214 type Octal is new Integer range 0 .. 7;
9215 type Octal_Array is array (Positive range <>) of Octal;
9216 pragma Pack (Octal_Array);
9217
9218 type Octal_Buffer (Size : Positive) is record
9219 Buffer : Octal_Array (1 .. Size);
9220 Length : Integer;
9221 end record;
9222
9223 In that case, Buffer is a PAD type whose size is unset and needs
9224 to be computed by fixing the unwrapped type.
9225
9226 4. When to ``Fix'' un-``Fixed'' sub-elements of an entity:
9227 ----------------------------------------------------------
9228
9229 Lastly, when should the sub-elements of an entity that remained unfixed
9230 thus far, be actually fixed?
9231
9232 The answer is: Only when referencing that element. For instance
9233 when selecting one component of a record, this specific component
9234 should be fixed at that point in time. Or when printing the value
9235 of a record, each component should be fixed before its value gets
9236 printed. Similarly for arrays, the element of the array should be
9237 fixed when printing each element of the array, or when extracting
9238 one element out of that array. On the other hand, fixing should
9239 not be performed on the elements when taking a slice of an array!
9240
9241 Note that one of the side-effects of miscomputing the offset and
9242 size of each field is that we end up also miscomputing the size
9243 of the containing type. This can have adverse results when computing
9244 the value of an entity. GDB fetches the value of an entity based
9245 on the size of its type, and thus a wrong size causes GDB to fetch
9246 the wrong amount of memory. In the case where the computed size is
9247 too small, GDB fetches too little data to print the value of our
9248 entiry. Results in this case as unpredicatble, as we usually read
9249 past the buffer containing the data =:-o. */
9250
9251 /* Implement the evaluate_exp routine in the exp_descriptor structure
9252 for the Ada language. */
9253
9254 static struct value *
9255 ada_evaluate_subexp (struct type *expect_type, struct expression *exp,
9256 int *pos, enum noside noside)
9257 {
9258 enum exp_opcode op;
9259 int tem;
9260 int pc;
9261 struct value *arg1 = NULL, *arg2 = NULL, *arg3;
9262 struct type *type;
9263 int nargs, oplen;
9264 struct value **argvec;
9265
9266 pc = *pos;
9267 *pos += 1;
9268 op = exp->elts[pc].opcode;
9269
9270 switch (op)
9271 {
9272 default:
9273 *pos -= 1;
9274 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
9275 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
9276
9277 /* If evaluating an OP_DOUBLE and an EXPECT_TYPE was provided,
9278 then we need to perform the conversion manually, because
9279 evaluate_subexp_standard doesn't do it. This conversion is
9280 necessary in Ada because the different kinds of float/fixed
9281 types in Ada have different representations.
9282
9283 Similarly, we need to perform the conversion from OP_LONG
9284 ourselves. */
9285 if ((op == OP_DOUBLE || op == OP_LONG) && expect_type != NULL)
9286 arg1 = ada_value_cast (expect_type, arg1, noside);
9287
9288 return arg1;
9289
9290 case OP_STRING:
9291 {
9292 struct value *result;
9293
9294 *pos -= 1;
9295 result = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
9296 /* The result type will have code OP_STRING, bashed there from
9297 OP_ARRAY. Bash it back. */
9298 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (result)) == TYPE_CODE_STRING)
9299 TYPE_CODE (value_type (result)) = TYPE_CODE_ARRAY;
9300 return result;
9301 }
9302
9303 case UNOP_CAST:
9304 (*pos) += 2;
9305 type = exp->elts[pc + 1].type;
9306 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
9307 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9308 goto nosideret;
9309 arg1 = ada_value_cast (type, arg1, noside);
9310 return arg1;
9311
9312 case UNOP_QUAL:
9313 (*pos) += 2;
9314 type = exp->elts[pc + 1].type;
9315 return ada_evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
9316
9317 case BINOP_ASSIGN:
9318 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9319 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_AGGREGATE)
9320 {
9321 arg1 = assign_aggregate (arg1, arg1, exp, pos, noside);
9322 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9323 return arg1;
9324 return ada_value_assign (arg1, arg1);
9325 }
9326 /* Force the evaluation of the rhs ARG2 to the type of the lhs ARG1,
9327 except if the lhs of our assignment is a convenience variable.
9328 In the case of assigning to a convenience variable, the lhs
9329 should be exactly the result of the evaluation of the rhs. */
9330 type = value_type (arg1);
9331 if (VALUE_LVAL (arg1) == lval_internalvar)
9332 type = NULL;
9333 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
9334 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9335 return arg1;
9336 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
9337 arg2 = cast_to_fixed (value_type (arg1), arg2);
9338 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
9339 error
9340 (_("Fixed-point values must be assigned to fixed-point variables"));
9341 else
9342 arg2 = coerce_for_assign (value_type (arg1), arg2);
9343 return ada_value_assign (arg1, arg2);
9344
9345 case BINOP_ADD:
9346 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
9347 arg2 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
9348 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9349 goto nosideret;
9350 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
9351 return (value_from_longest
9352 (value_type (arg1),
9353 value_as_long (arg1) + value_as_long (arg2)));
9354 if ((ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1))
9355 || ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
9356 && value_type (arg1) != value_type (arg2))
9357 error (_("Operands of fixed-point addition must have the same type"));
9358 /* Do the addition, and cast the result to the type of the first
9359 argument. We cannot cast the result to a reference type, so if
9360 ARG1 is a reference type, find its underlying type. */
9361 type = value_type (arg1);
9362 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
9363 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
9364 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9365 return value_cast (type, value_binop (arg1, arg2, BINOP_ADD));
9366
9367 case BINOP_SUB:
9368 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
9369 arg2 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
9370 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9371 goto nosideret;
9372 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
9373 return (value_from_longest
9374 (value_type (arg1),
9375 value_as_long (arg1) - value_as_long (arg2)));
9376 if ((ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1))
9377 || ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
9378 && value_type (arg1) != value_type (arg2))
9379 error (_("Operands of fixed-point subtraction "
9380 "must have the same type"));
9381 /* Do the substraction, and cast the result to the type of the first
9382 argument. We cannot cast the result to a reference type, so if
9383 ARG1 is a reference type, find its underlying type. */
9384 type = value_type (arg1);
9385 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
9386 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
9387 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9388 return value_cast (type, value_binop (arg1, arg2, BINOP_SUB));
9389
9390 case BINOP_MUL:
9391 case BINOP_DIV:
9392 case BINOP_REM:
9393 case BINOP_MOD:
9394 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9395 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9396 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9397 goto nosideret;
9398 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9399 {
9400 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9401 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
9402 }
9403 else
9404 {
9405 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_double;
9406 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
9407 arg1 = cast_from_fixed (type, arg1);
9408 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
9409 arg2 = cast_from_fixed (type, arg2);
9410 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9411 return ada_value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
9412 }
9413
9414 case BINOP_EQUAL:
9415 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
9416 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9417 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (value_type (arg1), exp, pos, noside);
9418 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9419 goto nosideret;
9420 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9421 tem = 0;
9422 else
9423 {
9424 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9425 tem = ada_value_equal (arg1, arg2);
9426 }
9427 if (op == BINOP_NOTEQUAL)
9428 tem = !tem;
9429 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
9430 return value_from_longest (type, (LONGEST) tem);
9431
9432 case UNOP_NEG:
9433 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9434 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9435 goto nosideret;
9436 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
9437 return value_cast (value_type (arg1), value_neg (arg1));
9438 else
9439 {
9440 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
9441 return value_neg (arg1);
9442 }
9443
9444 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
9445 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
9446 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
9447 {
9448 struct value *val;
9449
9450 *pos -= 1;
9451 val = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
9452 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
9453 return value_cast (type, val);
9454 }
9455
9456 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
9457 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
9458 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
9459 {
9460 struct value *val;
9461
9462 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS);
9463 *pos = pc;
9464 val = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
9465
9466 return value_cast (value_type (arg1), val);
9467 }
9468
9469 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
9470 *pos -= 1;
9471
9472 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9473 {
9474 *pos += 4;
9475 goto nosideret;
9476 }
9477 else if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
9478 /* Only encountered when an unresolved symbol occurs in a
9479 context other than a function call, in which case, it is
9480 invalid. */
9481 error (_("Unexpected unresolved symbol, %s, during evaluation"),
9482 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
9483 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9484 {
9485 type = static_unwrap_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
9486 /* Check to see if this is a tagged type. We also need to handle
9487 the case where the type is a reference to a tagged type, but
9488 we have to be careful to exclude pointers to tagged types.
9489 The latter should be shown as usual (as a pointer), whereas
9490 a reference should mostly be transparent to the user. */
9491 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type, 0)
9492 || (TYPE_CODE(type) == TYPE_CODE_REF
9493 && ada_is_tagged_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), 0)))
9494 {
9495 /* Tagged types are a little special in the fact that the real
9496 type is dynamic and can only be determined by inspecting the
9497 object's tag. This means that we need to get the object's
9498 value first (EVAL_NORMAL) and then extract the actual object
9499 type from its tag.
9500
9501 Note that we cannot skip the final step where we extract
9502 the object type from its tag, because the EVAL_NORMAL phase
9503 results in dynamic components being resolved into fixed ones.
9504 This can cause problems when trying to print the type
9505 description of tagged types whose parent has a dynamic size:
9506 We use the type name of the "_parent" component in order
9507 to print the name of the ancestor type in the type description.
9508 If that component had a dynamic size, the resolution into
9509 a fixed type would result in the loss of that type name,
9510 thus preventing us from printing the name of the ancestor
9511 type in the type description. */
9512 struct type *actual_type;
9513
9514 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_NORMAL);
9515 actual_type = type_from_tag (ada_value_tag (arg1));
9516 if (actual_type == NULL)
9517 /* If, for some reason, we were unable to determine
9518 the actual type from the tag, then use the static
9519 approximation that we just computed as a fallback.
9520 This can happen if the debugging information is
9521 incomplete, for instance. */
9522 actual_type = type;
9523
9524 return value_zero (actual_type, not_lval);
9525 }
9526
9527 *pos += 4;
9528 return value_zero
9529 (to_static_fixed_type
9530 (static_unwrap_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol))),
9531 not_lval);
9532 }
9533 else
9534 {
9535 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
9536 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
9537 return ada_to_fixed_value (arg1);
9538 }
9539
9540 case OP_FUNCALL:
9541 (*pos) += 2;
9542
9543 /* Allocate arg vector, including space for the function to be
9544 called in argvec[0] and a terminating NULL. */
9545 nargs = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
9546 argvec =
9547 (struct value **) alloca (sizeof (struct value *) * (nargs + 2));
9548
9549 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
9550 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
9551 error (_("Unexpected unresolved symbol, %s, during evaluation"),
9552 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol));
9553 else
9554 {
9555 for (tem = 0; tem <= nargs; tem += 1)
9556 argvec[tem] = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9557 argvec[tem] = 0;
9558
9559 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9560 goto nosideret;
9561 }
9562
9563 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type
9564 (desc_base_type (value_type (argvec[0]))))
9565 argvec[0] = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (argvec[0]);
9566 else if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
9567 && TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (value_type (argvec[0]), 0) != 0)
9568 /* This is a packed array that has already been fixed, and
9569 therefore already coerced to a simple array. Nothing further
9570 to do. */
9571 ;
9572 else if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_REF
9573 || (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
9574 && VALUE_LVAL (argvec[0]) == lval_memory))
9575 argvec[0] = value_addr (argvec[0]);
9576
9577 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (argvec[0]));
9578
9579 /* Ada allows us to implicitly dereference arrays when subscripting
9580 them. So, if this is an array typedef (encoding use for array
9581 access types encoded as fat pointers), strip it now. */
9582 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
9583 type = ada_typedef_target_type (type);
9584
9585 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
9586 {
9587 switch (TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))))
9588 {
9589 case TYPE_CODE_FUNC:
9590 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
9591 break;
9592 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
9593 break;
9594 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
9595 if (noside != EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9596 argvec[0] = ada_value_ind (argvec[0]);
9597 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
9598 break;
9599 default:
9600 error (_("cannot subscript or call something of type `%s'"),
9601 ada_type_name (value_type (argvec[0])));
9602 break;
9603 }
9604 }
9605
9606 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
9607 {
9608 case TYPE_CODE_FUNC:
9609 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9610 return allocate_value (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
9611 return call_function_by_hand (argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1);
9612 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
9613 {
9614 int arity;
9615
9616 arity = ada_array_arity (type);
9617 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
9618 if (type == NULL)
9619 error (_("cannot subscript or call a record"));
9620 if (arity != nargs)
9621 error (_("wrong number of subscripts; expecting %d"), arity);
9622 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9623 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
9624 return
9625 unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript
9626 (argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1));
9627 }
9628 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
9629 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9630 {
9631 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
9632 if (type == NULL)
9633 error (_("element type of array unknown"));
9634 else
9635 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
9636 }
9637 return
9638 unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript
9639 (ada_coerce_to_simple_array (argvec[0]),
9640 nargs, argvec + 1));
9641 case TYPE_CODE_PTR: /* Pointer to array */
9642 type = to_fixed_array_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), NULL, 1);
9643 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9644 {
9645 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
9646 if (type == NULL)
9647 error (_("element type of array unknown"));
9648 else
9649 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
9650 }
9651 return
9652 unwrap_value (ada_value_ptr_subscript (argvec[0], type,
9653 nargs, argvec + 1));
9654
9655 default:
9656 error (_("Attempt to index or call something other than an "
9657 "array or function"));
9658 }
9659
9660 case TERNOP_SLICE:
9661 {
9662 struct value *array = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9663 struct value *low_bound_val =
9664 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9665 struct value *high_bound_val =
9666 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9667 LONGEST low_bound;
9668 LONGEST high_bound;
9669
9670 low_bound_val = coerce_ref (low_bound_val);
9671 high_bound_val = coerce_ref (high_bound_val);
9672 low_bound = pos_atr (low_bound_val);
9673 high_bound = pos_atr (high_bound_val);
9674
9675 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9676 goto nosideret;
9677
9678 /* If this is a reference to an aligner type, then remove all
9679 the aligners. */
9680 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_REF
9681 && ada_is_aligner_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array))))
9682 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)) =
9683 ada_aligned_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)));
9684
9685 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (array)))
9686 error (_("cannot slice a packed array"));
9687
9688 /* If this is a reference to an array or an array lvalue,
9689 convert to a pointer. */
9690 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_REF
9691 || (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
9692 && VALUE_LVAL (array) == lval_memory))
9693 array = value_addr (array);
9694
9695 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS
9696 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (ada_check_typedef
9697 (value_type (array))))
9698 return empty_array (ada_type_of_array (array, 0), low_bound);
9699
9700 array = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (array);
9701
9702 /* If we have more than one level of pointer indirection,
9703 dereference the value until we get only one level. */
9704 while (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
9705 && (TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)))
9706 == TYPE_CODE_PTR))
9707 array = value_ind (array);
9708
9709 /* Make sure we really do have an array type before going further,
9710 to avoid a SEGV when trying to get the index type or the target
9711 type later down the road if the debug info generated by
9712 the compiler is incorrect or incomplete. */
9713 if (!ada_is_simple_array_type (value_type (array)))
9714 error (_("cannot take slice of non-array"));
9715
9716 if (TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (value_type (array)))
9717 == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
9718 {
9719 struct type *type0 = ada_check_typedef (value_type (array));
9720
9721 if (high_bound < low_bound || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9722 return empty_array (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0), low_bound);
9723 else
9724 {
9725 struct type *arr_type0 =
9726 to_fixed_array_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0), NULL, 1);
9727
9728 return ada_value_slice_from_ptr (array, arr_type0,
9729 longest_to_int (low_bound),
9730 longest_to_int (high_bound));
9731 }
9732 }
9733 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9734 return array;
9735 else if (high_bound < low_bound)
9736 return empty_array (value_type (array), low_bound);
9737 else
9738 return ada_value_slice (array, longest_to_int (low_bound),
9739 longest_to_int (high_bound));
9740 }
9741
9742 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
9743 (*pos) += 2;
9744 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9745 type = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 1].type);
9746
9747 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9748 goto nosideret;
9749
9750 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
9751 {
9752 default:
9753 lim_warning (_("Membership test incompletely implemented; "
9754 "always returns true"));
9755 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
9756 return value_from_longest (type, (LONGEST) 1);
9757
9758 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
9759 arg2 = value_from_longest (type, TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type));
9760 arg3 = value_from_longest (type, TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type));
9761 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9762 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
9763 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
9764 return
9765 value_from_longest (type,
9766 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
9767 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
9768 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
9769 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
9770 }
9771
9772 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
9773 (*pos) += 2;
9774 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9775 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9776
9777 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9778 goto nosideret;
9779
9780 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9781 {
9782 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
9783 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
9784 }
9785
9786 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
9787
9788 type = ada_index_type (value_type (arg2), tem, "range");
9789 if (!type)
9790 type = value_type (arg1);
9791
9792 arg3 = value_from_longest (type, ada_array_bound (arg2, tem, 1));
9793 arg2 = value_from_longest (type, ada_array_bound (arg2, tem, 0));
9794
9795 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9796 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
9797 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
9798 return
9799 value_from_longest (type,
9800 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
9801 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
9802 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
9803 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
9804
9805 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
9806 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9807 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9808 arg3 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9809
9810 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9811 goto nosideret;
9812
9813 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9814 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
9815 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
9816 return
9817 value_from_longest (type,
9818 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
9819 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
9820 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
9821 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
9822
9823 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
9824 case OP_ATR_LAST:
9825 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
9826 {
9827 struct type *type_arg;
9828
9829 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_TYPE)
9830 {
9831 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9832 arg1 = NULL;
9833 type_arg = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 2].type);
9834 }
9835 else
9836 {
9837 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9838 type_arg = NULL;
9839 }
9840
9841 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode != OP_LONG)
9842 error (_("Invalid operand to '%s"), ada_attribute_name (op));
9843 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos + 2].longconst);
9844 *pos += 4;
9845
9846 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9847 goto nosideret;
9848
9849 if (type_arg == NULL)
9850 {
9851 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
9852
9853 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arg1)))
9854 arg1 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
9855
9856 type = ada_index_type (value_type (arg1), tem,
9857 ada_attribute_name (op));
9858 if (type == NULL)
9859 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
9860
9861 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9862 return allocate_value (type);
9863
9864 switch (op)
9865 {
9866 default: /* Should never happen. */
9867 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
9868 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
9869 return value_from_longest
9870 (type, ada_array_bound (arg1, tem, 0));
9871 case OP_ATR_LAST:
9872 return value_from_longest
9873 (type, ada_array_bound (arg1, tem, 1));
9874 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
9875 return value_from_longest
9876 (type, ada_array_length (arg1, tem));
9877 }
9878 }
9879 else if (discrete_type_p (type_arg))
9880 {
9881 struct type *range_type;
9882 char *name = ada_type_name (type_arg);
9883
9884 range_type = NULL;
9885 if (name != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type_arg) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
9886 range_type = to_fixed_range_type (type_arg, NULL);
9887 if (range_type == NULL)
9888 range_type = type_arg;
9889 switch (op)
9890 {
9891 default:
9892 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
9893 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
9894 return value_from_longest
9895 (range_type, ada_discrete_type_low_bound (range_type));
9896 case OP_ATR_LAST:
9897 return value_from_longest
9898 (range_type, ada_discrete_type_high_bound (range_type));
9899 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
9900 error (_("the 'length attribute applies only to array types"));
9901 }
9902 }
9903 else if (TYPE_CODE (type_arg) == TYPE_CODE_FLT)
9904 error (_("unimplemented type attribute"));
9905 else
9906 {
9907 LONGEST low, high;
9908
9909 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type_arg))
9910 type_arg = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type_arg);
9911
9912 type = ada_index_type (type_arg, tem, ada_attribute_name (op));
9913 if (type == NULL)
9914 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
9915
9916 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9917 return allocate_value (type);
9918
9919 switch (op)
9920 {
9921 default:
9922 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
9923 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
9924 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 0);
9925 return value_from_longest (type, low);
9926 case OP_ATR_LAST:
9927 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 1);
9928 return value_from_longest (type, high);
9929 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
9930 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 0);
9931 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 1);
9932 return value_from_longest (type, high - low + 1);
9933 }
9934 }
9935 }
9936
9937 case OP_ATR_TAG:
9938 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9939 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9940 goto nosideret;
9941
9942 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9943 return value_zero (ada_tag_type (arg1), not_lval);
9944
9945 return ada_value_tag (arg1);
9946
9947 case OP_ATR_MIN:
9948 case OP_ATR_MAX:
9949 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9950 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9951 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9952 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9953 goto nosideret;
9954 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9955 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
9956 else
9957 {
9958 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9959 return value_binop (arg1, arg2,
9960 op == OP_ATR_MIN ? BINOP_MIN : BINOP_MAX);
9961 }
9962
9963 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
9964 {
9965 struct type *type_arg = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 2].type);
9966
9967 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9968 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9969 goto nosideret;
9970
9971 if (!ada_is_modular_type (type_arg))
9972 error (_("'modulus must be applied to modular type"));
9973
9974 return value_from_longest (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type_arg),
9975 ada_modulus (type_arg));
9976 }
9977
9978
9979 case OP_ATR_POS:
9980 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9981 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9982 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9983 goto nosideret;
9984 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
9985 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9986 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
9987 else
9988 return value_pos_atr (type, arg1);
9989
9990 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
9991 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9992 type = value_type (arg1);
9993
9994 /* If the argument is a reference, then dereference its type, since
9995 the user is really asking for the size of the actual object,
9996 not the size of the pointer. */
9997 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
9998 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
9999
10000 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10001 goto nosideret;
10002 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10003 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int, not_lval);
10004 else
10005 return value_from_longest (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
10006 TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (type));
10007
10008 case OP_ATR_VAL:
10009 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
10010 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10011 type = exp->elts[pc + 2].type;
10012 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10013 goto nosideret;
10014 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10015 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
10016 else
10017 return value_val_atr (type, arg1);
10018
10019 case BINOP_EXP:
10020 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10021 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10022 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10023 goto nosideret;
10024 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10025 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
10026 else
10027 {
10028 /* For integer exponentiation operations,
10029 only promote the first argument. */
10030 if (is_integral_type (value_type (arg2)))
10031 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
10032 else
10033 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10034
10035 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
10036 }
10037
10038 case UNOP_PLUS:
10039 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10040 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10041 goto nosideret;
10042 else
10043 return arg1;
10044
10045 case UNOP_ABS:
10046 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10047 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10048 goto nosideret;
10049 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
10050 if (value_less (arg1, value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval)))
10051 return value_neg (arg1);
10052 else
10053 return arg1;
10054
10055 case UNOP_IND:
10056 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10057 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10058 goto nosideret;
10059 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1));
10060 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10061 {
10062 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
10063 /* GDB allows dereferencing GNAT array descriptors. */
10064 {
10065 struct type *arrType = ada_type_of_array (arg1, 0);
10066
10067 if (arrType == NULL)
10068 error (_("Attempt to dereference null array pointer."));
10069 return value_at_lazy (arrType, 0);
10070 }
10071 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
10072 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF
10073 /* In C you can dereference an array to get the 1st elt. */
10074 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
10075 {
10076 type = to_static_fixed_type
10077 (ada_aligned_type
10078 (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))));
10079 check_size (type);
10080 return value_zero (type, lval_memory);
10081 }
10082 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT)
10083 {
10084 /* GDB allows dereferencing an int. */
10085 if (expect_type == NULL)
10086 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
10087 lval_memory);
10088 else
10089 {
10090 expect_type =
10091 to_static_fixed_type (ada_aligned_type (expect_type));
10092 return value_zero (expect_type, lval_memory);
10093 }
10094 }
10095 else
10096 error (_("Attempt to take contents of a non-pointer value."));
10097 }
10098 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1); /* FIXME: What is this for?? */
10099 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1));
10100
10101 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT)
10102 /* GDB allows dereferencing an int. If we were given
10103 the expect_type, then use that as the target type.
10104 Otherwise, assume that the target type is an int. */
10105 {
10106 if (expect_type != NULL)
10107 return ada_value_ind (value_cast (lookup_pointer_type (expect_type),
10108 arg1));
10109 else
10110 return value_at_lazy (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
10111 (CORE_ADDR) value_as_address (arg1));
10112 }
10113
10114 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
10115 /* GDB allows dereferencing GNAT array descriptors. */
10116 return ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
10117 else
10118 return ada_value_ind (arg1);
10119
10120 case STRUCTOP_STRUCT:
10121 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
10122 (*pos) += 3 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (tem + 1);
10123 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10124 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10125 goto nosideret;
10126 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10127 {
10128 struct type *type1 = value_type (arg1);
10129
10130 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type1, 1))
10131 {
10132 type = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type1,
10133 &exp->elts[pc + 2].string,
10134 1, 1, NULL);
10135 if (type == NULL)
10136 /* In this case, we assume that the field COULD exist
10137 in some extension of the type. Return an object of
10138 "type" void, which will match any formal
10139 (see ada_type_match). */
10140 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_void,
10141 lval_memory);
10142 }
10143 else
10144 type =
10145 ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type1, &exp->elts[pc + 2].string, 1,
10146 0, NULL);
10147
10148 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
10149 }
10150 else
10151 arg1 = ada_value_struct_elt (arg1, &exp->elts[pc + 2].string, 0);
10152 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
10153 return ada_to_fixed_value (arg1);
10154
10155 case OP_TYPE:
10156 /* The value is not supposed to be used. This is here to make it
10157 easier to accommodate expressions that contain types. */
10158 (*pos) += 2;
10159 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10160 goto nosideret;
10161 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10162 return allocate_value (exp->elts[pc + 1].type);
10163 else
10164 error (_("Attempt to use a type name as an expression"));
10165
10166 case OP_AGGREGATE:
10167 case OP_CHOICES:
10168 case OP_OTHERS:
10169 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
10170 case OP_POSITIONAL:
10171 case OP_NAME:
10172 if (noside == EVAL_NORMAL)
10173 switch (op)
10174 {
10175 case OP_NAME:
10176 error (_("Undefined name, ambiguous name, or renaming used in "
10177 "component association: %s."), &exp->elts[pc+2].string);
10178 case OP_AGGREGATE:
10179 error (_("Aggregates only allowed on the right of an assignment"));
10180 default:
10181 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10182 _("aggregate apparently mangled"));
10183 }
10184
10185 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
10186 *pos += oplen - 1;
10187 for (tem = 0; tem < nargs; tem += 1)
10188 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, noside);
10189 goto nosideret;
10190 }
10191
10192 nosideret:
10193 return value_from_longest (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int, 1);
10194 }
10195 \f
10196
10197 /* Fixed point */
10198
10199 /* If TYPE encodes an Ada fixed-point type, return the suffix of the
10200 type name that encodes the 'small and 'delta information.
10201 Otherwise, return NULL. */
10202
10203 static const char *
10204 fixed_type_info (struct type *type)
10205 {
10206 const char *name = ada_type_name (type);
10207 enum type_code code = (type == NULL) ? TYPE_CODE_UNDEF : TYPE_CODE (type);
10208
10209 if ((code == TYPE_CODE_INT || code == TYPE_CODE_RANGE) && name != NULL)
10210 {
10211 const char *tail = strstr (name, "___XF_");
10212
10213 if (tail == NULL)
10214 return NULL;
10215 else
10216 return tail + 5;
10217 }
10218 else if (code == TYPE_CODE_RANGE && TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) != type)
10219 return fixed_type_info (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
10220 else
10221 return NULL;
10222 }
10223
10224 /* Returns non-zero iff TYPE represents an Ada fixed-point type. */
10225
10226 int
10227 ada_is_fixed_point_type (struct type *type)
10228 {
10229 return fixed_type_info (type) != NULL;
10230 }
10231
10232 /* Return non-zero iff TYPE represents a System.Address type. */
10233
10234 int
10235 ada_is_system_address_type (struct type *type)
10236 {
10237 return (TYPE_NAME (type)
10238 && strcmp (TYPE_NAME (type), "system__address") == 0);
10239 }
10240
10241 /* Assuming that TYPE is the representation of an Ada fixed-point
10242 type, return its delta, or -1 if the type is malformed and the
10243 delta cannot be determined. */
10244
10245 DOUBLEST
10246 ada_delta (struct type *type)
10247 {
10248 const char *encoding = fixed_type_info (type);
10249 DOUBLEST num, den;
10250
10251 /* Strictly speaking, num and den are encoded as integer. However,
10252 they may not fit into a long, and they will have to be converted
10253 to DOUBLEST anyway. So scan them as DOUBLEST. */
10254 if (sscanf (encoding, "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT,
10255 &num, &den) < 2)
10256 return -1.0;
10257 else
10258 return num / den;
10259 }
10260
10261 /* Assuming that ada_is_fixed_point_type (TYPE), return the scaling
10262 factor ('SMALL value) associated with the type. */
10263
10264 static DOUBLEST
10265 scaling_factor (struct type *type)
10266 {
10267 const char *encoding = fixed_type_info (type);
10268 DOUBLEST num0, den0, num1, den1;
10269 int n;
10270
10271 /* Strictly speaking, num's and den's are encoded as integer. However,
10272 they may not fit into a long, and they will have to be converted
10273 to DOUBLEST anyway. So scan them as DOUBLEST. */
10274 n = sscanf (encoding,
10275 "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT
10276 "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT,
10277 &num0, &den0, &num1, &den1);
10278
10279 if (n < 2)
10280 return 1.0;
10281 else if (n == 4)
10282 return num1 / den1;
10283 else
10284 return num0 / den0;
10285 }
10286
10287
10288 /* Assuming that X is the representation of a value of fixed-point
10289 type TYPE, return its floating-point equivalent. */
10290
10291 DOUBLEST
10292 ada_fixed_to_float (struct type *type, LONGEST x)
10293 {
10294 return (DOUBLEST) x *scaling_factor (type);
10295 }
10296
10297 /* The representation of a fixed-point value of type TYPE
10298 corresponding to the value X. */
10299
10300 LONGEST
10301 ada_float_to_fixed (struct type *type, DOUBLEST x)
10302 {
10303 return (LONGEST) (x / scaling_factor (type) + 0.5);
10304 }
10305
10306 \f
10307
10308 /* Range types */
10309
10310 /* Scan STR beginning at position K for a discriminant name, and
10311 return the value of that discriminant field of DVAL in *PX. If
10312 PNEW_K is not null, put the position of the character beyond the
10313 name scanned in *PNEW_K. Return 1 if successful; return 0 and do
10314 not alter *PX and *PNEW_K if unsuccessful. */
10315
10316 static int
10317 scan_discrim_bound (char *str, int k, struct value *dval, LONGEST * px,
10318 int *pnew_k)
10319 {
10320 static char *bound_buffer = NULL;
10321 static size_t bound_buffer_len = 0;
10322 char *bound;
10323 char *pend;
10324 struct value *bound_val;
10325
10326 if (dval == NULL || str == NULL || str[k] == '\0')
10327 return 0;
10328
10329 pend = strstr (str + k, "__");
10330 if (pend == NULL)
10331 {
10332 bound = str + k;
10333 k += strlen (bound);
10334 }
10335 else
10336 {
10337 GROW_VECT (bound_buffer, bound_buffer_len, pend - (str + k) + 1);
10338 bound = bound_buffer;
10339 strncpy (bound_buffer, str + k, pend - (str + k));
10340 bound[pend - (str + k)] = '\0';
10341 k = pend - str;
10342 }
10343
10344 bound_val = ada_search_struct_field (bound, dval, 0, value_type (dval));
10345 if (bound_val == NULL)
10346 return 0;
10347
10348 *px = value_as_long (bound_val);
10349 if (pnew_k != NULL)
10350 *pnew_k = k;
10351 return 1;
10352 }
10353
10354 /* Value of variable named NAME in the current environment. If
10355 no such variable found, then if ERR_MSG is null, returns 0, and
10356 otherwise causes an error with message ERR_MSG. */
10357
10358 static struct value *
10359 get_var_value (char *name, char *err_msg)
10360 {
10361 struct ada_symbol_info *syms;
10362 int nsyms;
10363
10364 nsyms = ada_lookup_symbol_list (name, get_selected_block (0), VAR_DOMAIN,
10365 &syms, 1);
10366
10367 if (nsyms != 1)
10368 {
10369 if (err_msg == NULL)
10370 return 0;
10371 else
10372 error (("%s"), err_msg);
10373 }
10374
10375 return value_of_variable (syms[0].sym, syms[0].block);
10376 }
10377
10378 /* Value of integer variable named NAME in the current environment. If
10379 no such variable found, returns 0, and sets *FLAG to 0. If
10380 successful, sets *FLAG to 1. */
10381
10382 LONGEST
10383 get_int_var_value (char *name, int *flag)
10384 {
10385 struct value *var_val = get_var_value (name, 0);
10386
10387 if (var_val == 0)
10388 {
10389 if (flag != NULL)
10390 *flag = 0;
10391 return 0;
10392 }
10393 else
10394 {
10395 if (flag != NULL)
10396 *flag = 1;
10397 return value_as_long (var_val);
10398 }
10399 }
10400
10401
10402 /* Return a range type whose base type is that of the range type named
10403 NAME in the current environment, and whose bounds are calculated
10404 from NAME according to the GNAT range encoding conventions.
10405 Extract discriminant values, if needed, from DVAL. ORIG_TYPE is the
10406 corresponding range type from debug information; fall back to using it
10407 if symbol lookup fails. If a new type must be created, allocate it
10408 like ORIG_TYPE was. The bounds information, in general, is encoded
10409 in NAME, the base type given in the named range type. */
10410
10411 static struct type *
10412 to_fixed_range_type (struct type *raw_type, struct value *dval)
10413 {
10414 char *name;
10415 struct type *base_type;
10416 char *subtype_info;
10417
10418 gdb_assert (raw_type != NULL);
10419 gdb_assert (TYPE_NAME (raw_type) != NULL);
10420
10421 if (TYPE_CODE (raw_type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
10422 base_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (raw_type);
10423 else
10424 base_type = raw_type;
10425
10426 name = TYPE_NAME (raw_type);
10427 subtype_info = strstr (name, "___XD");
10428 if (subtype_info == NULL)
10429 {
10430 LONGEST L = ada_discrete_type_low_bound (raw_type);
10431 LONGEST U = ada_discrete_type_high_bound (raw_type);
10432
10433 if (L < INT_MIN || U > INT_MAX)
10434 return raw_type;
10435 else
10436 return create_range_type (alloc_type_copy (raw_type), raw_type,
10437 ada_discrete_type_low_bound (raw_type),
10438 ada_discrete_type_high_bound (raw_type));
10439 }
10440 else
10441 {
10442 static char *name_buf = NULL;
10443 static size_t name_len = 0;
10444 int prefix_len = subtype_info - name;
10445 LONGEST L, U;
10446 struct type *type;
10447 char *bounds_str;
10448 int n;
10449
10450 GROW_VECT (name_buf, name_len, prefix_len + 5);
10451 strncpy (name_buf, name, prefix_len);
10452 name_buf[prefix_len] = '\0';
10453
10454 subtype_info += 5;
10455 bounds_str = strchr (subtype_info, '_');
10456 n = 1;
10457
10458 if (*subtype_info == 'L')
10459 {
10460 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &L, &n)
10461 && !scan_discrim_bound (bounds_str, n, dval, &L, &n))
10462 return raw_type;
10463 if (bounds_str[n] == '_')
10464 n += 2;
10465 else if (bounds_str[n] == '.') /* FIXME? SGI Workshop kludge. */
10466 n += 1;
10467 subtype_info += 1;
10468 }
10469 else
10470 {
10471 int ok;
10472
10473 strcpy (name_buf + prefix_len, "___L");
10474 L = get_int_var_value (name_buf, &ok);
10475 if (!ok)
10476 {
10477 lim_warning (_("Unknown lower bound, using 1."));
10478 L = 1;
10479 }
10480 }
10481
10482 if (*subtype_info == 'U')
10483 {
10484 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &U, &n)
10485 && !scan_discrim_bound (bounds_str, n, dval, &U, &n))
10486 return raw_type;
10487 }
10488 else
10489 {
10490 int ok;
10491
10492 strcpy (name_buf + prefix_len, "___U");
10493 U = get_int_var_value (name_buf, &ok);
10494 if (!ok)
10495 {
10496 lim_warning (_("Unknown upper bound, using %ld."), (long) L);
10497 U = L;
10498 }
10499 }
10500
10501 type = create_range_type (alloc_type_copy (raw_type), base_type, L, U);
10502 TYPE_NAME (type) = name;
10503 return type;
10504 }
10505 }
10506
10507 /* True iff NAME is the name of a range type. */
10508
10509 int
10510 ada_is_range_type_name (const char *name)
10511 {
10512 return (name != NULL && strstr (name, "___XD"));
10513 }
10514 \f
10515
10516 /* Modular types */
10517
10518 /* True iff TYPE is an Ada modular type. */
10519
10520 int
10521 ada_is_modular_type (struct type *type)
10522 {
10523 struct type *subranged_type = get_base_type (type);
10524
10525 return (subranged_type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE
10526 && TYPE_CODE (subranged_type) == TYPE_CODE_INT
10527 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (subranged_type));
10528 }
10529
10530 /* Try to determine the lower and upper bounds of the given modular type
10531 using the type name only. Return non-zero and set L and U as the lower
10532 and upper bounds (respectively) if successful. */
10533
10534 int
10535 ada_modulus_from_name (struct type *type, ULONGEST *modulus)
10536 {
10537 char *name = ada_type_name (type);
10538 char *suffix;
10539 int k;
10540 LONGEST U;
10541
10542 if (name == NULL)
10543 return 0;
10544
10545 /* Discrete type bounds are encoded using an __XD suffix. In our case,
10546 we are looking for static bounds, which means an __XDLU suffix.
10547 Moreover, we know that the lower bound of modular types is always
10548 zero, so the actual suffix should start with "__XDLU_0__", and
10549 then be followed by the upper bound value. */
10550 suffix = strstr (name, "__XDLU_0__");
10551 if (suffix == NULL)
10552 return 0;
10553 k = 10;
10554 if (!ada_scan_number (suffix, k, &U, NULL))
10555 return 0;
10556
10557 *modulus = (ULONGEST) U + 1;
10558 return 1;
10559 }
10560
10561 /* Assuming ada_is_modular_type (TYPE), the modulus of TYPE. */
10562
10563 ULONGEST
10564 ada_modulus (struct type *type)
10565 {
10566 return (ULONGEST) TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type) + 1;
10567 }
10568 \f
10569
10570 /* Ada exception catchpoint support:
10571 ---------------------------------
10572
10573 We support 3 kinds of exception catchpoints:
10574 . catchpoints on Ada exceptions
10575 . catchpoints on unhandled Ada exceptions
10576 . catchpoints on failed assertions
10577
10578 Exceptions raised during failed assertions, or unhandled exceptions
10579 could perfectly be caught with the general catchpoint on Ada exceptions.
10580 However, we can easily differentiate these two special cases, and having
10581 the option to distinguish these two cases from the rest can be useful
10582 to zero-in on certain situations.
10583
10584 Exception catchpoints are a specialized form of breakpoint,
10585 since they rely on inserting breakpoints inside known routines
10586 of the GNAT runtime. The implementation therefore uses a standard
10587 breakpoint structure of the BP_BREAKPOINT type, but with its own set
10588 of breakpoint_ops.
10589
10590 Support in the runtime for exception catchpoints have been changed
10591 a few times already, and these changes affect the implementation
10592 of these catchpoints. In order to be able to support several
10593 variants of the runtime, we use a sniffer that will determine
10594 the runtime variant used by the program being debugged. */
10595
10596 /* The different types of catchpoints that we introduced for catching
10597 Ada exceptions. */
10598
10599 enum exception_catchpoint_kind
10600 {
10601 ex_catch_exception,
10602 ex_catch_exception_unhandled,
10603 ex_catch_assert
10604 };
10605
10606 /* Ada's standard exceptions. */
10607
10608 static char *standard_exc[] = {
10609 "constraint_error",
10610 "program_error",
10611 "storage_error",
10612 "tasking_error"
10613 };
10614
10615 typedef CORE_ADDR (ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_ftype) (void);
10616
10617 /* A structure that describes how to support exception catchpoints
10618 for a given executable. */
10619
10620 struct exception_support_info
10621 {
10622 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
10623 a catchpoint on exceptions. */
10624 const char *catch_exception_sym;
10625
10626 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
10627 a catchpoint on unhandled exceptions. */
10628 const char *catch_exception_unhandled_sym;
10629
10630 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
10631 a catchpoint on failed assertions. */
10632 const char *catch_assert_sym;
10633
10634 /* Assuming that the inferior just triggered an unhandled exception
10635 catchpoint, this function is responsible for returning the address
10636 in inferior memory where the name of that exception is stored.
10637 Return zero if the address could not be computed. */
10638 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_ftype *unhandled_exception_name_addr;
10639 };
10640
10641 static CORE_ADDR ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr (void);
10642 static CORE_ADDR ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise (void);
10643
10644 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to
10645 implement exception catchpoints with the latest version of the
10646 Ada runtime (as of 2007-03-06). */
10647
10648 static const struct exception_support_info default_exception_support_info =
10649 {
10650 "__gnat_debug_raise_exception", /* catch_exception_sym */
10651 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */
10652 "__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */
10653 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr
10654 };
10655
10656 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to
10657 implement exception catchpoints with a slightly older version
10658 of the Ada runtime. */
10659
10660 static const struct exception_support_info exception_support_info_fallback =
10661 {
10662 "__gnat_raise_nodefer_with_msg", /* catch_exception_sym */
10663 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */
10664 "system__assertions__raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */
10665 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise
10666 };
10667
10668 /* Return nonzero if we can detect the exception support routines
10669 described in EINFO.
10670
10671 This function errors out if an abnormal situation is detected
10672 (for instance, if we find the exception support routines, but
10673 that support is found to be incomplete). */
10674
10675 static int
10676 ada_has_this_exception_support (const struct exception_support_info *einfo)
10677 {
10678 struct symbol *sym;
10679
10680 /* The symbol we're looking up is provided by a unit in the GNAT runtime
10681 that should be compiled with debugging information. As a result, we
10682 expect to find that symbol in the symtabs. */
10683
10684 sym = standard_lookup (einfo->catch_exception_sym, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
10685 if (sym == NULL)
10686 {
10687 /* Perhaps we did not find our symbol because the Ada runtime was
10688 compiled without debugging info, or simply stripped of it.
10689 It happens on some GNU/Linux distributions for instance, where
10690 users have to install a separate debug package in order to get
10691 the runtime's debugging info. In that situation, let the user
10692 know why we cannot insert an Ada exception catchpoint.
10693
10694 Note: Just for the purpose of inserting our Ada exception
10695 catchpoint, we could rely purely on the associated minimal symbol.
10696 But we would be operating in degraded mode anyway, since we are
10697 still lacking the debugging info needed later on to extract
10698 the name of the exception being raised (this name is printed in
10699 the catchpoint message, and is also used when trying to catch
10700 a specific exception). We do not handle this case for now. */
10701 if (lookup_minimal_symbol (einfo->catch_exception_sym, NULL, NULL))
10702 error (_("Your Ada runtime appears to be missing some debugging "
10703 "information.\nCannot insert Ada exception catchpoint "
10704 "in this configuration."));
10705
10706 return 0;
10707 }
10708
10709 /* Make sure that the symbol we found corresponds to a function. */
10710
10711 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_BLOCK)
10712 error (_("Symbol \"%s\" is not a function (class = %d)"),
10713 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), SYMBOL_CLASS (sym));
10714
10715 return 1;
10716 }
10717
10718 /* Inspect the Ada runtime and determine which exception info structure
10719 should be used to provide support for exception catchpoints.
10720
10721 This function will always set the per-inferior exception_info,
10722 or raise an error. */
10723
10724 static void
10725 ada_exception_support_info_sniffer (void)
10726 {
10727 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
10728 struct symbol *sym;
10729
10730 /* If the exception info is already known, then no need to recompute it. */
10731 if (data->exception_info != NULL)
10732 return;
10733
10734 /* Check the latest (default) exception support info. */
10735 if (ada_has_this_exception_support (&default_exception_support_info))
10736 {
10737 data->exception_info = &default_exception_support_info;
10738 return;
10739 }
10740
10741 /* Try our fallback exception suport info. */
10742 if (ada_has_this_exception_support (&exception_support_info_fallback))
10743 {
10744 data->exception_info = &exception_support_info_fallback;
10745 return;
10746 }
10747
10748 /* Sometimes, it is normal for us to not be able to find the routine
10749 we are looking for. This happens when the program is linked with
10750 the shared version of the GNAT runtime, and the program has not been
10751 started yet. Inform the user of these two possible causes if
10752 applicable. */
10753
10754 if (ada_update_initial_language (language_unknown) != language_ada)
10755 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. Is this an Ada main program?"));
10756
10757 /* If the symbol does not exist, then check that the program is
10758 already started, to make sure that shared libraries have been
10759 loaded. If it is not started, this may mean that the symbol is
10760 in a shared library. */
10761
10762 if (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid) == 0)
10763 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. Try to start the program first."));
10764
10765 /* At this point, we know that we are debugging an Ada program and
10766 that the inferior has been started, but we still are not able to
10767 find the run-time symbols. That can mean that we are in
10768 configurable run time mode, or that a-except as been optimized
10769 out by the linker... In any case, at this point it is not worth
10770 supporting this feature. */
10771
10772 error (_("Cannot insert Ada exception catchpoints in this configuration."));
10773 }
10774
10775 /* True iff FRAME is very likely to be that of a function that is
10776 part of the runtime system. This is all very heuristic, but is
10777 intended to be used as advice as to what frames are uninteresting
10778 to most users. */
10779
10780 static int
10781 is_known_support_routine (struct frame_info *frame)
10782 {
10783 struct symtab_and_line sal;
10784 char *func_name;
10785 enum language func_lang;
10786 int i;
10787
10788 /* If this code does not have any debugging information (no symtab),
10789 This cannot be any user code. */
10790
10791 find_frame_sal (frame, &sal);
10792 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
10793 return 1;
10794
10795 /* If there is a symtab, but the associated source file cannot be
10796 located, then assume this is not user code: Selecting a frame
10797 for which we cannot display the code would not be very helpful
10798 for the user. This should also take care of case such as VxWorks
10799 where the kernel has some debugging info provided for a few units. */
10800
10801 if (symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab) == NULL)
10802 return 1;
10803
10804 /* Check the unit filename againt the Ada runtime file naming.
10805 We also check the name of the objfile against the name of some
10806 known system libraries that sometimes come with debugging info
10807 too. */
10808
10809 for (i = 0; known_runtime_file_name_patterns[i] != NULL; i += 1)
10810 {
10811 re_comp (known_runtime_file_name_patterns[i]);
10812 if (re_exec (sal.symtab->filename))
10813 return 1;
10814 if (sal.symtab->objfile != NULL
10815 && re_exec (sal.symtab->objfile->name))
10816 return 1;
10817 }
10818
10819 /* Check whether the function is a GNAT-generated entity. */
10820
10821 find_frame_funname (frame, &func_name, &func_lang, NULL);
10822 if (func_name == NULL)
10823 return 1;
10824
10825 for (i = 0; known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[i] != NULL; i += 1)
10826 {
10827 re_comp (known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[i]);
10828 if (re_exec (func_name))
10829 return 1;
10830 }
10831
10832 return 0;
10833 }
10834
10835 /* Find the first frame that contains debugging information and that is not
10836 part of the Ada run-time, starting from FI and moving upward. */
10837
10838 void
10839 ada_find_printable_frame (struct frame_info *fi)
10840 {
10841 for (; fi != NULL; fi = get_prev_frame (fi))
10842 {
10843 if (!is_known_support_routine (fi))
10844 {
10845 select_frame (fi);
10846 break;
10847 }
10848 }
10849
10850 }
10851
10852 /* Assuming that the inferior just triggered an unhandled exception
10853 catchpoint, return the address in inferior memory where the name
10854 of the exception is stored.
10855
10856 Return zero if the address could not be computed. */
10857
10858 static CORE_ADDR
10859 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr (void)
10860 {
10861 return parse_and_eval_address ("e.full_name");
10862 }
10863
10864 /* Same as ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr, except that this function
10865 should be used when the inferior uses an older version of the runtime,
10866 where the exception name needs to be extracted from a specific frame
10867 several frames up in the callstack. */
10868
10869 static CORE_ADDR
10870 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise (void)
10871 {
10872 int frame_level;
10873 struct frame_info *fi;
10874 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
10875
10876 /* To determine the name of this exception, we need to select
10877 the frame corresponding to RAISE_SYM_NAME. This frame is
10878 at least 3 levels up, so we simply skip the first 3 frames
10879 without checking the name of their associated function. */
10880 fi = get_current_frame ();
10881 for (frame_level = 0; frame_level < 3; frame_level += 1)
10882 if (fi != NULL)
10883 fi = get_prev_frame (fi);
10884
10885 while (fi != NULL)
10886 {
10887 char *func_name;
10888 enum language func_lang;
10889
10890 find_frame_funname (fi, &func_name, &func_lang, NULL);
10891 if (func_name != NULL
10892 && strcmp (func_name, data->exception_info->catch_exception_sym) == 0)
10893 break; /* We found the frame we were looking for... */
10894 fi = get_prev_frame (fi);
10895 }
10896
10897 if (fi == NULL)
10898 return 0;
10899
10900 select_frame (fi);
10901 return parse_and_eval_address ("id.full_name");
10902 }
10903
10904 /* Assuming the inferior just triggered an Ada exception catchpoint
10905 (of any type), return the address in inferior memory where the name
10906 of the exception is stored, if applicable.
10907
10908 Return zero if the address could not be computed, or if not relevant. */
10909
10910 static CORE_ADDR
10911 ada_exception_name_addr_1 (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
10912 struct breakpoint *b)
10913 {
10914 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
10915
10916 switch (ex)
10917 {
10918 case ex_catch_exception:
10919 return (parse_and_eval_address ("e.full_name"));
10920 break;
10921
10922 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
10923 return data->exception_info->unhandled_exception_name_addr ();
10924 break;
10925
10926 case ex_catch_assert:
10927 return 0; /* Exception name is not relevant in this case. */
10928 break;
10929
10930 default:
10931 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
10932 break;
10933 }
10934
10935 return 0; /* Should never be reached. */
10936 }
10937
10938 /* Same as ada_exception_name_addr_1, except that it intercepts and contains
10939 any error that ada_exception_name_addr_1 might cause to be thrown.
10940 When an error is intercepted, a warning with the error message is printed,
10941 and zero is returned. */
10942
10943 static CORE_ADDR
10944 ada_exception_name_addr (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
10945 struct breakpoint *b)
10946 {
10947 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
10948 CORE_ADDR result = 0;
10949
10950 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
10951 {
10952 result = ada_exception_name_addr_1 (ex, b);
10953 }
10954
10955 if (e.reason < 0)
10956 {
10957 warning (_("failed to get exception name: %s"), e.message);
10958 return 0;
10959 }
10960
10961 return result;
10962 }
10963
10964 static struct symtab_and_line ada_exception_sal (enum exception_catchpoint_kind,
10965 char *, char **,
10966 const struct breakpoint_ops **);
10967 static char *ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (const char *excep_string);
10968
10969 /* Ada catchpoints.
10970
10971 In the case of catchpoints on Ada exceptions, the catchpoint will
10972 stop the target on every exception the program throws. When a user
10973 specifies the name of a specific exception, we translate this
10974 request into a condition expression (in text form), and then parse
10975 it into an expression stored in each of the catchpoint's locations.
10976 We then use this condition to check whether the exception that was
10977 raised is the one the user is interested in. If not, then the
10978 target is resumed again. We store the name of the requested
10979 exception, in order to be able to re-set the condition expression
10980 when symbols change. */
10981
10982 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an Ada catchpoint
10983 breakpoint location. It includes a "struct bp_location" as a kind
10984 of base class; users downcast to "struct bp_location *" when
10985 needed. */
10986
10987 struct ada_catchpoint_location
10988 {
10989 /* The base class. */
10990 struct bp_location base;
10991
10992 /* The condition that checks whether the exception that was raised
10993 is the specific exception the user specified on catchpoint
10994 creation. */
10995 struct expression *excep_cond_expr;
10996 };
10997
10998 /* Implement the DTOR method in the bp_location_ops structure for all
10999 Ada exception catchpoint kinds. */
11000
11001 static void
11002 ada_catchpoint_location_dtor (struct bp_location *bl)
11003 {
11004 struct ada_catchpoint_location *al = (struct ada_catchpoint_location *) bl;
11005
11006 xfree (al->excep_cond_expr);
11007 }
11008
11009 /* The vtable to be used in Ada catchpoint locations. */
11010
11011 static const struct bp_location_ops ada_catchpoint_location_ops =
11012 {
11013 ada_catchpoint_location_dtor
11014 };
11015
11016 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an Ada catchpoint.
11017 It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base class; users
11018 downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. */
11019
11020 struct ada_catchpoint
11021 {
11022 /* The base class. */
11023 struct breakpoint base;
11024
11025 /* The name of the specific exception the user specified. */
11026 char *excep_string;
11027 };
11028
11029 /* Parse the exception condition string in the context of each of the
11030 catchpoint's locations, and store them for later evaluation. */
11031
11032 static void
11033 create_excep_cond_exprs (struct ada_catchpoint *c)
11034 {
11035 struct cleanup *old_chain;
11036 struct bp_location *bl;
11037 char *cond_string;
11038
11039 /* Nothing to do if there's no specific exception to catch. */
11040 if (c->excep_string == NULL)
11041 return;
11042
11043 /* Same if there are no locations... */
11044 if (c->base.loc == NULL)
11045 return;
11046
11047 /* Compute the condition expression in text form, from the specific
11048 expection we want to catch. */
11049 cond_string = ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (c->excep_string);
11050 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
11051
11052 /* Iterate over all the catchpoint's locations, and parse an
11053 expression for each. */
11054 for (bl = c->base.loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
11055 {
11056 struct ada_catchpoint_location *ada_loc
11057 = (struct ada_catchpoint_location *) bl;
11058 struct expression *exp = NULL;
11059
11060 if (!bl->shlib_disabled)
11061 {
11062 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
11063 char *s;
11064
11065 s = cond_string;
11066 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
11067 {
11068 exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, block_for_pc (bl->address), 0);
11069 }
11070 if (e.reason < 0)
11071 warning (_("failed to reevaluate internal exception condition "
11072 "for catchpoint %d: %s"),
11073 c->base.number, e.message);
11074 }
11075
11076 ada_loc->excep_cond_expr = exp;
11077 }
11078
11079 do_cleanups (old_chain);
11080 }
11081
11082 /* Implement the DTOR method in the breakpoint_ops structure for all
11083 exception catchpoint kinds. */
11084
11085 static void
11086 dtor_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex, struct breakpoint *b)
11087 {
11088 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
11089
11090 xfree (c->excep_string);
11091
11092 bkpt_breakpoint_ops.dtor (b);
11093 }
11094
11095 /* Implement the ALLOCATE_LOCATION method in the breakpoint_ops
11096 structure for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
11097
11098 static struct bp_location *
11099 allocate_location_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
11100 struct breakpoint *self)
11101 {
11102 struct ada_catchpoint_location *loc;
11103
11104 loc = XNEW (struct ada_catchpoint_location);
11105 init_bp_location (&loc->base, &ada_catchpoint_location_ops, self);
11106 loc->excep_cond_expr = NULL;
11107 return &loc->base;
11108 }
11109
11110 /* Implement the RE_SET method in the breakpoint_ops structure for all
11111 exception catchpoint kinds. */
11112
11113 static void
11114 re_set_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex, struct breakpoint *b)
11115 {
11116 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
11117
11118 /* Call the base class's method. This updates the catchpoint's
11119 locations. */
11120 bkpt_breakpoint_ops.re_set (b);
11121
11122 /* Reparse the exception conditional expressions. One for each
11123 location. */
11124 create_excep_cond_exprs (c);
11125 }
11126
11127 /* Returns true if we should stop for this breakpoint hit. If the
11128 user specified a specific exception, we only want to cause a stop
11129 if the program thrown that exception. */
11130
11131 static int
11132 should_stop_exception (const struct bp_location *bl)
11133 {
11134 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
11135 const struct ada_catchpoint_location *ada_loc
11136 = (const struct ada_catchpoint_location *) bl;
11137 volatile struct gdb_exception ex;
11138 int stop;
11139
11140 /* With no specific exception, should always stop. */
11141 if (c->excep_string == NULL)
11142 return 1;
11143
11144 if (ada_loc->excep_cond_expr == NULL)
11145 {
11146 /* We will have a NULL expression if back when we were creating
11147 the expressions, this location's had failed to parse. */
11148 return 1;
11149 }
11150
11151 stop = 1;
11152 TRY_CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
11153 {
11154 struct value *mark;
11155
11156 mark = value_mark ();
11157 stop = value_true (evaluate_expression (ada_loc->excep_cond_expr));
11158 value_free_to_mark (mark);
11159 }
11160 if (ex.reason < 0)
11161 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
11162 _("Error in testing exception condition:\n"));
11163 return stop;
11164 }
11165
11166 /* Implement the CHECK_STATUS method in the breakpoint_ops structure
11167 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
11168
11169 static void
11170 check_status_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex, bpstat bs)
11171 {
11172 bs->stop = should_stop_exception (bs->bp_location_at);
11173 }
11174
11175 /* Implement the PRINT_IT method in the breakpoint_ops structure
11176 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
11177
11178 static enum print_stop_action
11179 print_it_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex, bpstat bs)
11180 {
11181 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
11182 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
11183
11184 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
11185
11186 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
11187 {
11188 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
11189 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
11190 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
11191 }
11192
11193 ui_out_text (uiout,
11194 b->disposition == disp_del ? "\nTemporary catchpoint "
11195 : "\nCatchpoint ");
11196 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
11197 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
11198
11199 switch (ex)
11200 {
11201 case ex_catch_exception:
11202 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
11203 {
11204 const CORE_ADDR addr = ada_exception_name_addr (ex, b);
11205 char exception_name[256];
11206
11207 if (addr != 0)
11208 {
11209 read_memory (addr, exception_name, sizeof (exception_name) - 1);
11210 exception_name [sizeof (exception_name) - 1] = '\0';
11211 }
11212 else
11213 {
11214 /* For some reason, we were unable to read the exception
11215 name. This could happen if the Runtime was compiled
11216 without debugging info, for instance. In that case,
11217 just replace the exception name by the generic string
11218 "exception" - it will read as "an exception" in the
11219 notification we are about to print. */
11220 memcpy (exception_name, "exception", sizeof ("exception"));
11221 }
11222 /* In the case of unhandled exception breakpoints, we print
11223 the exception name as "unhandled EXCEPTION_NAME", to make
11224 it clearer to the user which kind of catchpoint just got
11225 hit. We used ui_out_text to make sure that this extra
11226 info does not pollute the exception name in the MI case. */
11227 if (ex == ex_catch_exception_unhandled)
11228 ui_out_text (uiout, "unhandled ");
11229 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exception-name", exception_name);
11230 }
11231 break;
11232 case ex_catch_assert:
11233 /* In this case, the name of the exception is not really
11234 important. Just print "failed assertion" to make it clearer
11235 that his program just hit an assertion-failure catchpoint.
11236 We used ui_out_text because this info does not belong in
11237 the MI output. */
11238 ui_out_text (uiout, "failed assertion");
11239 break;
11240 }
11241 ui_out_text (uiout, " at ");
11242 ada_find_printable_frame (get_current_frame ());
11243
11244 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
11245 }
11246
11247 /* Implement the PRINT_ONE method in the breakpoint_ops structure
11248 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
11249
11250 static void
11251 print_one_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
11252 struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
11253 {
11254 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
11255 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
11256 struct value_print_options opts;
11257
11258 get_user_print_options (&opts);
11259 if (opts.addressprint)
11260 {
11261 annotate_field (4);
11262 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr", b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address);
11263 }
11264
11265 annotate_field (5);
11266 *last_loc = b->loc;
11267 switch (ex)
11268 {
11269 case ex_catch_exception:
11270 if (c->excep_string != NULL)
11271 {
11272 char *msg = xstrprintf (_("`%s' Ada exception"), c->excep_string);
11273
11274 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", msg);
11275 xfree (msg);
11276 }
11277 else
11278 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "all Ada exceptions");
11279
11280 break;
11281
11282 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
11283 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "unhandled Ada exceptions");
11284 break;
11285
11286 case ex_catch_assert:
11287 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "failed Ada assertions");
11288 break;
11289
11290 default:
11291 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
11292 break;
11293 }
11294 }
11295
11296 /* Implement the PRINT_MENTION method in the breakpoint_ops structure
11297 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
11298
11299 static void
11300 print_mention_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
11301 struct breakpoint *b)
11302 {
11303 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
11304 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
11305
11306 ui_out_text (uiout, b->disposition == disp_del ? _("Temporary catchpoint ")
11307 : _("Catchpoint "));
11308 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
11309 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
11310
11311 switch (ex)
11312 {
11313 case ex_catch_exception:
11314 if (c->excep_string != NULL)
11315 {
11316 char *info = xstrprintf (_("`%s' Ada exception"), c->excep_string);
11317 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, info);
11318
11319 ui_out_text (uiout, info);
11320 do_cleanups (old_chain);
11321 }
11322 else
11323 ui_out_text (uiout, _("all Ada exceptions"));
11324 break;
11325
11326 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
11327 ui_out_text (uiout, _("unhandled Ada exceptions"));
11328 break;
11329
11330 case ex_catch_assert:
11331 ui_out_text (uiout, _("failed Ada assertions"));
11332 break;
11333
11334 default:
11335 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
11336 break;
11337 }
11338 }
11339
11340 /* Implement the PRINT_RECREATE method in the breakpoint_ops structure
11341 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
11342
11343 static void
11344 print_recreate_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
11345 struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
11346 {
11347 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
11348
11349 switch (ex)
11350 {
11351 case ex_catch_exception:
11352 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch exception");
11353 if (c->excep_string != NULL)
11354 fprintf_filtered (fp, " %s", c->excep_string);
11355 break;
11356
11357 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
11358 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch exception unhandled");
11359 break;
11360
11361 case ex_catch_assert:
11362 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch assert");
11363 break;
11364
11365 default:
11366 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
11367 }
11368 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
11369 }
11370
11371 /* Virtual table for "catch exception" breakpoints. */
11372
11373 static void
11374 dtor_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b)
11375 {
11376 dtor_exception (ex_catch_exception, b);
11377 }
11378
11379 static struct bp_location *
11380 allocate_location_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *self)
11381 {
11382 return allocate_location_exception (ex_catch_exception, self);
11383 }
11384
11385 static void
11386 re_set_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b)
11387 {
11388 re_set_exception (ex_catch_exception, b);
11389 }
11390
11391 static void
11392 check_status_catch_exception (bpstat bs)
11393 {
11394 check_status_exception (ex_catch_exception, bs);
11395 }
11396
11397 static enum print_stop_action
11398 print_it_catch_exception (bpstat bs)
11399 {
11400 return print_it_exception (ex_catch_exception, bs);
11401 }
11402
11403 static void
11404 print_one_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
11405 {
11406 print_one_exception (ex_catch_exception, b, last_loc);
11407 }
11408
11409 static void
11410 print_mention_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b)
11411 {
11412 print_mention_exception (ex_catch_exception, b);
11413 }
11414
11415 static void
11416 print_recreate_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
11417 {
11418 print_recreate_exception (ex_catch_exception, b, fp);
11419 }
11420
11421 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exception_breakpoint_ops;
11422
11423 /* Virtual table for "catch exception unhandled" breakpoints. */
11424
11425 static void
11426 dtor_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b)
11427 {
11428 dtor_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, b);
11429 }
11430
11431 static struct bp_location *
11432 allocate_location_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *self)
11433 {
11434 return allocate_location_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, self);
11435 }
11436
11437 static void
11438 re_set_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b)
11439 {
11440 re_set_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, b);
11441 }
11442
11443 static void
11444 check_status_catch_exception_unhandled (bpstat bs)
11445 {
11446 check_status_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, bs);
11447 }
11448
11449 static enum print_stop_action
11450 print_it_catch_exception_unhandled (bpstat bs)
11451 {
11452 return print_it_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, bs);
11453 }
11454
11455 static void
11456 print_one_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b,
11457 struct bp_location **last_loc)
11458 {
11459 print_one_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, b, last_loc);
11460 }
11461
11462 static void
11463 print_mention_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b)
11464 {
11465 print_mention_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, b);
11466 }
11467
11468 static void
11469 print_recreate_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b,
11470 struct ui_file *fp)
11471 {
11472 print_recreate_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, b, fp);
11473 }
11474
11475 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops;
11476
11477 /* Virtual table for "catch assert" breakpoints. */
11478
11479 static void
11480 dtor_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b)
11481 {
11482 dtor_exception (ex_catch_assert, b);
11483 }
11484
11485 static struct bp_location *
11486 allocate_location_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *self)
11487 {
11488 return allocate_location_exception (ex_catch_assert, self);
11489 }
11490
11491 static void
11492 re_set_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b)
11493 {
11494 return re_set_exception (ex_catch_assert, b);
11495 }
11496
11497 static void
11498 check_status_catch_assert (bpstat bs)
11499 {
11500 check_status_exception (ex_catch_assert, bs);
11501 }
11502
11503 static enum print_stop_action
11504 print_it_catch_assert (bpstat bs)
11505 {
11506 return print_it_exception (ex_catch_assert, bs);
11507 }
11508
11509 static void
11510 print_one_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
11511 {
11512 print_one_exception (ex_catch_assert, b, last_loc);
11513 }
11514
11515 static void
11516 print_mention_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b)
11517 {
11518 print_mention_exception (ex_catch_assert, b);
11519 }
11520
11521 static void
11522 print_recreate_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
11523 {
11524 print_recreate_exception (ex_catch_assert, b, fp);
11525 }
11526
11527 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_assert_breakpoint_ops;
11528
11529 /* Return a newly allocated copy of the first space-separated token
11530 in ARGSP, and then adjust ARGSP to point immediately after that
11531 token.
11532
11533 Return NULL if ARGPS does not contain any more tokens. */
11534
11535 static char *
11536 ada_get_next_arg (char **argsp)
11537 {
11538 char *args = *argsp;
11539 char *end;
11540 char *result;
11541
11542 args = skip_spaces (args);
11543 if (args[0] == '\0')
11544 return NULL; /* No more arguments. */
11545
11546 /* Find the end of the current argument. */
11547
11548 end = skip_to_space (args);
11549
11550 /* Adjust ARGSP to point to the start of the next argument. */
11551
11552 *argsp = end;
11553
11554 /* Make a copy of the current argument and return it. */
11555
11556 result = xmalloc (end - args + 1);
11557 strncpy (result, args, end - args);
11558 result[end - args] = '\0';
11559
11560 return result;
11561 }
11562
11563 /* Split the arguments specified in a "catch exception" command.
11564 Set EX to the appropriate catchpoint type.
11565 Set EXCEP_STRING to the name of the specific exception if
11566 specified by the user. */
11567
11568 static void
11569 catch_ada_exception_command_split (char *args,
11570 enum exception_catchpoint_kind *ex,
11571 char **excep_string)
11572 {
11573 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
11574 char *exception_name;
11575
11576 exception_name = ada_get_next_arg (&args);
11577 make_cleanup (xfree, exception_name);
11578
11579 /* Check that we do not have any more arguments. Anything else
11580 is unexpected. */
11581
11582 args = skip_spaces (args);
11583
11584 if (args[0] != '\0')
11585 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
11586
11587 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
11588
11589 if (exception_name == NULL)
11590 {
11591 /* Catch all exceptions. */
11592 *ex = ex_catch_exception;
11593 *excep_string = NULL;
11594 }
11595 else if (strcmp (exception_name, "unhandled") == 0)
11596 {
11597 /* Catch unhandled exceptions. */
11598 *ex = ex_catch_exception_unhandled;
11599 *excep_string = NULL;
11600 }
11601 else
11602 {
11603 /* Catch a specific exception. */
11604 *ex = ex_catch_exception;
11605 *excep_string = exception_name;
11606 }
11607 }
11608
11609 /* Return the name of the symbol on which we should break in order to
11610 implement a catchpoint of the EX kind. */
11611
11612 static const char *
11613 ada_exception_sym_name (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
11614 {
11615 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
11616
11617 gdb_assert (data->exception_info != NULL);
11618
11619 switch (ex)
11620 {
11621 case ex_catch_exception:
11622 return (data->exception_info->catch_exception_sym);
11623 break;
11624 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
11625 return (data->exception_info->catch_exception_unhandled_sym);
11626 break;
11627 case ex_catch_assert:
11628 return (data->exception_info->catch_assert_sym);
11629 break;
11630 default:
11631 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
11632 _("unexpected catchpoint kind (%d)"), ex);
11633 }
11634 }
11635
11636 /* Return the breakpoint ops "virtual table" used for catchpoints
11637 of the EX kind. */
11638
11639 static const struct breakpoint_ops *
11640 ada_exception_breakpoint_ops (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
11641 {
11642 switch (ex)
11643 {
11644 case ex_catch_exception:
11645 return (&catch_exception_breakpoint_ops);
11646 break;
11647 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
11648 return (&catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops);
11649 break;
11650 case ex_catch_assert:
11651 return (&catch_assert_breakpoint_ops);
11652 break;
11653 default:
11654 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
11655 _("unexpected catchpoint kind (%d)"), ex);
11656 }
11657 }
11658
11659 /* Return the condition that will be used to match the current exception
11660 being raised with the exception that the user wants to catch. This
11661 assumes that this condition is used when the inferior just triggered
11662 an exception catchpoint.
11663
11664 The string returned is a newly allocated string that needs to be
11665 deallocated later. */
11666
11667 static char *
11668 ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (const char *excep_string)
11669 {
11670 int i;
11671
11672 /* The standard exceptions are a special case. They are defined in
11673 runtime units that have been compiled without debugging info; if
11674 EXCEP_STRING is the not-fully-qualified name of a standard
11675 exception (e.g. "constraint_error") then, during the evaluation
11676 of the condition expression, the symbol lookup on this name would
11677 *not* return this standard exception. The catchpoint condition
11678 may then be set only on user-defined exceptions which have the
11679 same not-fully-qualified name (e.g. my_package.constraint_error).
11680
11681 To avoid this unexcepted behavior, these standard exceptions are
11682 systematically prefixed by "standard". This means that "catch
11683 exception constraint_error" is rewritten into "catch exception
11684 standard.constraint_error".
11685
11686 If an exception named contraint_error is defined in another package of
11687 the inferior program, then the only way to specify this exception as a
11688 breakpoint condition is to use its fully-qualified named:
11689 e.g. my_package.constraint_error. */
11690
11691 for (i = 0; i < sizeof (standard_exc) / sizeof (char *); i++)
11692 {
11693 if (strcmp (standard_exc [i], excep_string) == 0)
11694 {
11695 return xstrprintf ("long_integer (e) = long_integer (&standard.%s)",
11696 excep_string);
11697 }
11698 }
11699 return xstrprintf ("long_integer (e) = long_integer (&%s)", excep_string);
11700 }
11701
11702 /* Return the symtab_and_line that should be used to insert an exception
11703 catchpoint of the TYPE kind.
11704
11705 EXCEP_STRING should contain the name of a specific exception that
11706 the catchpoint should catch, or NULL otherwise.
11707
11708 ADDR_STRING returns the name of the function where the real
11709 breakpoint that implements the catchpoints is set, depending on the
11710 type of catchpoint we need to create. */
11711
11712 static struct symtab_and_line
11713 ada_exception_sal (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex, char *excep_string,
11714 char **addr_string, const struct breakpoint_ops **ops)
11715 {
11716 const char *sym_name;
11717 struct symbol *sym;
11718
11719 /* First, find out which exception support info to use. */
11720 ada_exception_support_info_sniffer ();
11721
11722 /* Then lookup the function on which we will break in order to catch
11723 the Ada exceptions requested by the user. */
11724 sym_name = ada_exception_sym_name (ex);
11725 sym = standard_lookup (sym_name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
11726
11727 /* We can assume that SYM is not NULL at this stage. If the symbol
11728 did not exist, ada_exception_support_info_sniffer would have
11729 raised an exception.
11730
11731 Also, ada_exception_support_info_sniffer should have already
11732 verified that SYM is a function symbol. */
11733 gdb_assert (sym != NULL);
11734 gdb_assert (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_BLOCK);
11735
11736 /* Set ADDR_STRING. */
11737 *addr_string = xstrdup (sym_name);
11738
11739 /* Set OPS. */
11740 *ops = ada_exception_breakpoint_ops (ex);
11741
11742 return find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
11743 }
11744
11745 /* Parse the arguments (ARGS) of the "catch exception" command.
11746
11747 If the user asked the catchpoint to catch only a specific
11748 exception, then save the exception name in ADDR_STRING.
11749
11750 See ada_exception_sal for a description of all the remaining
11751 function arguments of this function. */
11752
11753 static struct symtab_and_line
11754 ada_decode_exception_location (char *args, char **addr_string,
11755 char **excep_string,
11756 const struct breakpoint_ops **ops)
11757 {
11758 enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex;
11759
11760 catch_ada_exception_command_split (args, &ex, excep_string);
11761 return ada_exception_sal (ex, *excep_string, addr_string, ops);
11762 }
11763
11764 /* Create an Ada exception catchpoint. */
11765
11766 static void
11767 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
11768 struct symtab_and_line sal,
11769 char *addr_string,
11770 char *excep_string,
11771 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
11772 int tempflag,
11773 int from_tty)
11774 {
11775 struct ada_catchpoint *c;
11776
11777 c = XNEW (struct ada_catchpoint);
11778 init_ada_exception_breakpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, sal, addr_string,
11779 ops, tempflag, from_tty);
11780 c->excep_string = excep_string;
11781 create_excep_cond_exprs (c);
11782 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
11783 }
11784
11785 /* Implement the "catch exception" command. */
11786
11787 static void
11788 catch_ada_exception_command (char *arg, int from_tty,
11789 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11790 {
11791 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11792 int tempflag;
11793 struct symtab_and_line sal;
11794 char *addr_string = NULL;
11795 char *excep_string = NULL;
11796 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
11797
11798 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
11799
11800 if (!arg)
11801 arg = "";
11802 sal = ada_decode_exception_location (arg, &addr_string, &excep_string, &ops);
11803 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string,
11804 excep_string, ops, tempflag, from_tty);
11805 }
11806
11807 static struct symtab_and_line
11808 ada_decode_assert_location (char *args, char **addr_string,
11809 const struct breakpoint_ops **ops)
11810 {
11811 /* Check that no argument where provided at the end of the command. */
11812
11813 if (args != NULL)
11814 {
11815 args = skip_spaces (args);
11816 if (*args != '\0')
11817 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11818 }
11819
11820 return ada_exception_sal (ex_catch_assert, NULL, addr_string, ops);
11821 }
11822
11823 /* Implement the "catch assert" command. */
11824
11825 static void
11826 catch_assert_command (char *arg, int from_tty,
11827 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11828 {
11829 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11830 int tempflag;
11831 struct symtab_and_line sal;
11832 char *addr_string = NULL;
11833 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
11834
11835 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
11836
11837 if (!arg)
11838 arg = "";
11839 sal = ada_decode_assert_location (arg, &addr_string, &ops);
11840 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string,
11841 NULL, ops, tempflag, from_tty);
11842 }
11843 /* Operators */
11844 /* Information about operators given special treatment in functions
11845 below. */
11846 /* Format: OP_DEFN (<operator>, <operator length>, <# args>, <binop>). */
11847
11848 #define ADA_OPERATORS \
11849 OP_DEFN (OP_VAR_VALUE, 4, 0, 0) \
11850 OP_DEFN (BINOP_IN_BOUNDS, 3, 2, 0) \
11851 OP_DEFN (TERNOP_IN_RANGE, 1, 3, 0) \
11852 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_FIRST, 1, 2, 0) \
11853 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_LAST, 1, 2, 0) \
11854 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_LENGTH, 1, 2, 0) \
11855 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_IMAGE, 1, 2, 0) \
11856 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MAX, 1, 3, 0) \
11857 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MIN, 1, 3, 0) \
11858 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MODULUS, 1, 1, 0) \
11859 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_POS, 1, 2, 0) \
11860 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_SIZE, 1, 1, 0) \
11861 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_TAG, 1, 1, 0) \
11862 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_VAL, 1, 2, 0) \
11863 OP_DEFN (UNOP_QUAL, 3, 1, 0) \
11864 OP_DEFN (UNOP_IN_RANGE, 3, 1, 0) \
11865 OP_DEFN (OP_OTHERS, 1, 1, 0) \
11866 OP_DEFN (OP_POSITIONAL, 3, 1, 0) \
11867 OP_DEFN (OP_DISCRETE_RANGE, 1, 2, 0)
11868
11869 static void
11870 ada_operator_length (const struct expression *exp, int pc, int *oplenp,
11871 int *argsp)
11872 {
11873 switch (exp->elts[pc - 1].opcode)
11874 {
11875 default:
11876 operator_length_standard (exp, pc, oplenp, argsp);
11877 break;
11878
11879 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) \
11880 case op: *oplenp = len; *argsp = args; break;
11881 ADA_OPERATORS;
11882 #undef OP_DEFN
11883
11884 case OP_AGGREGATE:
11885 *oplenp = 3;
11886 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc - 2].longconst);
11887 break;
11888
11889 case OP_CHOICES:
11890 *oplenp = 3;
11891 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc - 2].longconst) + 1;
11892 break;
11893 }
11894 }
11895
11896 /* Implementation of the exp_descriptor method operator_check. */
11897
11898 static int
11899 ada_operator_check (struct expression *exp, int pos,
11900 int (*objfile_func) (struct objfile *objfile, void *data),
11901 void *data)
11902 {
11903 const union exp_element *const elts = exp->elts;
11904 struct type *type = NULL;
11905
11906 switch (elts[pos].opcode)
11907 {
11908 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
11909 case UNOP_QUAL:
11910 type = elts[pos + 1].type;
11911 break;
11912
11913 default:
11914 return operator_check_standard (exp, pos, objfile_func, data);
11915 }
11916
11917 /* Invoke callbacks for TYPE and OBJFILE if they were set as non-NULL. */
11918
11919 if (type && TYPE_OBJFILE (type)
11920 && (*objfile_func) (TYPE_OBJFILE (type), data))
11921 return 1;
11922
11923 return 0;
11924 }
11925
11926 static char *
11927 ada_op_name (enum exp_opcode opcode)
11928 {
11929 switch (opcode)
11930 {
11931 default:
11932 return op_name_standard (opcode);
11933
11934 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) case op: return #op;
11935 ADA_OPERATORS;
11936 #undef OP_DEFN
11937
11938 case OP_AGGREGATE:
11939 return "OP_AGGREGATE";
11940 case OP_CHOICES:
11941 return "OP_CHOICES";
11942 case OP_NAME:
11943 return "OP_NAME";
11944 }
11945 }
11946
11947 /* As for operator_length, but assumes PC is pointing at the first
11948 element of the operator, and gives meaningful results only for the
11949 Ada-specific operators, returning 0 for *OPLENP and *ARGSP otherwise. */
11950
11951 static void
11952 ada_forward_operator_length (struct expression *exp, int pc,
11953 int *oplenp, int *argsp)
11954 {
11955 switch (exp->elts[pc].opcode)
11956 {
11957 default:
11958 *oplenp = *argsp = 0;
11959 break;
11960
11961 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) \
11962 case op: *oplenp = len; *argsp = args; break;
11963 ADA_OPERATORS;
11964 #undef OP_DEFN
11965
11966 case OP_AGGREGATE:
11967 *oplenp = 3;
11968 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
11969 break;
11970
11971 case OP_CHOICES:
11972 *oplenp = 3;
11973 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst) + 1;
11974 break;
11975
11976 case OP_STRING:
11977 case OP_NAME:
11978 {
11979 int len = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
11980
11981 *oplenp = 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (len + 1);
11982 *argsp = 0;
11983 break;
11984 }
11985 }
11986 }
11987
11988 static int
11989 ada_dump_subexp_body (struct expression *exp, struct ui_file *stream, int elt)
11990 {
11991 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[elt].opcode;
11992 int oplen, nargs;
11993 int pc = elt;
11994 int i;
11995
11996 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, elt, &oplen, &nargs);
11997
11998 switch (op)
11999 {
12000 /* Ada attributes ('Foo). */
12001 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
12002 case OP_ATR_LAST:
12003 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
12004 case OP_ATR_IMAGE:
12005 case OP_ATR_MAX:
12006 case OP_ATR_MIN:
12007 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
12008 case OP_ATR_POS:
12009 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
12010 case OP_ATR_TAG:
12011 case OP_ATR_VAL:
12012 break;
12013
12014 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
12015 case UNOP_QUAL:
12016 /* XXX: gdb_sprint_host_address, type_sprint */
12017 fprintf_filtered (stream, _("Type @"));
12018 gdb_print_host_address (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, stream);
12019 fprintf_filtered (stream, " (");
12020 type_print (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, NULL, stream, 0);
12021 fprintf_filtered (stream, ")");
12022 break;
12023 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
12024 fprintf_filtered (stream, " (%d)",
12025 longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 2].longconst));
12026 break;
12027 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
12028 break;
12029
12030 case OP_AGGREGATE:
12031 case OP_OTHERS:
12032 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
12033 case OP_POSITIONAL:
12034 case OP_CHOICES:
12035 break;
12036
12037 case OP_NAME:
12038 case OP_STRING:
12039 {
12040 char *name = &exp->elts[elt + 2].string;
12041 int len = longest_to_int (exp->elts[elt + 1].longconst);
12042
12043 fprintf_filtered (stream, "Text: `%.*s'", len, name);
12044 break;
12045 }
12046
12047 default:
12048 return dump_subexp_body_standard (exp, stream, elt);
12049 }
12050
12051 elt += oplen;
12052 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
12053 elt = dump_subexp (exp, stream, elt);
12054
12055 return elt;
12056 }
12057
12058 /* The Ada extension of print_subexp (q.v.). */
12059
12060 static void
12061 ada_print_subexp (struct expression *exp, int *pos,
12062 struct ui_file *stream, enum precedence prec)
12063 {
12064 int oplen, nargs, i;
12065 int pc = *pos;
12066 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[pc].opcode;
12067
12068 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
12069
12070 *pos += oplen;
12071 switch (op)
12072 {
12073 default:
12074 *pos -= oplen;
12075 print_subexp_standard (exp, pos, stream, prec);
12076 return;
12077
12078 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
12079 fputs_filtered (SYMBOL_NATURAL_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol), stream);
12080 return;
12081
12082 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
12083 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
12084 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12085 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
12086 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12087 fputs_filtered ("'range", stream);
12088 if (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst > 1)
12089 fprintf_filtered (stream, "(%ld)",
12090 (long) exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
12091 return;
12092
12093 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
12094 if (prec >= PREC_EQUAL)
12095 fputs_filtered ("(", stream);
12096 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
12097 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12098 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
12099 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_EQUAL);
12100 fputs_filtered (" .. ", stream);
12101 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_EQUAL);
12102 if (prec >= PREC_EQUAL)
12103 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
12104 return;
12105
12106 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
12107 case OP_ATR_LAST:
12108 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
12109 case OP_ATR_IMAGE:
12110 case OP_ATR_MAX:
12111 case OP_ATR_MIN:
12112 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
12113 case OP_ATR_POS:
12114 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
12115 case OP_ATR_TAG:
12116 case OP_ATR_VAL:
12117 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_TYPE)
12118 {
12119 if (TYPE_CODE (exp->elts[*pos + 1].type) != TYPE_CODE_VOID)
12120 LA_PRINT_TYPE (exp->elts[*pos + 1].type, "", stream, 0, 0);
12121 *pos += 3;
12122 }
12123 else
12124 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12125 fprintf_filtered (stream, "'%s", ada_attribute_name (op));
12126 if (nargs > 1)
12127 {
12128 int tem;
12129
12130 for (tem = 1; tem < nargs; tem += 1)
12131 {
12132 fputs_filtered ((tem == 1) ? " (" : ", ", stream);
12133 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_ABOVE_COMMA);
12134 }
12135 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
12136 }
12137 return;
12138
12139 case UNOP_QUAL:
12140 type_print (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, "", stream, 0);
12141 fputs_filtered ("'(", stream);
12142 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_PREFIX);
12143 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
12144 return;
12145
12146 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
12147 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
12148 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12149 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
12150 LA_PRINT_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, "", stream, 1, 0);
12151 return;
12152
12153 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
12154 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12155 fputs_filtered ("..", stream);
12156 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12157 return;
12158
12159 case OP_OTHERS:
12160 fputs_filtered ("others => ", stream);
12161 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12162 return;
12163
12164 case OP_CHOICES:
12165 for (i = 0; i < nargs-1; i += 1)
12166 {
12167 if (i > 0)
12168 fputs_filtered ("|", stream);
12169 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12170 }
12171 fputs_filtered (" => ", stream);
12172 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12173 return;
12174
12175 case OP_POSITIONAL:
12176 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12177 return;
12178
12179 case OP_AGGREGATE:
12180 fputs_filtered ("(", stream);
12181 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
12182 {
12183 if (i > 0)
12184 fputs_filtered (", ", stream);
12185 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12186 }
12187 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
12188 return;
12189 }
12190 }
12191
12192 /* Table mapping opcodes into strings for printing operators
12193 and precedences of the operators. */
12194
12195 static const struct op_print ada_op_print_tab[] = {
12196 {":=", BINOP_ASSIGN, PREC_ASSIGN, 1},
12197 {"or else", BINOP_LOGICAL_OR, PREC_LOGICAL_OR, 0},
12198 {"and then", BINOP_LOGICAL_AND, PREC_LOGICAL_AND, 0},
12199 {"or", BINOP_BITWISE_IOR, PREC_BITWISE_IOR, 0},
12200 {"xor", BINOP_BITWISE_XOR, PREC_BITWISE_XOR, 0},
12201 {"and", BINOP_BITWISE_AND, PREC_BITWISE_AND, 0},
12202 {"=", BINOP_EQUAL, PREC_EQUAL, 0},
12203 {"/=", BINOP_NOTEQUAL, PREC_EQUAL, 0},
12204 {"<=", BINOP_LEQ, PREC_ORDER, 0},
12205 {">=", BINOP_GEQ, PREC_ORDER, 0},
12206 {">", BINOP_GTR, PREC_ORDER, 0},
12207 {"<", BINOP_LESS, PREC_ORDER, 0},
12208 {">>", BINOP_RSH, PREC_SHIFT, 0},
12209 {"<<", BINOP_LSH, PREC_SHIFT, 0},
12210 {"+", BINOP_ADD, PREC_ADD, 0},
12211 {"-", BINOP_SUB, PREC_ADD, 0},
12212 {"&", BINOP_CONCAT, PREC_ADD, 0},
12213 {"*", BINOP_MUL, PREC_MUL, 0},
12214 {"/", BINOP_DIV, PREC_MUL, 0},
12215 {"rem", BINOP_REM, PREC_MUL, 0},
12216 {"mod", BINOP_MOD, PREC_MUL, 0},
12217 {"**", BINOP_EXP, PREC_REPEAT, 0},
12218 {"@", BINOP_REPEAT, PREC_REPEAT, 0},
12219 {"-", UNOP_NEG, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
12220 {"+", UNOP_PLUS, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
12221 {"not ", UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
12222 {"not ", UNOP_COMPLEMENT, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
12223 {"abs ", UNOP_ABS, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
12224 {".all", UNOP_IND, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
12225 {"'access", UNOP_ADDR, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
12226 {"'size", OP_ATR_SIZE, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
12227 {NULL, 0, 0, 0}
12228 };
12229 \f
12230 enum ada_primitive_types {
12231 ada_primitive_type_int,
12232 ada_primitive_type_long,
12233 ada_primitive_type_short,
12234 ada_primitive_type_char,
12235 ada_primitive_type_float,
12236 ada_primitive_type_double,
12237 ada_primitive_type_void,
12238 ada_primitive_type_long_long,
12239 ada_primitive_type_long_double,
12240 ada_primitive_type_natural,
12241 ada_primitive_type_positive,
12242 ada_primitive_type_system_address,
12243 nr_ada_primitive_types
12244 };
12245
12246 static void
12247 ada_language_arch_info (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12248 struct language_arch_info *lai)
12249 {
12250 const struct builtin_type *builtin = builtin_type (gdbarch);
12251
12252 lai->primitive_type_vector
12253 = GDBARCH_OBSTACK_CALLOC (gdbarch, nr_ada_primitive_types + 1,
12254 struct type *);
12255
12256 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_int]
12257 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
12258 0, "integer");
12259 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long]
12260 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_long_bit (gdbarch),
12261 0, "long_integer");
12262 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_short]
12263 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_short_bit (gdbarch),
12264 0, "short_integer");
12265 lai->string_char_type
12266 = lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_char]
12267 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, TARGET_CHAR_BIT, 0, "character");
12268 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_float]
12269 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_float_bit (gdbarch),
12270 "float", NULL);
12271 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_double]
12272 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_double_bit (gdbarch),
12273 "long_float", NULL);
12274 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long_long]
12275 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_long_long_bit (gdbarch),
12276 0, "long_long_integer");
12277 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long_double]
12278 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_double_bit (gdbarch),
12279 "long_long_float", NULL);
12280 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_natural]
12281 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
12282 0, "natural");
12283 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_positive]
12284 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
12285 0, "positive");
12286 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_void]
12287 = builtin->builtin_void;
12288
12289 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address]
12290 = lookup_pointer_type (arch_type (gdbarch, TYPE_CODE_VOID, 1, "void"));
12291 TYPE_NAME (lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address])
12292 = "system__address";
12293
12294 lai->bool_type_symbol = NULL;
12295 lai->bool_type_default = builtin->builtin_bool;
12296 }
12297 \f
12298 /* Language vector */
12299
12300 /* Not really used, but needed in the ada_language_defn. */
12301
12302 static void
12303 emit_char (int c, struct type *type, struct ui_file *stream, int quoter)
12304 {
12305 ada_emit_char (c, type, stream, quoter, 1);
12306 }
12307
12308 static int
12309 parse (void)
12310 {
12311 warnings_issued = 0;
12312 return ada_parse ();
12313 }
12314
12315 static const struct exp_descriptor ada_exp_descriptor = {
12316 ada_print_subexp,
12317 ada_operator_length,
12318 ada_operator_check,
12319 ada_op_name,
12320 ada_dump_subexp_body,
12321 ada_evaluate_subexp
12322 };
12323
12324 /* Implement the "la_get_symbol_name_match_p" language_defn method
12325 for Ada. */
12326
12327 static symbol_name_match_p_ftype
12328 ada_get_symbol_name_match_p (const char *lookup_name)
12329 {
12330 if (should_use_wild_match (lookup_name))
12331 return wild_match;
12332 else
12333 return compare_names;
12334 }
12335
12336 const struct language_defn ada_language_defn = {
12337 "ada", /* Language name */
12338 language_ada,
12339 range_check_off,
12340 type_check_off,
12341 case_sensitive_on, /* Yes, Ada is case-insensitive, but
12342 that's not quite what this means. */
12343 array_row_major,
12344 macro_expansion_no,
12345 &ada_exp_descriptor,
12346 parse,
12347 ada_error,
12348 resolve,
12349 ada_printchar, /* Print a character constant */
12350 ada_printstr, /* Function to print string constant */
12351 emit_char, /* Function to print single char (not used) */
12352 ada_print_type, /* Print a type using appropriate syntax */
12353 ada_print_typedef, /* Print a typedef using appropriate syntax */
12354 ada_val_print, /* Print a value using appropriate syntax */
12355 ada_value_print, /* Print a top-level value */
12356 NULL, /* Language specific skip_trampoline */
12357 NULL, /* name_of_this */
12358 ada_lookup_symbol_nonlocal, /* Looking up non-local symbols. */
12359 basic_lookup_transparent_type, /* lookup_transparent_type */
12360 ada_la_decode, /* Language specific symbol demangler */
12361 NULL, /* Language specific
12362 class_name_from_physname */
12363 ada_op_print_tab, /* expression operators for printing */
12364 0, /* c-style arrays */
12365 1, /* String lower bound */
12366 ada_get_gdb_completer_word_break_characters,
12367 ada_make_symbol_completion_list,
12368 ada_language_arch_info,
12369 ada_print_array_index,
12370 default_pass_by_reference,
12371 c_get_string,
12372 ada_get_symbol_name_match_p, /* la_get_symbol_name_match_p */
12373 ada_iterate_over_symbols,
12374 LANG_MAGIC
12375 };
12376
12377 /* Provide a prototype to silence -Wmissing-prototypes. */
12378 extern initialize_file_ftype _initialize_ada_language;
12379
12380 /* Command-list for the "set/show ada" prefix command. */
12381 static struct cmd_list_element *set_ada_list;
12382 static struct cmd_list_element *show_ada_list;
12383
12384 /* Implement the "set ada" prefix command. */
12385
12386 static void
12387 set_ada_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
12388 {
12389 printf_unfiltered (_(\
12390 "\"set ada\" must be followed by the name of a setting.\n"));
12391 help_list (set_ada_list, "set ada ", -1, gdb_stdout);
12392 }
12393
12394 /* Implement the "show ada" prefix command. */
12395
12396 static void
12397 show_ada_command (char *args, int from_tty)
12398 {
12399 cmd_show_list (show_ada_list, from_tty, "");
12400 }
12401
12402 static void
12403 initialize_ada_catchpoint_ops (void)
12404 {
12405 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
12406
12407 initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
12408
12409 ops = &catch_exception_breakpoint_ops;
12410 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
12411 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_exception;
12412 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_catch_exception;
12413 ops->re_set = re_set_catch_exception;
12414 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_exception;
12415 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exception;
12416 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exception;
12417 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exception;
12418 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exception;
12419
12420 ops = &catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops;
12421 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
12422 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_exception_unhandled;
12423 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_catch_exception_unhandled;
12424 ops->re_set = re_set_catch_exception_unhandled;
12425 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_exception_unhandled;
12426 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exception_unhandled;
12427 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exception_unhandled;
12428 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exception_unhandled;
12429 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exception_unhandled;
12430
12431 ops = &catch_assert_breakpoint_ops;
12432 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
12433 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_assert;
12434 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_catch_assert;
12435 ops->re_set = re_set_catch_assert;
12436 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_assert;
12437 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_assert;
12438 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_assert;
12439 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_assert;
12440 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_assert;
12441 }
12442
12443 void
12444 _initialize_ada_language (void)
12445 {
12446 add_language (&ada_language_defn);
12447
12448 initialize_ada_catchpoint_ops ();
12449
12450 add_prefix_cmd ("ada", no_class, set_ada_command,
12451 _("Prefix command for changing Ada-specfic settings"),
12452 &set_ada_list, "set ada ", 0, &setlist);
12453
12454 add_prefix_cmd ("ada", no_class, show_ada_command,
12455 _("Generic command for showing Ada-specific settings."),
12456 &show_ada_list, "show ada ", 0, &showlist);
12457
12458 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("trust-PAD-over-XVS", class_obscure,
12459 &trust_pad_over_xvs, _("\
12460 Enable or disable an optimization trusting PAD types over XVS types"), _("\
12461 Show whether an optimization trusting PAD types over XVS types is activated"),
12462 _("\
12463 This is related to the encoding used by the GNAT compiler. The debugger\n\
12464 should normally trust the contents of PAD types, but certain older versions\n\
12465 of GNAT have a bug that sometimes causes the information in the PAD type\n\
12466 to be incorrect. Turning this setting \"off\" allows the debugger to\n\
12467 work around this bug. It is always safe to turn this option \"off\", but\n\
12468 this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is recommended to NOT change\n\
12469 this option to \"off\" unless necessary."),
12470 NULL, NULL, &set_ada_list, &show_ada_list);
12471
12472 add_catch_command ("exception", _("\
12473 Catch Ada exceptions, when raised.\n\
12474 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
12475 catch_ada_exception_command,
12476 NULL,
12477 CATCH_PERMANENT,
12478 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
12479 add_catch_command ("assert", _("\
12480 Catch failed Ada assertions, when raised.\n\
12481 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
12482 catch_assert_command,
12483 NULL,
12484 CATCH_PERMANENT,
12485 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
12486
12487 varsize_limit = 65536;
12488
12489 obstack_init (&symbol_list_obstack);
12490
12491 decoded_names_store = htab_create_alloc
12492 (256, htab_hash_string, (int (*)(const void *, const void *)) streq,
12493 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
12494
12495 /* Setup per-inferior data. */
12496 observer_attach_inferior_exit (ada_inferior_exit);
12497 ada_inferior_data
12498 = register_inferior_data_with_cleanup (ada_inferior_data_cleanup);
12499 }